Compare commits
397 Commits
alpha_1_15
...
release_1_
| Author | SHA1 | Date | |
|---|---|---|---|
|
|
9077de9fa9 | ||
|
|
ac6caa71bc | ||
|
|
1ffb4377a4 | ||
|
|
a00f276fe9 | ||
|
|
5fa60b8d43 | ||
|
|
29887e47d3 | ||
|
|
a6318ea0ef | ||
|
|
c10830a35b | ||
|
|
7a968d67c8 | ||
|
|
7b68ef3d91 | ||
|
|
970f999818 | ||
|
|
cd39b5a1b7 | ||
|
|
7f6e6e6a3e | ||
|
|
99e3a2604f | ||
|
|
b4ec8aedf9 | ||
|
|
5354888e40 | ||
|
|
57bfbbde90 | ||
|
|
7b69ee5a24 | ||
|
|
1428b7f176 | ||
|
|
6901594ac4 | ||
|
|
c78356feda | ||
|
|
60c00c18b5 | ||
|
|
c1b55e02b1 | ||
|
|
15abf5c4d9 | ||
|
|
1353511226 | ||
|
|
85c7909497 | ||
|
|
db83069aea | ||
|
|
dbbffde583 | ||
|
|
1d79c6734c | ||
|
|
3af9cc0f15 | ||
|
|
c9a7297a8a | ||
|
|
985637ab5a | ||
|
|
1024343a2b | ||
|
|
1efa1f3b43 | ||
|
|
5f1a4f9f12 | ||
|
|
969d2b986b | ||
|
|
d5f2066cac | ||
|
|
79ce0e6789 | ||
|
|
6a052fd5a3 | ||
|
|
8aa729b90e | ||
|
|
057dd26a60 | ||
|
|
b94eed6d03 | ||
|
|
192860abb8 | ||
|
|
c2d2e806a1 | ||
|
|
2a89f7a0a8 | ||
|
|
71d2a66f42 | ||
|
|
e496c1b529 | ||
|
|
6667fa7fb8 | ||
|
|
a16ad3112e | ||
|
|
7efe3850f6 | ||
|
|
d0694ee604 | ||
|
|
37f0faf1c0 | ||
|
|
b893aee6d2 | ||
|
|
f60d655908 | ||
|
|
549481a0a7 | ||
|
|
e08afc2002 | ||
|
|
338591a486 | ||
|
|
c0e0d06e69 | ||
|
|
6e85425618 | ||
|
|
336519aa4f | ||
|
|
5f4d99491d | ||
|
|
48d83be336 | ||
|
|
60d351cc5a | ||
|
|
e33be3d0a1 | ||
|
|
32562b9412 | ||
|
|
dfd87ba1d0 | ||
|
|
5d4a682a55 | ||
|
|
8e3a2a520d | ||
|
|
745832a280 | ||
|
|
458efab23b | ||
|
|
23dcaa117f | ||
|
|
5099ddf6cc | ||
|
|
8476145508 | ||
|
|
362492fe70 | ||
|
|
7111008659 | ||
|
|
ec4741d732 | ||
|
|
bed7de0271 | ||
|
|
eaaadcfd36 | ||
|
|
a8830fbb86 | ||
|
|
848659f1c6 | ||
|
|
17cbd4862c | ||
|
|
64ded9e702 | ||
|
|
ccd0a527e4 | ||
|
|
3f869877a4 | ||
|
|
8c528937a9 | ||
|
|
460f4ec146 | ||
|
|
eb59c14a1f | ||
|
|
3c4f4ca423 | ||
|
|
506b4db5d0 | ||
|
|
5bfb6c5f9d | ||
|
|
3725b5606f | ||
|
|
d1a7eebc30 | ||
|
|
dfe280dcca | ||
|
|
620a136e74 | ||
|
|
3fb5d67b28 | ||
|
|
c30a794679 | ||
|
|
00bb0d8f5c | ||
|
|
af3e05b6af | ||
|
|
6060d613d1 | ||
|
|
3f12066739 | ||
|
|
3b74fbfc3b | ||
|
|
14d39a2c14 | ||
|
|
7b57922073 | ||
|
|
05c6da4c62 | ||
|
|
4ece30109d | ||
|
|
55f1eadbf2 | ||
|
|
9b22262fc6 | ||
|
|
2de140fa95 | ||
|
|
6f6864df13 | ||
|
|
519a7c0c75 | ||
|
|
1ef212d0fb | ||
|
|
333780b227 | ||
|
|
2c56ca0e7f | ||
|
|
63f8de655b | ||
|
|
2743e1ba5b | ||
|
|
40ece6bf4d | ||
|
|
63e835f5c0 | ||
|
|
efe6609cd9 | ||
|
|
b0d5935cb0 | ||
|
|
a1b1b7cc8a | ||
|
|
8940247418 | ||
|
|
0dacafbbb0 | ||
|
|
e3e50c987b | ||
|
|
923f0cda43 | ||
|
|
c485b7984d | ||
|
|
d769b724f4 | ||
|
|
a0eb52da3f | ||
|
|
87ac3207fb | ||
|
|
c634f2c6f1 | ||
|
|
5416153391 | ||
|
|
5bb69a88d8 | ||
|
|
0a848ff669 | ||
|
|
7c0b81cbb9 | ||
|
|
862770bf91 | ||
|
|
89d682d0b9 | ||
|
|
764174dc1d | ||
|
|
5ab30f709a | ||
|
|
e2b8c8fa9f | ||
|
|
42250f5010 | ||
|
|
62571aa7c3 | ||
|
|
32f7047037 | ||
|
|
a69be0adce | ||
|
|
1fb35e7374 | ||
|
|
7e69b14775 | ||
|
|
625c45d304 | ||
|
|
3fe0f0d7f8 | ||
|
|
c3d4fee823 | ||
|
|
a0fb51e136 | ||
|
|
ac8690fc4e | ||
|
|
395df04927 | ||
|
|
89a91c7b44 | ||
|
|
5635a428ab | ||
|
|
8b5f10a6c4 | ||
|
|
6e98015774 | ||
|
|
bd13e18a63 | ||
|
|
01cf5c5315 | ||
|
|
0dd814fac2 | ||
|
|
b27b516b68 | ||
|
|
c7f69c265b | ||
|
|
bc00f45420 | ||
|
|
57304e8b0a | ||
|
|
d3f04456e8 | ||
|
|
d78083e82c | ||
|
|
c8d4ceccc1 | ||
|
|
6287d3045f | ||
|
|
9d3142805b | ||
|
|
05eddc1a58 | ||
|
|
78bfbb5661 | ||
|
|
fe576585e6 | ||
|
|
080a6b2ac5 | ||
|
|
f236f33643 | ||
|
|
a4ffcfb875 | ||
|
|
967fcb9318 | ||
|
|
12b3a5d5b1 | ||
|
|
eeb610da48 | ||
|
|
749e20e6fa | ||
|
|
56f6556f94 | ||
|
|
43c5343194 | ||
|
|
250db35f17 | ||
|
|
6f929b2c89 | ||
|
|
64cddf2fbc | ||
|
|
ccdbafb276 | ||
|
|
bd222d606a | ||
|
|
94fb06f5db | ||
|
|
74d217db74 | ||
|
|
17ef61b2fd | ||
|
|
f32828d577 | ||
|
|
e67e085421 | ||
|
|
ca856c2585 | ||
|
|
18641602c1 | ||
|
|
8bdbc08a89 | ||
|
|
a5d5cc599f | ||
|
|
761895d43c | ||
|
|
5d4f057e31 | ||
|
|
7c0ba663c8 | ||
|
|
51118be241 | ||
|
|
69f5d77383 | ||
|
|
d989864712 | ||
|
|
983d328ff2 | ||
|
|
586c684815 | ||
|
|
bbf7dec45e | ||
|
|
40f79286ab | ||
|
|
ebc522d521 | ||
|
|
ad85f632c6 | ||
|
|
062b37115f | ||
|
|
6261c58ae8 | ||
|
|
427bda01a3 | ||
|
|
1d26fff0f3 | ||
|
|
bb6b92e37d | ||
|
|
8ca4064a8c | ||
|
|
5c890a6003 | ||
|
|
3705fd6452 | ||
|
|
bde442ba15 | ||
|
|
c9a8f1bc33 | ||
|
|
66e9b9cd6c | ||
|
|
b9588c4722 | ||
|
|
9a41b3b3db | ||
|
|
990e7d4437 | ||
|
|
173d3229e3 | ||
|
|
2d261da8f9 | ||
|
|
99527fa17b | ||
|
|
868ee74028 | ||
|
|
8c90bf0414 | ||
|
|
892cdea8a1 | ||
|
|
00763876f1 | ||
|
|
1a1cfaafa6 | ||
|
|
445d95be07 | ||
|
|
6fe55234c9 | ||
|
|
e24d8574a8 | ||
|
|
4da5205ed6 | ||
|
|
8241687465 | ||
|
|
8e3f3adf98 | ||
|
|
e5ef01710a | ||
|
|
e70e63612a | ||
|
|
28b26242c7 | ||
|
|
6b279a6f8c | ||
|
|
079f2d6807 | ||
|
|
b09417ca8d | ||
|
|
b15e3f1bbd | ||
|
|
1616b1d1b4 | ||
|
|
f23bc997fd | ||
|
|
8ec119a27f | ||
|
|
e35d05b1d2 | ||
|
|
cdb77dcd7b | ||
|
|
9bf87b195e | ||
|
|
643e3f2441 | ||
|
|
6e75833cb7 | ||
|
|
908d78d208 | ||
|
|
192f55e2a0 | ||
|
|
9d99fd13cd | ||
|
|
07902e9f9a | ||
|
|
0c94a109b9 | ||
|
|
27094c4fc3 | ||
|
|
5aca761e1b | ||
|
|
cc82db7f2d | ||
|
|
137ebf41fd | ||
|
|
49ea4c5057 | ||
|
|
409bddf38c | ||
|
|
c930802f31 | ||
|
|
ca14885884 | ||
|
|
01d6188297 | ||
|
|
759c5208c5 | ||
|
|
8457e06b99 | ||
|
|
8719c4f680 | ||
|
|
574022ab78 | ||
|
|
304d8b9f0c | ||
|
|
6712656eb2 | ||
|
|
415d9c9e15 | ||
|
|
1a8141ab8a | ||
|
|
023c766600 | ||
|
|
fdb46aa2e2 | ||
|
|
2504e7d3ae | ||
|
|
b0765e257c | ||
|
|
73d4c40a87 | ||
|
|
7aed52718f | ||
|
|
f572ca0cfb | ||
|
|
29236a68fa | ||
|
|
a4b1564d4a | ||
|
|
94d0385a57 | ||
|
|
603c1d60a6 | ||
|
|
29e9004b69 | ||
|
|
8da152d2b3 | ||
|
|
00746182f3 | ||
|
|
6c8815909d | ||
|
|
fde336b21a | ||
|
|
394b12d950 | ||
|
|
372638ae7a | ||
|
|
c455373e5b | ||
|
|
f2541c66cd | ||
|
|
7e6d54d0c0 | ||
|
|
876e554157 | ||
|
|
1118d24fd3 | ||
|
|
dc6f7ebf20 | ||
|
|
1102eeef1f | ||
|
|
e8a4c35a73 | ||
|
|
e359fad641 | ||
|
|
f5504a3bae | ||
|
|
341be8f405 | ||
|
|
4f2a22f306 | ||
|
|
a76ab340dd | ||
|
|
3ad3ca8734 | ||
|
|
82b2829e10 | ||
|
|
f852428d5f | ||
|
|
86e91a5bfc | ||
|
|
ec5743a628 | ||
|
|
bf7f4fdc1e | ||
|
|
98b9522499 | ||
|
|
6398dbe1a5 | ||
|
|
37724f5e20 | ||
|
|
c8c351684c | ||
|
|
01b6fb98bf | ||
|
|
f1309bffbf | ||
|
|
c732eb584e | ||
|
|
0680ad4d42 | ||
|
|
1942370acd | ||
|
|
94de7c4c77 | ||
|
|
05805868f2 | ||
|
|
57aa98047e | ||
|
|
7573967406 | ||
|
|
ab8711413c | ||
|
|
9fd9a0913d | ||
|
|
f4e4adea80 | ||
|
|
7110641821 | ||
|
|
fce454b5ca | ||
|
|
8ad985ea6c | ||
|
|
37edfd9e8f | ||
|
|
016f7c87a7 | ||
|
|
52b8bea074 | ||
|
|
5addfdcb03 | ||
|
|
e707b47aba | ||
|
|
76dc519f9f | ||
|
|
2a00376816 | ||
|
|
9766528b07 | ||
|
|
f26a90783b | ||
|
|
36fe16aaf5 | ||
|
|
89f1667fdb | ||
|
|
f2d65dda39 | ||
|
|
8370746251 | ||
|
|
2614af6d3c | ||
|
|
614def3113 | ||
|
|
b6365e9b03 | ||
|
|
bf789e3642 | ||
|
|
1421ee630d | ||
|
|
9869d0ae17 | ||
|
|
edc0b12c5e | ||
|
|
808cafa454 | ||
|
|
d1dedae402 | ||
|
|
de754902da | ||
|
|
bc7f4ad027 | ||
|
|
55abc110f5 | ||
|
|
4d753fced1 | ||
|
|
85a4e0fdeb | ||
|
|
583415c2c1 | ||
|
|
6488588c5f | ||
|
|
ac40b1e6f6 | ||
|
|
4bf5f6dca4 | ||
|
|
ecaff7cbba | ||
|
|
ea9e2d8d8e | ||
|
|
39e5d9182c | ||
|
|
c7aa519f09 | ||
|
|
bf5ba3dbef | ||
|
|
ea368b6d1b | ||
|
|
d0201294c0 | ||
|
|
c5b15c4ac1 | ||
|
|
4b3dd17c00 | ||
|
|
d339cc38af | ||
|
|
796a69787e | ||
|
|
4c54e234c1 | ||
|
|
c027e03924 | ||
|
|
6d615f12d4 | ||
|
|
8f970d2c1e | ||
|
|
d04af8f714 | ||
|
|
e2ecb82711 | ||
|
|
8e2e731733 | ||
|
|
19a63e523d | ||
|
|
5679d3020e | ||
|
|
1001c1b326 | ||
|
|
090d1d36ae | ||
|
|
2e1f904f2c | ||
|
|
6a0b5421b9 | ||
|
|
9c764b14a9 | ||
|
|
ae67839879 | ||
|
|
9588a106a7 | ||
|
|
b3627f3f07 | ||
|
|
ca7df3fe6b | ||
|
|
ab19642053 | ||
|
|
a71b154289 | ||
|
|
ceaef10443 | ||
|
|
5da6733724 | ||
|
|
8d6c177ecb | ||
|
|
1ecd6672e1 | ||
|
|
ca2f855c90 | ||
|
|
693134a4e7 | ||
|
|
90cec95580 | ||
|
|
b6fcb4ba8f | ||
|
|
6d1e9ab67e | ||
|
|
300210aa15 |
17
.cvsignore
17
.cvsignore
@@ -1,17 +0,0 @@
|
||||
*.bz2
|
||||
*.gz
|
||||
*.tar
|
||||
.bootstrap
|
||||
ABOUT-NLS
|
||||
COPYING
|
||||
INSTALL
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
aclocal.m4
|
||||
autom4te.cache
|
||||
build-aux
|
||||
config.*
|
||||
configure
|
||||
gnulib
|
||||
rmt
|
||||
stamp-h1
|
||||
31
.gitignore
vendored
Normal file
31
.gitignore
vendored
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
|
||||
*.a
|
||||
*.la
|
||||
*.lo
|
||||
*.o
|
||||
*.so
|
||||
*~
|
||||
.bootstrap
|
||||
.deps
|
||||
.emacs*
|
||||
.libs
|
||||
ABOUT-NLS
|
||||
ChangeLog
|
||||
INSTALL
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
Make.rules
|
||||
aclocal.m4
|
||||
autom4te.cache
|
||||
config.h
|
||||
config.h.in
|
||||
config.log
|
||||
config.status
|
||||
configure
|
||||
gnulib
|
||||
libtool
|
||||
m4
|
||||
paxutils
|
||||
stamp-h1
|
||||
build-aux/
|
||||
gnu
|
||||
|
||||
41
AUTHORS
41
AUTHORS
@@ -1,34 +1,15 @@
|
||||
Authors of GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
The following contributions warranted legal paper exchanges with the
|
||||
Free Software Foundation. Also see files ChangeLog and THANKS.
|
||||
Public domain tar was written by John Gilmore, with contributions from
|
||||
Henry Spencer, Fred Fish, Ian Darwin, Geoff Collyer, Stan Barber, Guy
|
||||
Harris, Dave Brower, Richard Todd, Michael Rendell, Stu Heiss, and
|
||||
Rich Salz.
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Sergey Poznyakoff 2003-10
|
||||
Assigns his past and future changes.
|
||||
The FSF version, named GNU tar, was derived from public domain tar by
|
||||
Jay Fenlason and Joy Kendall. Amy Gorin and Melissa Weisshaus
|
||||
contributed to the manual. GNU tar has been maintained in turn by
|
||||
Thomas Bushnell BSG, François Pinard, Paul Eggert, and Sergey
|
||||
Poznyakoff.
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Paul Eggert 2000-10
|
||||
Assigns his past and future changes.
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Jay Fenlason
|
||||
Assigns his changes.
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Richard E Salz 1993-03-11
|
||||
Disclaims changes to getdate.y.
|
||||
|
||||
TAR MANUAL (?) Amy Gorin (US 1963) 1995-01-10
|
||||
Assigns the Tar Manual.
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Francois Pinard Canada 1949 1996-02-01
|
||||
Assigns past and future changes.
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Melissa Weisshaus US 1966 1997-04-09
|
||||
Assigns changes to the manual and future changes.
|
||||
melissa@gnu.ai.mit.edu
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Thomas Michael Innis Bushnell US 1967 1997-04-09
|
||||
Assigns changes.
|
||||
thomas@gnu.ai.mit.edu
|
||||
|
||||
TAR Thomas Michael Innis Bushnell US 1967 1997-04-09
|
||||
Assigns changes to manual.
|
||||
thomas@gnu.ai.mit.edu
|
||||
Many others have contributed to GNU tar; please see the files THANKS
|
||||
and ChangeLog.
|
||||
|
||||
676
COPYING
Normal file
676
COPYING
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,676 @@
|
||||
|
||||
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
|
||||
Version 3, 29 June 2007
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
|
||||
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
|
||||
of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
|
||||
|
||||
Preamble
|
||||
|
||||
The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for
|
||||
software and other kinds of works.
|
||||
|
||||
The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed
|
||||
to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast,
|
||||
the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to
|
||||
share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free
|
||||
software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to
|
||||
any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to
|
||||
your programs, too.
|
||||
|
||||
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
|
||||
price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
|
||||
have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
|
||||
them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you
|
||||
want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new
|
||||
free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
|
||||
|
||||
To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you
|
||||
these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have
|
||||
certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if
|
||||
you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others.
|
||||
|
||||
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
|
||||
gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same
|
||||
freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive
|
||||
or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they
|
||||
know their rights.
|
||||
|
||||
Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps:
|
||||
(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License
|
||||
giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it.
|
||||
|
||||
For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains
|
||||
that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and
|
||||
authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as
|
||||
changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to
|
||||
authors of previous versions.
|
||||
|
||||
Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run
|
||||
modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer
|
||||
can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of
|
||||
protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic
|
||||
pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to
|
||||
use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we
|
||||
have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those
|
||||
products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we
|
||||
stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions
|
||||
of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
|
||||
|
||||
Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents.
|
||||
States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of
|
||||
software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to
|
||||
avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could
|
||||
make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that
|
||||
patents cannot be used to render the program non-free.
|
||||
|
||||
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
|
||||
modification follow.
|
||||
|
||||
TERMS AND CONDITIONS
|
||||
|
||||
0. Definitions.
|
||||
|
||||
"This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
|
||||
|
||||
"Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of
|
||||
works, such as semiconductor masks.
|
||||
|
||||
"The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this
|
||||
License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and
|
||||
"recipients" may be individuals or organizations.
|
||||
|
||||
To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work
|
||||
in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an
|
||||
exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the
|
||||
earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work.
|
||||
|
||||
A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based
|
||||
on the Program.
|
||||
|
||||
To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without
|
||||
permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for
|
||||
infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a
|
||||
computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying,
|
||||
distribution (with or without modification), making available to the
|
||||
public, and in some countries other activities as well.
|
||||
|
||||
To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other
|
||||
parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through
|
||||
a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
|
||||
|
||||
An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices"
|
||||
to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible
|
||||
feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2)
|
||||
tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the
|
||||
extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the
|
||||
work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If
|
||||
the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a
|
||||
menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
|
||||
|
||||
1. Source Code.
|
||||
|
||||
The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work
|
||||
for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source
|
||||
form of a work.
|
||||
|
||||
A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official
|
||||
standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of
|
||||
interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that
|
||||
is widely used among developers working in that language.
|
||||
|
||||
The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other
|
||||
than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of
|
||||
packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major
|
||||
Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that
|
||||
Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an
|
||||
implementation is available to the public in source code form. A
|
||||
"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component
|
||||
(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system
|
||||
(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to
|
||||
produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
|
||||
|
||||
The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all
|
||||
the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable
|
||||
work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to
|
||||
control those activities. However, it does not include the work's
|
||||
System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free
|
||||
programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but
|
||||
which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source
|
||||
includes interface definition files associated with source files for
|
||||
the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically
|
||||
linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require,
|
||||
such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those
|
||||
subprograms and other parts of the work.
|
||||
|
||||
The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users
|
||||
can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding
|
||||
Source.
|
||||
|
||||
The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that
|
||||
same work.
|
||||
|
||||
2. Basic Permissions.
|
||||
|
||||
All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of
|
||||
copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated
|
||||
conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited
|
||||
permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a
|
||||
covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its
|
||||
content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your
|
||||
rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
|
||||
|
||||
You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not
|
||||
convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains
|
||||
in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose
|
||||
of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you
|
||||
with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with
|
||||
the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do
|
||||
not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works
|
||||
for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction
|
||||
and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of
|
||||
your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you.
|
||||
|
||||
Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under
|
||||
the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10
|
||||
makes it unnecessary.
|
||||
|
||||
3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
|
||||
|
||||
No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological
|
||||
measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article
|
||||
11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or
|
||||
similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such
|
||||
measures.
|
||||
|
||||
When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid
|
||||
circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention
|
||||
is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to
|
||||
the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or
|
||||
modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's
|
||||
users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of
|
||||
technological measures.
|
||||
|
||||
4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
|
||||
|
||||
You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you
|
||||
receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
|
||||
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice;
|
||||
keep intact all notices stating that this License and any
|
||||
non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code;
|
||||
keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all
|
||||
recipients a copy of this License along with the Program.
|
||||
|
||||
You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey,
|
||||
and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
|
||||
|
||||
5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
|
||||
|
||||
You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to
|
||||
produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the
|
||||
terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
|
||||
|
||||
a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified
|
||||
it, and giving a relevant date.
|
||||
|
||||
b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is
|
||||
released under this License and any conditions added under section
|
||||
7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to
|
||||
"keep intact all notices".
|
||||
|
||||
c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this
|
||||
License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This
|
||||
License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7
|
||||
additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts,
|
||||
regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no
|
||||
permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not
|
||||
invalidate such permission if you have separately received it.
|
||||
|
||||
d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display
|
||||
Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive
|
||||
interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your
|
||||
work need not make them do so.
|
||||
|
||||
A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent
|
||||
works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work,
|
||||
and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program,
|
||||
in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an
|
||||
"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not
|
||||
used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users
|
||||
beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work
|
||||
in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other
|
||||
parts of the aggregate.
|
||||
|
||||
6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
|
||||
|
||||
You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms
|
||||
of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the
|
||||
machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License,
|
||||
in one of these ways:
|
||||
|
||||
a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
|
||||
(including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the
|
||||
Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium
|
||||
customarily used for software interchange.
|
||||
|
||||
b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
|
||||
(including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a
|
||||
written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as
|
||||
long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product
|
||||
model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a
|
||||
copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the
|
||||
product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical
|
||||
medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no
|
||||
more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this
|
||||
conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the
|
||||
Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge.
|
||||
|
||||
c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the
|
||||
written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This
|
||||
alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and
|
||||
only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord
|
||||
with subsection 6b.
|
||||
|
||||
d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated
|
||||
place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the
|
||||
Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no
|
||||
further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the
|
||||
Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to
|
||||
copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source
|
||||
may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party)
|
||||
that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain
|
||||
clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the
|
||||
Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the
|
||||
Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is
|
||||
available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
|
||||
|
||||
e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided
|
||||
you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding
|
||||
Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no
|
||||
charge under subsection 6d.
|
||||
|
||||
A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded
|
||||
from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be
|
||||
included in conveying the object code work.
|
||||
|
||||
A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any
|
||||
tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family,
|
||||
or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation
|
||||
into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product,
|
||||
doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular
|
||||
product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a
|
||||
typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status
|
||||
of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user
|
||||
actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product
|
||||
is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial
|
||||
commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent
|
||||
the only significant mode of use of the product.
|
||||
|
||||
"Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods,
|
||||
procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install
|
||||
and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from
|
||||
a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must
|
||||
suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object
|
||||
code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because
|
||||
modification has been made.
|
||||
|
||||
If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or
|
||||
specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as
|
||||
part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the
|
||||
User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a
|
||||
fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the
|
||||
Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied
|
||||
by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply
|
||||
if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install
|
||||
modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has
|
||||
been installed in ROM).
|
||||
|
||||
The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a
|
||||
requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates
|
||||
for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for
|
||||
the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a
|
||||
network may be denied when the modification itself materially and
|
||||
adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and
|
||||
protocols for communication across the network.
|
||||
|
||||
Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided,
|
||||
in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly
|
||||
documented (and with an implementation available to the public in
|
||||
source code form), and must require no special password or key for
|
||||
unpacking, reading or copying.
|
||||
|
||||
7. Additional Terms.
|
||||
|
||||
"Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this
|
||||
License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions.
|
||||
Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall
|
||||
be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent
|
||||
that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions
|
||||
apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately
|
||||
under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by
|
||||
this License without regard to the additional permissions.
|
||||
|
||||
When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option
|
||||
remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of
|
||||
it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own
|
||||
removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place
|
||||
additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work,
|
||||
for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
|
||||
|
||||
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you
|
||||
add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of
|
||||
that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms:
|
||||
|
||||
a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the
|
||||
terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or
|
||||
|
||||
b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or
|
||||
author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal
|
||||
Notices displayed by works containing it; or
|
||||
|
||||
c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or
|
||||
requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in
|
||||
reasonable ways as different from the original version; or
|
||||
|
||||
d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or
|
||||
authors of the material; or
|
||||
|
||||
e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some
|
||||
trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or
|
||||
|
||||
f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that
|
||||
material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of
|
||||
it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for
|
||||
any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on
|
||||
those licensors and authors.
|
||||
|
||||
All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further
|
||||
restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you
|
||||
received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is
|
||||
governed by this License along with a term that is a further
|
||||
restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains
|
||||
a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this
|
||||
License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms
|
||||
of that license document, provided that the further restriction does
|
||||
not survive such relicensing or conveying.
|
||||
|
||||
If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you
|
||||
must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the
|
||||
additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating
|
||||
where to find the applicable terms.
|
||||
|
||||
Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the
|
||||
form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions;
|
||||
the above requirements apply either way.
|
||||
|
||||
8. Termination.
|
||||
|
||||
You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly
|
||||
provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or
|
||||
modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under
|
||||
this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third
|
||||
paragraph of section 11).
|
||||
|
||||
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
|
||||
license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
|
||||
provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and
|
||||
finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright
|
||||
holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means
|
||||
prior to 60 days after the cessation.
|
||||
|
||||
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
|
||||
reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
|
||||
violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
|
||||
received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
|
||||
copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after
|
||||
your receipt of the notice.
|
||||
|
||||
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the
|
||||
licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under
|
||||
this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently
|
||||
reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same
|
||||
material under section 10.
|
||||
|
||||
9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
|
||||
|
||||
You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or
|
||||
run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work
|
||||
occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission
|
||||
to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However,
|
||||
nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or
|
||||
modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do
|
||||
not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a
|
||||
covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
|
||||
|
||||
10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
|
||||
|
||||
Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically
|
||||
receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and
|
||||
propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible
|
||||
for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
|
||||
|
||||
An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an
|
||||
organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an
|
||||
organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered
|
||||
work results from an entity transaction, each party to that
|
||||
transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever
|
||||
licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could
|
||||
give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the
|
||||
Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if
|
||||
the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
|
||||
|
||||
You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the
|
||||
rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may
|
||||
not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of
|
||||
rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation
|
||||
(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that
|
||||
any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for
|
||||
sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it.
|
||||
|
||||
11. Patents.
|
||||
|
||||
A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this
|
||||
License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The
|
||||
work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version".
|
||||
|
||||
A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims
|
||||
owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or
|
||||
hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted
|
||||
by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version,
|
||||
but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a
|
||||
consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For
|
||||
purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant
|
||||
patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of
|
||||
this License.
|
||||
|
||||
Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free
|
||||
patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to
|
||||
make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and
|
||||
propagate the contents of its contributor version.
|
||||
|
||||
In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express
|
||||
agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent
|
||||
(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to
|
||||
sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a
|
||||
party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a
|
||||
patent against the party.
|
||||
|
||||
If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license,
|
||||
and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone
|
||||
to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a
|
||||
publicly available network server or other readily accessible means,
|
||||
then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so
|
||||
available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the
|
||||
patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner
|
||||
consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent
|
||||
license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have
|
||||
actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the
|
||||
covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work
|
||||
in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that
|
||||
country that you have reason to believe are valid.
|
||||
|
||||
If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or
|
||||
arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a
|
||||
covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties
|
||||
receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify
|
||||
or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license
|
||||
you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered
|
||||
work and works based on it.
|
||||
|
||||
A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within
|
||||
the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is
|
||||
conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are
|
||||
specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered
|
||||
work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is
|
||||
in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment
|
||||
to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying
|
||||
the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the
|
||||
parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory
|
||||
patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work
|
||||
conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily
|
||||
for and in connection with specific products or compilations that
|
||||
contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement,
|
||||
or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
|
||||
|
||||
Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting
|
||||
any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may
|
||||
otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law.
|
||||
|
||||
12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom.
|
||||
|
||||
If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
|
||||
otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
|
||||
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a
|
||||
covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
|
||||
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may
|
||||
not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you
|
||||
to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey
|
||||
the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this
|
||||
License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
|
||||
|
||||
13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
|
||||
|
||||
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have
|
||||
permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed
|
||||
under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single
|
||||
combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this
|
||||
License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work,
|
||||
but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License,
|
||||
section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the
|
||||
combination as such.
|
||||
|
||||
14. Revised Versions of this License.
|
||||
|
||||
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of
|
||||
the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
|
||||
be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
|
||||
address new problems or concerns.
|
||||
|
||||
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the
|
||||
Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General
|
||||
Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the
|
||||
option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered
|
||||
version or of any later version published by the Free Software
|
||||
Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the
|
||||
GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published
|
||||
by the Free Software Foundation.
|
||||
|
||||
If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future
|
||||
versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's
|
||||
public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you
|
||||
to choose that version for the Program.
|
||||
|
||||
Later license versions may give you additional or different
|
||||
permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any
|
||||
author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a
|
||||
later version.
|
||||
|
||||
15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
|
||||
|
||||
THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
|
||||
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT
|
||||
HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY
|
||||
OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
|
||||
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
|
||||
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM
|
||||
IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF
|
||||
ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
|
||||
|
||||
16. Limitation of Liability.
|
||||
|
||||
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
|
||||
WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS
|
||||
THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY
|
||||
GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE
|
||||
USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
|
||||
DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD
|
||||
PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS),
|
||||
EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
|
||||
SUCH DAMAGES.
|
||||
|
||||
17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
|
||||
|
||||
If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided
|
||||
above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms,
|
||||
reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates
|
||||
an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the
|
||||
Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a
|
||||
copy of the Program in return for a fee.
|
||||
|
||||
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
|
||||
|
||||
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
|
||||
|
||||
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
|
||||
possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
|
||||
free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
|
||||
|
||||
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
|
||||
to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
|
||||
state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
|
||||
the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
|
||||
|
||||
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
|
||||
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
|
||||
(at your option) any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
|
||||
|
||||
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
|
||||
|
||||
If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short
|
||||
notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode:
|
||||
|
||||
<program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
|
||||
This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
|
||||
This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
|
||||
under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
|
||||
|
||||
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
|
||||
parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands
|
||||
might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box".
|
||||
|
||||
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school,
|
||||
if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary.
|
||||
For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see
|
||||
<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
|
||||
|
||||
The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program
|
||||
into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you
|
||||
may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with
|
||||
the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General
|
||||
Public License instead of this License. But first, please read
|
||||
<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>.
|
||||
|
||||
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
26
Makefile.am
26
Makefile.am
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
|
||||
# Main Makefile for GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003 Free
|
||||
# Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2007,
|
||||
# 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
## any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
@@ -19,6 +19,22 @@
|
||||
## 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
ACLOCAL_AMFLAGS = -I m4
|
||||
EXTRA_DIST = ChangeLog.1 PORTS
|
||||
SUBDIRS = doc lib rmt src scripts po tests
|
||||
EXTRA_DIST = ChangeLog.1 Make.rules
|
||||
SUBDIRS = doc gnu lib rmt src scripts po tests
|
||||
|
||||
dist-hook:
|
||||
$(MAKE) changelog_dir=$(distdir) make-ChangeLog
|
||||
-rm -f $(distdir).cpio
|
||||
find $(distdir) | cpio -Hcrc -o | \
|
||||
GZIP=$(GZIP_ENV) gzip -c > $(distdir).cpio.gz
|
||||
|
||||
distclean-local:
|
||||
-rm -f $(distdir).cpio.gz
|
||||
|
||||
include Make.rules
|
||||
|
||||
gen_start_date = 2009-03-06
|
||||
prev_change_log = ChangeLog.CVS
|
||||
changelog_dir = .
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
378
Makefile.in
378
Makefile.in
@@ -1,378 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# Makefile.in generated automatically by automake 1.1n from Makefile.am
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
|
||||
# gives unlimited permission to copy, distribute and modify it.
|
||||
|
||||
# Main Makefile for GNU tar.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
# any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
# GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
|
||||
# 02111-1307, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
SHELL = /bin/sh
|
||||
|
||||
srcdir = @srcdir@
|
||||
top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@
|
||||
VPATH = @srcdir@
|
||||
prefix = @prefix@
|
||||
exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
|
||||
|
||||
bindir = @bindir@
|
||||
sbindir = @sbindir@
|
||||
libexecdir = @libexecdir@
|
||||
datadir = @datadir@
|
||||
sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@
|
||||
sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@
|
||||
localstatedir = @localstatedir@
|
||||
libdir = @libdir@
|
||||
infodir = @infodir@
|
||||
mandir = @mandir@
|
||||
includedir = @includedir@
|
||||
oldincludedir = /usr/include
|
||||
|
||||
pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@
|
||||
pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@
|
||||
pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@
|
||||
|
||||
top_builddir = .
|
||||
|
||||
ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@
|
||||
AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@
|
||||
AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@
|
||||
AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@
|
||||
|
||||
INSTALL = @INSTALL@
|
||||
INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
|
||||
INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
|
||||
INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@
|
||||
transform = @program_transform_name@
|
||||
|
||||
NORMAL_INSTALL = true
|
||||
PRE_INSTALL = true
|
||||
POST_INSTALL = true
|
||||
NORMAL_UNINSTALL = true
|
||||
PRE_UNINSTALL = true
|
||||
POST_UNINSTALL = true
|
||||
ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@
|
||||
AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@
|
||||
AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@
|
||||
AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@
|
||||
CATALOGS = @CATALOGS@
|
||||
CATOBJEXT = @CATOBJEXT@
|
||||
CC = @CC@
|
||||
DATADIRNAME = @DATADIRNAME@
|
||||
ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@
|
||||
ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@
|
||||
GENCAT = @GENCAT@
|
||||
GMOFILES = @GMOFILES@
|
||||
GMSGFMT = @GMSGFMT@
|
||||
GT_NO = @GT_NO@
|
||||
GT_YES = @GT_YES@
|
||||
INSTOBJEXT = @INSTOBJEXT@
|
||||
INTLDEPS = @INTLDEPS@
|
||||
INTLLIBS = @INTLLIBS@
|
||||
INTLOBJS = @INTLOBJS@
|
||||
MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS = @MKINSTALLDIRS@
|
||||
MSGFMT = @MSGFMT@
|
||||
PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@
|
||||
POFILES = @POFILES@
|
||||
POSUB = @POSUB@
|
||||
RANLIB = @RANLIB@
|
||||
RMT = @RMT@
|
||||
U = @U@
|
||||
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL = @USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@
|
||||
USE_NLS = @USE_NLS@
|
||||
VERSION = @VERSION@
|
||||
YACC = @YACC@
|
||||
|
||||
AUTOMAKE_OPTIONS = gnits dist-shar
|
||||
|
||||
BABYL = rmail/* admin/*/RMAIL
|
||||
EXTRA_DIST = AC-PATCHES AM-PATCHES BI-PATCHES PORTS rebox.el
|
||||
SUBDIRS = doc lib intl src scripts po tests
|
||||
ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4
|
||||
CONFIG_HEADER_IN = config.h.in
|
||||
CONFIG_HEADER_FULL = config.h
|
||||
mkinstalldirs = $(SHELL) $(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs
|
||||
CONFIG_HEADER = config.h
|
||||
CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES =
|
||||
DIST_COMMON = README ABOUT-NLS AUTHORS BACKLOG COPYING ChangeLog \
|
||||
INSTALL Makefile.am Makefile.in NEWS THANKS TODO acconfig.h \
|
||||
acinclude.m4 aclocal.m4 config.h.in configure configure.in install-sh \
|
||||
missing mkinstalldirs stamp-h.in
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST)
|
||||
|
||||
TAR = tar
|
||||
GZIP = --best
|
||||
default: all
|
||||
|
||||
.SUFFIXES:
|
||||
$(srcdir)/Makefile.in: Makefile.am $(top_srcdir)/configure.in $(ACLOCAL_M4)
|
||||
cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnits Makefile
|
||||
|
||||
Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status $(BUILT_SOURCES)
|
||||
cd $(top_builddir) \
|
||||
&& CONFIG_FILES=$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= $(SHELL) ./config.status
|
||||
|
||||
$(srcdir)/aclocal.m4: configure.in acinclude.m4
|
||||
cd $(srcdir) && $(ACLOCAL)
|
||||
|
||||
config.status: configure
|
||||
$(SHELL) ./config.status --recheck
|
||||
$(srcdir)/configure: configure.in $(ACLOCAL_M4) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES)
|
||||
cd $(srcdir) && $(AUTOCONF)
|
||||
|
||||
$(CONFIG_HEADER): stamp-h
|
||||
stamp-h: $(CONFIG_HEADER_IN) $(top_builddir)/config.status
|
||||
cd $(top_builddir) \
|
||||
&& CONFIG_FILES= CONFIG_HEADERS=$(CONFIG_HEADER_FULL) \
|
||||
$(SHELL) ./config.status
|
||||
@echo timestamp > stamp-h
|
||||
$(srcdir)/$(CONFIG_HEADER_IN): stamp-h.in
|
||||
$(srcdir)/stamp-h.in: $(top_srcdir)/configure.in $(ACLOCAL_M4) acconfig.h
|
||||
cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOHEADER)
|
||||
echo timestamp > $(srcdir)/stamp-h.in
|
||||
|
||||
mostlyclean-hdr:
|
||||
|
||||
clean-hdr:
|
||||
|
||||
distclean-hdr:
|
||||
rm -f $(CONFIG_HEADER)
|
||||
|
||||
maintainer-clean-hdr:
|
||||
|
||||
# This directory's subdirectories are mostly independent; you can cd
|
||||
# into them and run `make' without going through this Makefile.
|
||||
# To change the values of `make' variables: instead of editing Makefiles,
|
||||
# (1) if the variable is set in `config.status', edit `config.status'
|
||||
# (which will cause the Makefiles to be regenerated when you run `make');
|
||||
# (2) otherwise, pass the desired values on the `make' command line.
|
||||
|
||||
@SET_MAKE@
|
||||
|
||||
all-recursive install-data-recursive install-exec-recursive \
|
||||
installdirs-recursive install-recursive uninstall-recursive \
|
||||
check-recursive installcheck-recursive info-recursive dvi-recursive \
|
||||
mostlyclean-recursive clean-recursive distclean-recursive \
|
||||
maintainer-clean-recursive:
|
||||
@for subdir in $(SUBDIRS); do \
|
||||
target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
|
||||
echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
|
||||
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $$target) \
|
||||
|| case "$(MFLAGS)" in *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
|
||||
done && test -z "$$fail"
|
||||
tags-recursive:
|
||||
list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
|
||||
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) tags); \
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
tags: TAGS
|
||||
|
||||
TAGS: tags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES) config.h.in $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES)
|
||||
tags=; \
|
||||
here=`pwd`; \
|
||||
list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
|
||||
test -f $$subdir/TAGS && tags="$$tags -i $$here/$$subdir/TAGS"; \
|
||||
done; \
|
||||
test -z "$(ETAGS_ARGS)config.h.in$(SOURCES)$(HEADERS)$$tags" \
|
||||
|| (cd $(srcdir) && etags $(ETAGS_ARGS) $$tags config.h.in $(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) -o $$here/TAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
mostlyclean-tags:
|
||||
|
||||
clean-tags:
|
||||
|
||||
distclean-tags:
|
||||
rm -f TAGS ID
|
||||
|
||||
maintainer-clean-tags:
|
||||
|
||||
distdir = $(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION)
|
||||
# This target untars the dist file and tries a VPATH configuration. Then
|
||||
# it guarantees that the distribution is self-contained by making another
|
||||
# tarfile.
|
||||
distcheck: dist
|
||||
rm -rf $(distdir)
|
||||
GZIP=$(GZIP) $(TAR) zxf $(distdir).tar.gz --mode=a+r
|
||||
mkdir $(distdir)/=build
|
||||
mkdir $(distdir)/=inst
|
||||
dc_install_base=`cd $(distdir)/=inst && pwd`; \
|
||||
cd $(distdir)/=build \
|
||||
&& ../configure --with-included-gettext --srcdir=.. --prefix=$$dc_install_base \
|
||||
&& $(MAKE) \
|
||||
&& $(MAKE) dvi \
|
||||
&& $(MAKE) check \
|
||||
&& $(MAKE) install \
|
||||
&& $(MAKE) installcheck \
|
||||
&& $(MAKE) dist
|
||||
rm -rf $(distdir)
|
||||
@echo "========================"; \
|
||||
echo "$(distdir).tar.gz is ready for distribution"; \
|
||||
echo "========================"
|
||||
dist: distdir
|
||||
-chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
|
||||
GZIP=$(GZIP) $(TAR) chozf $(distdir).tar.gz --mode=a+r $(distdir)
|
||||
rm -rf $(distdir)
|
||||
dist-shar: distdir
|
||||
-chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
|
||||
rm -rf $(distdir)
|
||||
dist-all: distdir
|
||||
-chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
|
||||
GZIP=$(GZIP) $(TAR) chozf $(distdir).tar.gz --mode=a+r $(distdir)
|
||||
rm -rf $(distdir)
|
||||
distdir: $(DISTFILES)
|
||||
@if sed 15q $(srcdir)/NEWS | fgrep -e "$(VERSION)" > /dev/null; then :; else \
|
||||
echo "NEWS not updated; not releasing" 1>&2; \
|
||||
exit 1; \
|
||||
fi
|
||||
rm -rf $(distdir)
|
||||
mkdir $(distdir)
|
||||
-chmod 755 $(distdir)
|
||||
@for file in $(DISTFILES); do \
|
||||
d=$(srcdir); \
|
||||
test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
|
||||
|| ln $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file 2> /dev/null \
|
||||
|| cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file; \
|
||||
done
|
||||
for subdir in $(SUBDIRS); do \
|
||||
test -d $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|
||||
|| mkdir $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|
||||
|| exit 1; \
|
||||
chmod 755 $(distdir)/$$subdir; \
|
||||
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) distdir=../$(distdir)/$$subdir distdir) \
|
||||
|| exit 1; \
|
||||
done
|
||||
info: info-recursive
|
||||
dvi: dvi-recursive
|
||||
check: all-am
|
||||
$(MAKE) check-recursive
|
||||
installcheck: installcheck-recursive
|
||||
all-recursive-am: $(CONFIG_HEADER)
|
||||
$(MAKE) all-recursive
|
||||
|
||||
all-am: Makefile config.h all-local
|
||||
|
||||
install-exec: install-exec-recursive
|
||||
@$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
|
||||
|
||||
install-data: install-data-recursive
|
||||
@$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
|
||||
|
||||
install: install-recursive
|
||||
@:
|
||||
|
||||
uninstall: uninstall-recursive
|
||||
|
||||
all: all-recursive-am all-am
|
||||
|
||||
install-strip:
|
||||
$(MAKE) INSTALL_PROGRAM='$(INSTALL_PROGRAM) -s' install
|
||||
installdirs: installdirs-recursive
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
mostlyclean-generic:
|
||||
test -z "$(MOSTLYCLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(MOSTLYCLEANFILES)
|
||||
|
||||
clean-generic:
|
||||
test -z "$(CLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(CLEANFILES)
|
||||
|
||||
distclean-generic:
|
||||
rm -f Makefile $(DISTCLEANFILES)
|
||||
rm -f config.cache config.log stamp-h
|
||||
test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)
|
||||
|
||||
maintainer-clean-generic:
|
||||
test -z "$(MAINTAINERCLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(MAINTAINERCLEANFILES)
|
||||
test -z "$(BUILT_SOURCES)" || rm -f $(BUILT_SOURCES)
|
||||
mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-hdr mostlyclean-tags mostlyclean-generic
|
||||
|
||||
clean-am: clean-hdr clean-tags clean-generic mostlyclean-am
|
||||
|
||||
distclean-am: distclean-hdr distclean-tags distclean-generic clean-am
|
||||
|
||||
maintainer-clean-am: maintainer-clean-hdr maintainer-clean-tags \
|
||||
maintainer-clean-generic distclean-am
|
||||
|
||||
mostlyclean: mostlyclean-recursive mostlyclean-am
|
||||
|
||||
clean: clean-recursive clean-am
|
||||
|
||||
distclean: distclean-recursive distclean-am
|
||||
rm -f config.status
|
||||
|
||||
maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-recursive maintainer-clean-am
|
||||
@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use;"
|
||||
@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild."
|
||||
rm -f config.status
|
||||
|
||||
.PHONY: default mostlyclean-hdr distclean-hdr clean-hdr \
|
||||
maintainer-clean-hdr install-data-recursive uninstall-data-recursive \
|
||||
install-exec-recursive uninstall-exec-recursive installdirs-recursive \
|
||||
uninstalldirs-recursive all-recursive check-recursive \
|
||||
installcheck-recursive info-recursive dvi-recursive \
|
||||
mostlyclean-recursive distclean-recursive clean-recursive \
|
||||
maintainer-clean-recursive tags tags-recursive mostlyclean-tags \
|
||||
distclean-tags clean-tags maintainer-clean-tags distdir info dvi \
|
||||
installcheck all-recursive-am all-am install-exec install-data install \
|
||||
uninstall all installdirs mostlyclean-generic distclean-generic \
|
||||
clean-generic maintainer-clean-generic clean mostlyclean distclean \
|
||||
maintainer-clean
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
all-local: $(CONFIG_HEADER)
|
||||
|
||||
id: ID
|
||||
|
||||
ID:
|
||||
cd lib && $(MAKE) $@
|
||||
cd src && $(MAKE) $@
|
||||
|
||||
dist-zoo: $(DISTFILES)
|
||||
rm -rf $(distdir)
|
||||
mkdir $(distdir)
|
||||
distdir=`cd $(distdir) && pwd` \
|
||||
&& cd $(srcdir) \
|
||||
&& automake --include-deps --output-dir=$$distdir
|
||||
@for file in $(DISTFILES); do \
|
||||
test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
|
||||
|| cp -p $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)/$$file; \
|
||||
done
|
||||
for subdir in $(SUBDIRS); do \
|
||||
test -d $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|
||||
|| mkdir $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|
||||
|| exit 1; \
|
||||
chmod 777 $(distdir)/$$subdir; \
|
||||
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) dist) || exit 1; \
|
||||
done
|
||||
@sublist="$(DIST_SUBDIRS)"; \
|
||||
for dir in $$sublist; do \
|
||||
echo copying directory $$dir; \
|
||||
tar -chf - $$dir | (cd $(distdir) && tar -xBpf -); \
|
||||
done
|
||||
chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
|
||||
find $(distdir) -type f | xargs dosfn
|
||||
# find $(distdir) -type f | xargs recode :ibmpc
|
||||
mv $(distdir) $(PACKAGE)
|
||||
find $(PACKAGE) -type f | zoo ahIq $(PACKAGE).zoo
|
||||
rm -rf $(PACKAGE)
|
||||
|
||||
# Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
|
||||
# Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
|
||||
.NOEXPORT:
|
||||
295
NEWS
295
NEWS
@@ -1,7 +1,272 @@
|
||||
GNU tar NEWS - User visible changes.
|
||||
GNU tar NEWS - User visible changes. 2009-03-05
|
||||
Please send GNU tar bug reports to <bug-tar@gnu.org>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.15.91 - Sergey Poznyakoff, (CVS version)
|
||||
version 1.22 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2009-03-05
|
||||
|
||||
* Support for xz compression
|
||||
|
||||
Tar uses xz for compression if one of the following conditions is met:
|
||||
|
||||
1. The option --xz or -J (see below) is used.
|
||||
2. The xz binary is set as compressor using --use-compress-program option.
|
||||
3. The file name of the archive being created ends in `.xz' and
|
||||
auto-compress option (-a) is used.
|
||||
|
||||
Xz is used for decompression if one of the following conditions is met:
|
||||
|
||||
1. The option --xz or -J is used.
|
||||
2. The xz binary is set as compressor using --use-compress-program option.
|
||||
3. The file is recognized as xz compressed stream data.
|
||||
|
||||
* Short option -J reassigned as a short equivalent of --xz
|
||||
|
||||
* New option -I
|
||||
|
||||
The -I option is assigned as a short equivalent for
|
||||
--use-compress-program.
|
||||
|
||||
* The --no-recursive option works in incremental mode.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.21 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2008-12-27
|
||||
|
||||
* New short option -J
|
||||
|
||||
A shortcut for --lzma.
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --lzop
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --no-auto-compress
|
||||
|
||||
Cancels the effect of previous --auto-compress (-a) option.
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --no-null
|
||||
|
||||
Cancels the effect of previous --null option.
|
||||
|
||||
* Compressed format recognition
|
||||
|
||||
If tar is unable to determine archive compression format, it falls
|
||||
back to using archive suffix to determine it.
|
||||
|
||||
* VCS support.
|
||||
|
||||
Using --exclude-vcs handles also files used internally by Bazaar,
|
||||
Mercurial and Darcs.
|
||||
|
||||
* Transformation scope flags
|
||||
|
||||
Name transformation expressions understand additional flags that
|
||||
control type of archive members affected by them. The flags are:
|
||||
|
||||
- r
|
||||
Apply transformation to regular archive members.
|
||||
|
||||
- s
|
||||
Apply transformation to symbolic link targets.
|
||||
|
||||
- h
|
||||
Apply transformation to hard link targets.
|
||||
|
||||
Corresponding upper-case letters negate the meaning, so that
|
||||
`H' means ``do not apply transformation to hard link targets.''
|
||||
|
||||
The scope flags are listed in the third part of an `s' expression,
|
||||
e.g.:
|
||||
|
||||
tar --transform 's|^|/usr/local/|S'
|
||||
|
||||
Default is `rsh', which means that transformations are applied to
|
||||
both regular archive members and to the targets of symbolic and hard
|
||||
links. If several transform expressions are used, the default flags
|
||||
can be changed using `flags=' statement before the expressions, e.g.:
|
||||
|
||||
tar --transform 'flags=S;s|^|/usr/local/|S'
|
||||
|
||||
* Bugfixes
|
||||
|
||||
** The --null option disabled handling of tar options in list files. This
|
||||
is fixed.
|
||||
** Fixed record size autodetection. If detected record size differs from
|
||||
the expected value (either default, or set on the command line), tar
|
||||
always prints a warning if verbosity level is set to 1 or greater,
|
||||
i.e. if either -t or -v option is given.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.20 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2008-04-14
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --auto-compress (-a)
|
||||
|
||||
With --create, selects compression algorithm basing on the suffix
|
||||
of the archive file name.
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --lzma
|
||||
|
||||
Selects LZMA compression algorithm
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --hard-dereference
|
||||
|
||||
During archive creation, dereferences hard links and stores the files
|
||||
they refer to, instead of creating usual hard link members (type '1').
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --checkpoint-action
|
||||
|
||||
This action allows to specify an action to be executed upon hitting a
|
||||
checkpoint. Recognized actions are: dot, echo (the default),
|
||||
echo=string, ttyout=string, exec=cmdline, and sleep=value. Any number
|
||||
of `--checkpoint-action' options can be specified, the actions will be
|
||||
executed in order of their appearance in the command line. See
|
||||
chapter 3.8 "Checkpoints" for a complete description.
|
||||
|
||||
* New options --no-check-device, --check-device.
|
||||
|
||||
The `--no-check-device' option disables comparing device numbers during
|
||||
preparatory stage of an incremental dump. This allows to avoid
|
||||
creating full dumps if the device numbers change (e.g. when using an
|
||||
LVM snapshot).
|
||||
|
||||
The `--check-device' option enables comparing device numbers. This is
|
||||
the default. This option is provided to undo the effect of the previous
|
||||
`--no-check-device' option, e.g. if it was set in TAR_OPTIONS
|
||||
environment variable.
|
||||
|
||||
* The --transform option.
|
||||
|
||||
Any number of `--transform' options can be given in the command line.
|
||||
The specified transformations will be applied in turn.
|
||||
|
||||
The argument to `--transform' option can be a list of replace
|
||||
expressions, separated by a semicolon (as in `sed').
|
||||
|
||||
Filename transformations are applied to symbolic link targets
|
||||
during both creation and extraction. Tar 1.19 used them only
|
||||
during extraction.
|
||||
|
||||
For a detailed description, see chapter 6.7 "Modifying File and Member
|
||||
Names".
|
||||
|
||||
* Info (end-of-volume) scripts
|
||||
|
||||
The value of the blocking factor is made available to info and
|
||||
checkpoint scripts via environment variable TAR_BLOCKING_FACTOR.
|
||||
|
||||
* Incremental archives
|
||||
|
||||
Improved (sped up) extracting from incremental archives.
|
||||
|
||||
* Bugfixes.
|
||||
** Fix bug introduced in version 1.19: tar refused to update non-existing
|
||||
archives.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.19 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2007-10-10
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --exclude-vcs
|
||||
|
||||
Excludes directories and files, created by several widely used version
|
||||
control systems, e.g. "CVS/", ".svn/", etc.
|
||||
|
||||
* --exclude-tag and --exclude-cache options
|
||||
|
||||
The following options now work with incremental archives as well:
|
||||
|
||||
--exclude-caches
|
||||
--exclude-caches-all
|
||||
--exclude-tag
|
||||
--exclude-tag-all
|
||||
--exclude-tag-under
|
||||
|
||||
* Fix handling of renamed files in listed incremental archives.
|
||||
|
||||
Previous versions always stored absolute file names in rename
|
||||
records, even if -P was not used. This is fixed: rename records
|
||||
contain file names processed in accordance with the command line
|
||||
settings.
|
||||
|
||||
* Fix --version output.
|
||||
|
||||
* Recognition of broken archives.
|
||||
|
||||
When supplied an archive smaller than 512 bytes in reading mode (-x,
|
||||
-t), the previous version of tar silently ignored it, exiting with
|
||||
code 0. It is fixed. Tar now issues the following diagnostic message:
|
||||
'This does not look like a tar archive', and exits with code 2.
|
||||
|
||||
* Fix double-dot recognition in archive member names in case of duplicate '/.'.
|
||||
|
||||
* Fix file padding in case of truncation of the input file to zero size.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.18 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2007-06-29
|
||||
|
||||
* Licensed under the GPLv3
|
||||
|
||||
* Fixed several bugs in the testsuite
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.17 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2007-06-08
|
||||
|
||||
* Fix archivation of sparse files in posix mode. Previous versions padded
|
||||
sparse members with spurious zero blocks.
|
||||
|
||||
* Fix operation of --verify --listed-incremental. Version 1.16.1 produced
|
||||
a full dump when both options were given.
|
||||
|
||||
* Fix --occurrence. In previous versions it continued scanning the archive
|
||||
even though all requested members has already been extracted.
|
||||
|
||||
* Scope of --transform and --strip-components options.
|
||||
|
||||
In addition to affecting regular archive members, the --transform
|
||||
option affects hard and soft link targets and the --strip-components
|
||||
option affects hard link targets as well.
|
||||
|
||||
* End-of-volume script can send the new volume name to tar by writing
|
||||
it to the file descriptor stored in the environment variable `TAR_FD'.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.16.1 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2006-12-09
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --exclude-tag allows to specify "exclusion tag files", i.e.
|
||||
files whose presence in a directory means that the directory should not
|
||||
be archived.
|
||||
|
||||
* The --exclude-cache option excludes directories that contain the
|
||||
CACHEDIR.TAG file from being archived. Previous versions excluded
|
||||
directory contents only, while the directories themselves were
|
||||
still added to the archive.
|
||||
|
||||
* Support for reading ustar type 'N' header logical records has been removed.
|
||||
This GNU extension was generated only by very old versions of GNU 'tar'.
|
||||
Unfortunately its implementation had security holes; see
|
||||
<http://archives.neohapsis.com/archives/fulldisclosure/2006-11/0344.html>.
|
||||
We don't expect that any tar archives in practical use have type 'N'
|
||||
records, but if you have one and you trust its contents, you can
|
||||
decode it with GNU tar 1.16 or earlier.
|
||||
|
||||
* Race conditions have been fixed that in some cases briefly allowed
|
||||
files extracted by 'tar -x --same-owner' (or plain 'tar -x', when
|
||||
running as root) to be accessed by users that they shouldn't have been.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.16 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2006-10-21
|
||||
|
||||
* After creating an archive, tar exits with code 1 if some files were
|
||||
changed while being read. Previous versions exited with code 2 (fatal
|
||||
error), and only if some files were truncated while being archived.
|
||||
|
||||
* New option --mtime allows to set modification times for all archive
|
||||
members during creation.
|
||||
|
||||
* Bug fixes
|
||||
** Avoid running off file descriptors when using multiple -C options.
|
||||
** tar --index-file=FILE --file=- sent the archive to FILE, and
|
||||
the listing to stderr.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
version 1.15.91 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2006-06-16
|
||||
|
||||
* Incompatible changes
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -19,14 +284,14 @@ no longer uses globbing by default. For example, the above invocation
|
||||
is now interpreted as a request to extract from the archive the file
|
||||
named '*.c'.
|
||||
|
||||
To treat member names as globbing patterns, use --wildcards option.
|
||||
To treat member names as globbing patterns, use --wildcards option.
|
||||
If you wish tar to mimic the behavior of versions up to 1.15.90,
|
||||
add --wildcards to the value of the environment variable TAR_OPTIONS.
|
||||
|
||||
The exact way in which tar interprets member names is controlled by the
|
||||
following command line options:
|
||||
|
||||
--wildcards use wildcards
|
||||
--wildcards use wildcards
|
||||
--anchored patterns match file name start
|
||||
--ignore-case ignore case
|
||||
--wildcards-match-slash wildcards match `/'
|
||||
@@ -34,7 +299,7 @@ following command line options:
|
||||
Each of these options has a '--no-' counterpart that disables its
|
||||
effect (e.g. --no-wildcards).
|
||||
|
||||
These options affect both the interpretation of member names from
|
||||
These options affect both the interpretation of member names from
|
||||
command line and that of the exclusion patterns (given with --exclude
|
||||
and --exclude-from options). The defaults are:
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -50,7 +315,7 @@ case-sensitive matching for the rest of command line, one could write:
|
||||
|
||||
** Short option -l is now an alias of --check-links option, which complies
|
||||
with UNIX98. This ends the transition period started with version 1.14.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
* New features
|
||||
|
||||
** New option --transform allows to transform file names before storing them
|
||||
@@ -65,19 +330,19 @@ will add 'prefix/' to all file names stored in foo.tar.
|
||||
versions it worked only with --extract.
|
||||
|
||||
** New option --show-transformed-names enables display of transformed file
|
||||
or archive. It generalizes --show-stored-names option, introduced in
|
||||
1.15.90. In particular, when creating an archive in verbose mode, it lists
|
||||
or archive. It generalizes --show-stored-names option, introduced in
|
||||
1.15.90. In particular, when creating an archive in verbose mode, it lists
|
||||
member names as stored in the archive, i.e., with any eventual prefixes
|
||||
removed and file name transformations applied. The option is useful,
|
||||
for example, while comparing `tar cv' and `tar tv' outputs.
|
||||
|
||||
** New incremental snapshot file format keeps information about file names
|
||||
** New incremental snapshot file format keeps information about file names
|
||||
as well as that about directories.
|
||||
|
||||
** The --checkpoint option takes an optional argument specifying the number
|
||||
of records between the two successive checkpoints. Optional dot
|
||||
starting the argument intructs tar to print dots instead of textual
|
||||
checkpoints.
|
||||
checkpoints.
|
||||
|
||||
** The --totals option can be used with any tar operation (previous versions
|
||||
understood it only with --create). If an argument to this option is
|
||||
@@ -169,7 +434,7 @@ Consequently, the file pointer was set off and the next member
|
||||
was not processed correctly.
|
||||
** Previous version created invalid archives when files shrink
|
||||
during reading.
|
||||
** Compare mode (tar d) hanged when trying to compare file contents.
|
||||
** Compare mode (tar d) hung when trying to compare file contents.
|
||||
** Previous versions in certain cases failed to restore directory
|
||||
modification times.
|
||||
** When creating an archive, do not attempt to store files whose
|
||||
@@ -826,13 +1091,13 @@ Versions 1.07 back to 1.00 by Jay Fenlason.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003,
|
||||
2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This file is part of GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
@@ -848,4 +1113,8 @@ Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
Local variables:
|
||||
mode: outline
|
||||
paragraph-separate: "[ ]*$"
|
||||
eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
|
||||
time-stamp-start: "changes. "
|
||||
time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d"
|
||||
time-stamp-end: "\n"
|
||||
end:
|
||||
|
||||
173
PORTS
173
PORTS
@@ -1,173 +0,0 @@
|
||||
Ports of GNU tar and other tars
|
||||
See the end of file for copying conditions.
|
||||
|
||||
* Introduction
|
||||
|
||||
Most entries in this file are out of date, unfortunately. Such
|
||||
entries are marked with an `X'. Run grep '^\*\*[^X]' PORTS to
|
||||
extract valid entries.
|
||||
|
||||
Please write bug-tar@gnu.org if you are aware of various ports of GNU tar
|
||||
to non-GNU and non-Unix systems not listed here, or for corrections.
|
||||
Please provide the goal system, a complete and stable URL, the maintainer
|
||||
name and address, the tar version used as a base, and your comments.
|
||||
|
||||
* GNU/Linux and Unix
|
||||
|
||||
** Star is a tape archiver similar to tar.
|
||||
<http://www.fokus.gmd.de/research/cc/glone/employees/joerg.schilling/private/star.html>
|
||||
|
||||
* Amiga
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.wustl.edu/systems/amiga/aminet/util/arc/GNUtar-1.11.8.lha
|
||||
maintained by Enrico Forestieri <enrico@com.unipr.it>
|
||||
Based on tar 1.11.8.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.ninemoons.com/pub/ade/current/amiga-bin/tar-1.11.8-bin.lha
|
||||
maintained by the ADE group <fnf@fishpond.ninemoons.com>
|
||||
Based on tar 1.11.8, needs ixemul.library.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.wustl.edu/systems/amiga/aminet/util/arc/gnutar.lha
|
||||
maintained by <mscheler@wuarchive.wustl.edu>
|
||||
|
||||
* DEC alpha (NT)
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.20/windows/archiver/tar.zip
|
||||
maintained by Drew Bliss & Geoff Voelker
|
||||
|
||||
* DEC VAX (VMS)
|
||||
|
||||
**X http://www.lp.se/free/vmstar/
|
||||
maintained by Richard Levitte <levitte@lp.se>
|
||||
This is not GNU tar, but a separate implementation.
|
||||
|
||||
** maintained by William Bader <william@nscs.fast.net>
|
||||
For V4.7. Based on an old PDtar. Requires compatible shared libraries
|
||||
to run V5 or V6 executables.
|
||||
|
||||
* IBM/PC (DV/X)
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://qdeck.com/ (?)
|
||||
maintained by David Ronis <ronis@gibbs.chem.mcgill.ca>
|
||||
For Desqview/X. Everything works besides compression. Copy of hacked
|
||||
sources available, some of DV/X's programmer's library also needed.
|
||||
|
||||
* IBM/PC (MSDOS)
|
||||
|
||||
**X http://www.simtel.net/simtel.net/
|
||||
http://www.leo.org/pub/comp/platforms/pc/gnuish (Germany)
|
||||
ftp://ftp.simtel.net/simtelnet/gnu
|
||||
ftp://ftp.leo.org/pub/comp/platforms/pc/gnuish
|
||||
maintained by Darrel Hankerson <hankedr@mail.auburn.edu>
|
||||
You get many GNU tools, not only `tar'. The GNUish project is described
|
||||
in `gnuish_t.htm'.
|
||||
|
||||
** The DJGPP development tools also include some `tar' utilities.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.mcs.com/mcsnet.users/les/dos-gnutar/
|
||||
maintained by Leslie Mikesell <les@mcs.net>
|
||||
Based on tar 1.11.2. Support for SCSI (via ASPI) and network (rsh over
|
||||
packet driver). No support for win95 long file names.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.wu-wien.ac.at/pub/src/PCmisc/aspi-tar/*
|
||||
maintained by Christoph Splittgerber <chris@orion.sdata.de>
|
||||
Based on tar 1.10. Support for SCSI (via ASPI).
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://wuarchive (?)
|
||||
Several DOS version based on PDtar. John Gilmore <gnu@toad.com> says
|
||||
he has copies of several vintages saved.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.14/languages/ada/toolkit/msdos/gtar/gtar.exe
|
||||
ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.14/languages/ada/toolkit/msdos/gtar/gtar.taz
|
||||
ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.14/languages/ada/toolkit/msdos/gtar/gtar.zip
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.4/os2/archiver/tar.zip
|
||||
Based on PDtar.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.20/windows/archiver/tar.zip
|
||||
maintained by Drew Bliss & Geoff Voelker
|
||||
GNU tar for NT (intel and Alpha platforms).
|
||||
|
||||
** ftp://garbo.uwasa.fi/pc/unix/untgz095.zip
|
||||
maintained by Tillmann Steinbrecher <tst@darmstadt.netsurf.de>
|
||||
The `untgz' program is a fast .tar or .tar.gz (.tgz) extractor.
|
||||
|
||||
**X http://people.darmstadt.netsurf.de/tst/tar.htm
|
||||
maintained by Tillmann Steinbrecher <tst@darmstadt.netsurf.de>
|
||||
This is not a `tar' port, but an index of them.
|
||||
|
||||
* IBM/PC (OS/2)
|
||||
|
||||
**X http://www.leo.org/pub/comp/os/os2/leo/gnu/archiver/gtar254.zip
|
||||
http://www.leo.org/pub/comp/os/os2/leo/gnu/archiver/gtak254.zip
|
||||
maintained by Andreas Kaiser <Andreas.Kaiser@stuttgart.netsurf.de>
|
||||
Version 2.54. Based on tar 1.10. The second archive contains SCSI
|
||||
drivers (DAT streamers notably) and rmt-type programs.
|
||||
|
||||
* IBM/PC (Win32: Windows 95, NT 3.5 or NT 4.0)
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.cygnus.com:~ftp/pub/sac/win32/usersrc/*
|
||||
maintained by Cygnus
|
||||
GNU-Win32 B17.1 distribution. Download all files, `cat' them together,
|
||||
and `untar' the result. You get many GNU tools, not only `tar'.
|
||||
Based on tar 1.11.2.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.20/windows/archiver/tar.zip
|
||||
maintained by Drew Bliss & Geoff Voelker
|
||||
GNU tar for NT (intel and Alpha platforms).
|
||||
|
||||
** ftp://garbo.uwasa.fi/pc/unix/untgz095.zip
|
||||
maintained by Tillmann Steinbrecher <tst@darmstadt.netsurf.de>
|
||||
The `untgz' program is a fast .tar or .tar.gz (.tgz) extractor.
|
||||
|
||||
* IBM/PC (Windows 3.1)
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.mcs.com/mcsnet.users/les/win-gnutar/
|
||||
maintained by Leslie Mikesell <les@mcs.net>
|
||||
Support for network (rsh over winsock). No support for win95 long
|
||||
file names.
|
||||
|
||||
**X ftp://ftp.gamesdomain.ru/.1/os/windows/programr/tar.zip
|
||||
Based on GNU tar 1.11.2.
|
||||
|
||||
* Macintosh
|
||||
|
||||
** Paulo Abreu (paulotex at yahoo dot com) did a
|
||||
limited port of GNU tar to Darwin, with support for resource forks
|
||||
and finder info, but this no longer seems to be available.
|
||||
|
||||
** There is a tar in Stuffit Expander which is available many places and
|
||||
comes with MacOS. It creates some spurious files but works on average.
|
||||
|
||||
** There is an excellent GNU tar bundled in Tenon MachTen, but it does not
|
||||
seem to be available separately.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
* Copyright notice
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1999, 2001, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This file is part of GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with GNU tar; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
|
||||
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Local Variables:
|
||||
mode: outline
|
||||
paragraph-separate: "[ ]*$"
|
||||
version-control: never
|
||||
End:
|
||||
|
||||
6
README
6
README
@@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ scripts.
|
||||
|
||||
** `--disable-largefile' omits support for large files, even if the
|
||||
operating system supports large files. Typically, large files are
|
||||
those larger on 2 GB on a 32-bit host.
|
||||
those larger than 2 GB on a 32-bit host.
|
||||
|
||||
* Installation hints
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -223,13 +223,13 @@ and share your findings by writing to <bug-tar@gnu.org>.
|
||||
* Copying
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 1992, 1994, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000,
|
||||
2001, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
2001, 2003, 2004, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This file is part of GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -14,6 +14,7 @@ that you have the latest stable version.
|
||||
- Gettext <http://www.gnu.org/software/gettext/>
|
||||
- Gzip <http://www.gnu.org/software/gzip/>
|
||||
- M4 <http://www.gnu.org/software/m4/>
|
||||
- Texinfo <http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo>
|
||||
- Wget <http://www.gnu.org/software/wget/>
|
||||
|
||||
As of this writing, the latest stable version of Gzip is 1.2.4 but we
|
||||
@@ -61,13 +62,13 @@ some other value.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2001, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2001, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This file is part of GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
71
README-hacking
Normal file
71
README-hacking
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
|
||||
These notes intend to help people working on the Git version of
|
||||
this package.
|
||||
|
||||
* Requirements
|
||||
|
||||
You need the following packages to build the Git version of GNU
|
||||
tar. We do not make any efforts to accommodate older versions of
|
||||
these packages, so please make sure that you have the latest stable
|
||||
version.
|
||||
|
||||
- Automake <http://www.gnu.org/software/automake/>
|
||||
- Autoconf <http://www.gnu.org/software/autoconf/>
|
||||
- M4 <http://www.gnu.org/software/m4/>
|
||||
- Texinfo <http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo>
|
||||
- Gnulib <http://www.gnu.org/software/gnulib>
|
||||
- Git <http://git.or.cz>
|
||||
|
||||
* Bootstrapping
|
||||
|
||||
Obviously, if you are reading these notes, you did manage to clone
|
||||
tar from Git. The next step is to get other files needed to build,
|
||||
which are extracted from other source packages:
|
||||
|
||||
1. Change to the source tree directory
|
||||
|
||||
cd tar
|
||||
|
||||
2. Run
|
||||
|
||||
./bootstrap
|
||||
|
||||
Once done, proceed as described in the file README (section
|
||||
INSTALLATION).
|
||||
|
||||
Normally you will have to run bootstrap only once. However, if you
|
||||
intend to hack on GNU tar, you might need to run it again later. In
|
||||
this case, you will probably want to save some time and bandwidth by
|
||||
avoiding downloading the same files again. If so, create in GNU tar
|
||||
root directory the file named `.bootstrap' with the following
|
||||
contents:
|
||||
|
||||
--gnulib-srcdir=$HOME/gnulib
|
||||
|
||||
Replace `$HOME/gnulib' with the actual directory where the Gnulib
|
||||
sources reside.
|
||||
|
||||
For more information about `bootstrap', run `bootstrap --help'.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
* Copyright information
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
|
||||
of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
|
||||
copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
|
||||
thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
|
||||
|
||||
Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
|
||||
of this document, or of portions of it,
|
||||
under the above conditions, provided also that they
|
||||
carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
|
||||
|
||||
^L
|
||||
Local Variables:
|
||||
mode: outline
|
||||
paragraph-separate: "[ ^L]*$"
|
||||
version-control: never
|
||||
End:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
20
THANKS
20
THANKS
@@ -1,11 +1,6 @@
|
||||
GNU tar THANKS file
|
||||
|
||||
Public domain tar was written by John Gilmore, with contributions
|
||||
from Henry Spencer, Fred Fish, Ian Darwin, Geoff Collyer, Stan Barber,
|
||||
Guy Harris, Dave Brower, Richard Todd, Michael Rendell, Stu Heiss and
|
||||
Rich $alz. The FSF version, named GNU tar, was derived from PDTAR by
|
||||
Jay Fenlason and Joy Kendall, and was maintained in turn by François
|
||||
Pinard, Paul Eggert and Sergey Poznyakoff.
|
||||
Please see the AUTHORS file for the list of principal authors.
|
||||
|
||||
Many people further contributed to GNU tar by reporting problems,
|
||||
suggesting various improvements or submitting actual code. Here is a
|
||||
@@ -107,9 +102,11 @@ Clinton Carr clint@netcom.com
|
||||
Conrad Hughes chughes@maths.tcd.ie
|
||||
Constantin Belous const@cris.net
|
||||
Coranth Gryphon gryphon@bur.visidyne.com
|
||||
Cyril Strejc strejc@unicontrols.cz
|
||||
Dale R. Worley worley@world.std.com
|
||||
Dale Wiles wiles@geordi.calspan.com
|
||||
Dan Bloch dan@transarc.com
|
||||
Dan Drake dan@dandrake.org
|
||||
Dan Reish dreish@izzy.net
|
||||
Daniel Hagerty hag@gnu.org
|
||||
Daniel Quinlan quinlan@pathname.com
|
||||
@@ -150,12 +147,14 @@ Drew Sullivan drew@sni.ca
|
||||
Drew Trieger trieger@woodstock.abbott.com
|
||||
Dunstan Vavasour dev@cegelecproj.co.uk
|
||||
Ed Childs echilds@bgs.com
|
||||
Ed Leaver ewleaver@comcast.net
|
||||
Edgar Taube et@immd8.informatik.uni-erlangen.de
|
||||
Eduardo Kortright eduardo@cs.ua.edu
|
||||
Eduardo V. de Rivas eddie@asterion.com
|
||||
Edward Welbourne eddy@gen.cam.ac.uk
|
||||
Elmar Heeb heeb@itp.ethz.ch
|
||||
Elmer Fittery elmerf@ptw.com
|
||||
Enric Hernandez ehernandez@notariado.org
|
||||
Eric Backus ericb@lsid.hp.com
|
||||
Eric Benson eb@amazon.com
|
||||
Eric Blake ebb9@byu.net
|
||||
@@ -222,10 +221,12 @@ Janne Snabb snabb@niksula.hut.fi
|
||||
Jason R. Mastaler jason@webmaster.net
|
||||
Jason Armistead Jason.Armistead@otis.com
|
||||
Jay Fenlason hack@gnu.org
|
||||
Jean-Louis Martineau martineau@zmanda.com
|
||||
Jean-Michel Soenen soenen@lectra.fr
|
||||
Jean-Ph. Martin-Flatin syj@ecmwf.int
|
||||
Jean-loup Gailly jloup@chorus.fr
|
||||
Jean-Loup Gailly jloup@chorus.fr
|
||||
Jeff Moskow jeff@rtr.com
|
||||
Jean-Ph. Martin-Flatin syj@ecmwf.int
|
||||
Jean-Pierre Demailly Jean-Pierre.Demailly@ujf-grenoble.fr
|
||||
Jeff Prothero jsp@betz.biostr.washington.edu
|
||||
Jeff Siegel js@hornet.att.com
|
||||
Jeff Sorensen sorenj@alumni.rpi.edu
|
||||
@@ -269,6 +270,7 @@ Jurgen Botz jbotz@orixa.mtholyoke.edu
|
||||
Jyh-Shyang Wang erik@vsp.ee.nctu.edu.tw
|
||||
Jörg Schilling schilling@fokus.fraunhofer.de
|
||||
Jörg Weule weule@cs.uni-duesseldorf.de
|
||||
Jörg Weilbier gnu@weilbier.net
|
||||
Jörgen Hågg Jorgen.Hagg@axis.se
|
||||
Jörgen Weigert jw@suse.de
|
||||
Jürgen Lüters jlueters@t-online.de
|
||||
@@ -294,6 +296,7 @@ Konno Hiroharu konno@pac.co.jp
|
||||
Kurt Jaeger pi@lf.net
|
||||
Larry Creech lcreech@lonestar.rcclub.org
|
||||
Larry Schwimmer rosebud@cyclone.stanford.edu
|
||||
Lasse Collin lasse.collin@tukaani.org
|
||||
Laurent Caillat-Vallet caillat@noe.lyon.cemagref.fr
|
||||
Laurent Sainte-Marthe smarthe@genethon.fr
|
||||
Leland Lucius llucius@tiny.net
|
||||
@@ -391,6 +394,7 @@ Pierce Cantrell cantrell@ee.tamu.edu
|
||||
R. Kent Dybvig dyb@cadence.bloomington.in.us
|
||||
R. Scott Butler butler@prism.es.dupont.com
|
||||
Rainer Orth ro@TechFak.Uni-Bielefeld.DE
|
||||
Ralf Wildenhues Ralf.Wildenhues@gmx.de
|
||||
Ralf S. Engelschall rse@engelschall.com
|
||||
Ralf Suckow suckow@contrib.de
|
||||
Ralph Corderoy ralph@inputplus.co.uk
|
||||
|
||||
10
TODO
10
TODO
@@ -1,5 +1,7 @@
|
||||
Suggestions for improving GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
* <45BEC0DB.8040903@unix-beratung.de>
|
||||
|
||||
* Incorporate fixes from major distributions, e.g., Debian GNU/Linux.
|
||||
|
||||
* Add support for restoring file time stamps to sub-second resolution,
|
||||
@@ -10,10 +12,6 @@ Suggestions for improving GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
* --append should bail out if the two archives are of different types.
|
||||
|
||||
* Add support for GNU private keywords in POSIX 1003.1-2001 headers,
|
||||
so that the GNU extensions (--incremental, --label and
|
||||
--multi-volume) may be used with POSIX archives.
|
||||
|
||||
* Add support for a 'pax' command that conforms to POSIX 1003.1-2001.
|
||||
This would unify paxutils with tar.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -47,13 +45,13 @@ so that the GNU extensions (--incremental, --label and
|
||||
|
||||
* Copyright notice
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2003, 2004, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This file is part of GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
88
acconfig.h
88
acconfig.h
@@ -1,88 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Special definitions for GNU tar, processed by autoheader.
|
||||
Copyright <20> 1994, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
Fran<61>ois Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>, 1993.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* This is unconditionally defined for setting a GNU environment. */
|
||||
#undef _GNU_SOURCE
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to a string giving the full name of the default archive file. */
|
||||
#undef DEFAULT_ARCHIVE
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to a number giving the default blocking size for archives. */
|
||||
#undef DEFAULT_BLOCKING
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if density may be indicated by [lmh] at end of device. */
|
||||
#undef DENSITY_LETTER
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to a string giving the prefix of the default device, without the
|
||||
part specifying the unit and density. */
|
||||
#undef DEVICE_PREFIX
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you lack a 3-argument version of open, and want to
|
||||
emulate it with system calls you do have. */
|
||||
#undef EMUL_OPEN3
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if NLS is requested. */
|
||||
#undef ENABLE_NLS
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define as 1 if you have catgets and don't want to use GNU gettext. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_CATGETS
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have getgrgid(3). */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_GETGRGID
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have getpwuid(3). */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_GETPWUID
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define as 1 if you have gettext and don't want to use GNU gettext. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_GETTEXT
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define if your locale.h file contains LC_MESSAGES. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_LC_MESSAGES
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if you have the valloc function. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_VALLOC
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if some rsh exists, or if you have <netdb.h>. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_RTAPELIB
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if mknod function is available. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_MKNOD
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if stpcpy function is available. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_STPCPY
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define if `union wait' is the type of the first arg to wait functions. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_UNION_WAIT
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if utime.h exists and declares struct utimbuf. */
|
||||
#undef HAVE_UTIME_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to mt_model (v.g., for DG/UX), else to mt_type. */
|
||||
#undef MTIO_CHECK_FIELD
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the name of the distribution. */
|
||||
#undef PACKAGE
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if ANSI function prototypes are usable. */
|
||||
#undef PROTOTYPES
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the full path of your rsh, if any. */
|
||||
#undef REMOTE_SHELL
|
||||
|
||||
/* Path to directory containing system wide message catalog sources. */
|
||||
#undef STD_INC_PATH
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to the version of the distribution. */
|
||||
#undef VERSION
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if using the `glocale' package for message catalogs. */
|
||||
#undef WITH_CATALOGS
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 for better use of the debugging malloc library. See
|
||||
site ftp.antaire.com in antaire/src, file dmalloc/dmalloc.tar.gz. */
|
||||
#undef WITH_DMALLOC
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define to 1 if GNU regex should be used instead of GNU rx. */
|
||||
#undef WITH_REGEX
|
||||
425
acinclude.m4
425
acinclude.m4
@@ -1,425 +0,0 @@
|
||||
## ----------------------------------------- ##
|
||||
## Find how to suppress newlines with echo. ##
|
||||
## ----------------------------------------- ##
|
||||
|
||||
# Once this macro is called, you may output with no echo in a Makefile or
|
||||
# script using: echo @ECHO_N@ "STRING_TO_OUTPUT@ECHO_C@".
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(fp_PROG_ECHO,
|
||||
[AC_MSG_CHECKING(how to suppress newlines using echo)
|
||||
AC_CACHE_VAL(fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl,
|
||||
[if (echo "testing\c"; echo 1,2,3) | grep c >/dev/null; then
|
||||
if (echo -n testing; echo 1,2,3) | sed s/-n/xn/ | grep xn >/dev/null; then
|
||||
fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl=no
|
||||
else
|
||||
fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl=option
|
||||
fi
|
||||
else
|
||||
fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl=escape
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl)
|
||||
case $fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl in
|
||||
no) ECHO_N= ECHO_C= ;;
|
||||
option) ECHO_N=-n ECHO_C= ;;
|
||||
escape) ECHO_N= ECHO_C='\c' ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
AC_SUBST(ECHO_N)dnl
|
||||
AC_SUBST(ECHO_C)dnl
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
## ------------------------------------------- ##
|
||||
## Check if --with-included-malloc was given. ##
|
||||
## From Franc,ois Pinard ##
|
||||
## ------------------------------------------- ##
|
||||
|
||||
# In 1992, Michael Bushnell (now Thomas Bushnell <thomas@gnu.ai.mit.edu>)
|
||||
# devised a test for avoiding HP/UX malloc and using GNU malloc instead.
|
||||
# Bruno Haible <haible@ma2s2.mathematik.uni-karlsruhe.de> recycled this
|
||||
# test for CLISP Common LISP and extended it to cover broken mallocs from
|
||||
# Sun and SGI. I (<pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>) reworked it a little so
|
||||
# it is independent of config.guess, and overridable by the installer.
|
||||
|
||||
# On IRIX 5.2, libc malloc is broken, but the -lmalloc one was usable.
|
||||
# So in my packages, I once unconditionally used -lmalloc if it existed.
|
||||
# This does not do anymore, because the -lmalloc malloc is broken on
|
||||
# Solaris 2.4 to 2.5.1 (alignment is 4 bytes instead of 8 bytes, as
|
||||
# reported by John Wells <john@bitsmart.com>).
|
||||
|
||||
# Bruno also notes: "HP-UX has two different malloc() implementations.
|
||||
# Both are broken. When used with CLISP, the one in the default libc.a
|
||||
# leads to a SIGSEGV, the one in libmalloc.a leads to a SIGBUS. The SunOS
|
||||
# 4.1.1 malloc() breaks when used by CLISP's generational GC. The IRIX
|
||||
# 5.2 malloc() breaks when used by CLISP's generational GC."
|
||||
|
||||
# If the installer does not give a preference, we use the included GNU
|
||||
# malloc if we have the slightest doubt that malloc could be broken, this
|
||||
# includes cross compilation, and *all* HP/UX, SunOS or IRIX systems.
|
||||
# It is crude indeed, but I just do not have enough information for truly
|
||||
# benchmarking malloc in all cases, but want safe packages nevertheless.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(fp_WITH_INCLUDED_MALLOC,
|
||||
[AC_MSG_CHECKING(if included GNU malloc is wanted)
|
||||
AC_ARG_WITH(included-malloc,
|
||||
[ --with-included-malloc use the GNU malloc which is included here], ,
|
||||
[if test $cross_compiling = yes; then
|
||||
withval=yes
|
||||
else
|
||||
case `uname -s 2> /dev/null` in
|
||||
HP-UX | SunOS | IRIX* ) withval=yes ;;
|
||||
*) withval=no ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
fi])
|
||||
test "$withval" = yes && LIBOBJS="$LIBOBJS gmalloc.o"
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($withval)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
## -------------------- ##
|
||||
## Macros from Ulrich. ##
|
||||
## -------------------- ##
|
||||
|
||||
# Search path for a program which passes the given test.
|
||||
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
|
||||
|
||||
# serial 1
|
||||
|
||||
dnl AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(VARIABLE, PROG-TO-CHECK-FOR,
|
||||
dnl TEST-PERFORMED-ON-FOUND_PROGRAM [, VALUE-IF-NOT-FOUND [, PATH]])
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST,
|
||||
[# Extract the first word of "$2", so it can be a program name with args.
|
||||
set dummy $2; ac_word=[$]2
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING([for $ac_word])
|
||||
AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_path_$1,
|
||||
[case "[$]$1" in
|
||||
/*)
|
||||
ac_cv_path_$1="[$]$1" # Let the user override the test with a path.
|
||||
;;
|
||||
*)
|
||||
IFS="${IFS= }"; ac_save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS="${IFS}:"
|
||||
for ac_dir in ifelse([$5], , $PATH, [$5]); do
|
||||
test -z "$ac_dir" && ac_dir=.
|
||||
if test -f $ac_dir/$ac_word; then
|
||||
if [$3]; then
|
||||
ac_cv_path_$1="$ac_dir/$ac_word"
|
||||
break
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
done
|
||||
IFS="$ac_save_ifs"
|
||||
dnl If no 4th arg is given, leave the cache variable unset,
|
||||
dnl so AC_PATH_PROGS will keep looking.
|
||||
ifelse([$4], , , [ test -z "[$]ac_cv_path_$1" && ac_cv_path_$1="$4"
|
||||
])dnl
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac])dnl
|
||||
$1="$ac_cv_path_$1"
|
||||
if test -n "[$]$1"; then
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT([$]$1)
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT(no)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
AC_SUBST($1)dnl
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
# Check whether LC_MESSAGES is available in <locale.h>.
|
||||
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
|
||||
|
||||
# serial 1
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(AM_LC_MESSAGES,
|
||||
[if test $ac_cv_header_locale_h = yes; then
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for LC_MESSAGES], am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_LINK([#include <locale.h>], [return LC_MESSAGES],
|
||||
am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES=yes, am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES=no)])
|
||||
if test $am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES = yes; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LC_MESSAGES)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi])
|
||||
|
||||
# Macro to add for using GNU gettext.
|
||||
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
|
||||
|
||||
# serial 1
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(AM_WITH_NLS,
|
||||
[AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether NLS is requested])
|
||||
dnl Default is enabled NLS
|
||||
AC_ARG_ENABLE(nls,
|
||||
[ --disable-nls do not use Native Language Support],
|
||||
USE_NLS=$enableval, USE_NLS=yes)
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($USE_NLS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(USE_NLS)
|
||||
|
||||
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
|
||||
|
||||
dnl If we use NLS figure out what method
|
||||
if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(ENABLE_NLS)
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether included gettext is requested])
|
||||
AC_ARG_WITH(included-gettext,
|
||||
[ --with-included-gettext use the GNU gettext library included here],
|
||||
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=$withval,
|
||||
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=no)
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext)
|
||||
|
||||
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext="$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext"
|
||||
if test "$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext" != "yes"; then
|
||||
dnl User does not insist on using GNU NLS library. Figure out what
|
||||
dnl to use. If gettext or catgets are available (in this order) we
|
||||
dnl use this. Else we have to fall back to GNU NLS library.
|
||||
dnl catgets is only used if permitted by option --with-catgets.
|
||||
nls_cv_header_intl=
|
||||
nls_cv_header_libgt=
|
||||
CATOBJEXT=NONE
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADER(libintl.h,
|
||||
[AC_CACHE_CHECK([for gettext in libc], gt_cv_func_gettext_libc,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>], [return (int) gettext ("")],
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gettext_libc=yes, gt_cv_func_gettext_libc=no)])
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$gt_cv_func_gettext_libc" != "yes"; then
|
||||
AC_CHECK_LIB(intl, bindtextdomain,
|
||||
[AC_CACHE_CHECK([for gettext in libintl],
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_LINK([], [return (int) gettext ("")],
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl=yes,
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl=no)])])
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$gt_cv_func_gettext_libc" = "yes" \
|
||||
|| test "$gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl" = "yes"; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_GETTEXT)
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
|
||||
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep 'dv '`"], no)dnl
|
||||
if test "$MSGFMT" != "no"; then
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(dcgettext)
|
||||
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
|
||||
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep '(HELP)'`"], :)
|
||||
AC_TRY_LINK(, [extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
|
||||
return _nl_msg_cat_cntr],
|
||||
[CATOBJEXT=.gmo
|
||||
DATADIRNAME=share],
|
||||
[CATOBJEXT=.mo
|
||||
DATADIRNAME=lib])
|
||||
INSTOBJEXT=.mo
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = "NONE"; then
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether catgets can be used])
|
||||
AC_ARG_WITH(catgets,
|
||||
[ --with-catgets use catgets functions if available],
|
||||
nls_cv_use_catgets=$withval, nls_cv_use_catgets=no)
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($nls_cv_use_catgets)
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$nls_cv_use_catgets" = "yes"; then
|
||||
dnl No gettext in C library. Try catgets next.
|
||||
AC_CHECK_LIB(i, main)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNC(catgets,
|
||||
[AC_DEFINE(HAVE_CATGETS)
|
||||
INTLOBJS="\$(CATOBJS)"
|
||||
AC_PATH_PROG(GENCAT, gencat, no)dnl
|
||||
if test "$GENCAT" != "no"; then
|
||||
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, no)
|
||||
if test "$GMSGFMT" = "no"; then
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(GMSGFMT, msgfmt,
|
||||
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep 'dv '`"], no)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
|
||||
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep '(HELP)'`"], :)
|
||||
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
|
||||
CATOBJEXT=.cat
|
||||
INSTOBJEXT=.cat
|
||||
DATADIRNAME=lib
|
||||
INTLDEPS="../intl/libintl.a"
|
||||
INTLLIBS=$INTLDEPS
|
||||
LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed -e 's/-lintl//'`
|
||||
nls_cv_header_intl=intl/libintl.h
|
||||
nls_cv_header_libgt=intl/libgettext.h
|
||||
fi])
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = "NONE"; then
|
||||
dnl Neither gettext nor catgets in included in the C library.
|
||||
dnl Fall back on GNU gettext library.
|
||||
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext=yes
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext" = "yes"; then
|
||||
dnl Mark actions used to generate GNU NLS library.
|
||||
INTLOBJS="\$(GETTOBJS)"
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
|
||||
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep 'dv '`"], msgfmt)
|
||||
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
|
||||
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep '(HELP)'`"], :)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(MSGFMT)
|
||||
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
|
||||
CATOBJEXT=.gmo
|
||||
INSTOBJEXT=.mo
|
||||
DATADIRNAME=share
|
||||
INTLDEPS="../intl/libintl.a"
|
||||
INTLLIBS=$INTLDEPS
|
||||
LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed -e 's/-lintl//'`
|
||||
nls_cv_header_intl=intl/libintl.h
|
||||
nls_cv_header_libgt=intl/libgettext.h
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Test whether we really found GNU xgettext.
|
||||
if test "$XGETTEXT" != ":"; then
|
||||
dnl If it is no GNU xgettext we define it as : so that the
|
||||
dnl Makefiles still can work.
|
||||
if $XGETTEXT --omit-header /dev/null 2> /dev/null; then
|
||||
: ;
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT(
|
||||
[found xgettext programs is not GNU xgettext; ignore it])
|
||||
XGETTEXT=":"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# We need to process the po/ directory.
|
||||
POSUB=po
|
||||
else
|
||||
DATADIRNAME=share
|
||||
nls_cv_header_intl=intl/libintl.h
|
||||
nls_cv_header_libgt=intl/libgettext.h
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# If this is used in GNU gettext we have to set USE_NLS to `yes'
|
||||
# because some of the sources are only built for this goal.
|
||||
if test "$PACKAGE" = gettext; then
|
||||
USE_NLS=yes
|
||||
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl These rules are solely for the distribution goal. While doing this
|
||||
dnl we only have to keep exactly one list of the available catalogs
|
||||
dnl in configure.in.
|
||||
for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
|
||||
GMOFILES="$GMOFILES $lang.gmo"
|
||||
POFILES="$POFILES $lang.po"
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Make all variables we use known to autoconf.
|
||||
AC_SUBST(USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(CATALOGS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(CATOBJEXT)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(DATADIRNAME)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(GMOFILES)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INSTOBJEXT)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INTLDEPS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INTLLIBS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INTLOBJS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(POFILES)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(POSUB)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(AM_GNU_GETTEXT,
|
||||
[AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_MAKE_SET])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_ISC_POSIX])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_RANLIB])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_HEADER_STDC])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_CONST])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_INLINE])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_OFF_T])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_SIZE_T])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_ALLOCA])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_MMAP])dnl
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS([argz.h limits.h locale.h nl_types.h malloc.h string.h \
|
||||
unistd.h values.h])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS([getcwd munmap putenv setenv setlocale strchr strcasecmp \
|
||||
__argz_count __argz_stringify __argz_next])
|
||||
|
||||
if test "${ac_cv_func_stpcpy+set}" != "set"; then
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(stpcpy)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
if test "${ac_cv_func_stpcpy}" = "yes"; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_STPCPY)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
AM_LC_MESSAGES
|
||||
AM_WITH_NLS
|
||||
|
||||
if test "x$CATOBJEXT" != "x"; then
|
||||
if test "x$ALL_LINGUAS" = "x"; then
|
||||
LINGUAS=
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING(for catalogs to be installed)
|
||||
NEW_LINGUAS=
|
||||
for lang in ${LINGUAS=$ALL_LINGUAS}; do
|
||||
case "$ALL_LINGUAS" in
|
||||
*$lang*) NEW_LINGUAS="$NEW_LINGUAS $lang" ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
done
|
||||
LINGUAS=$NEW_LINGUAS
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($LINGUAS)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Construct list of names of catalog files to be constructed.
|
||||
if test -n "$LINGUAS"; then
|
||||
for lang in $LINGUAS; do CATALOGS="$CATALOGS $lang$CATOBJEXT"; done
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Determine which catalog format we have (if any is needed)
|
||||
dnl For now we know about two different formats:
|
||||
dnl Linux libc-5 and the normal X/Open format
|
||||
test -d intl || mkdir intl
|
||||
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = ".cat"; then
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADER(linux/version.h, msgformat=linux, msgformat=xopen)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Transform the SED scripts while copying because some dumb SEDs
|
||||
dnl cannot handle comments.
|
||||
sed -e '/^#/d' $srcdir/intl/$msgformat-msg.sed > intl/po2msg.sed
|
||||
fi
|
||||
dnl po2tbl.sed is always needed.
|
||||
sed -e '/^#.*[^\\]$/d' -e '/^#$/d' \
|
||||
$srcdir/intl/po2tbl.sed.in > intl/po2tbl.sed
|
||||
|
||||
dnl In the intl/Makefile.in we have a special dependency which makes
|
||||
dnl only sense for gettext. We comment this out for non-gettext
|
||||
dnl packages.
|
||||
if test "$PACKAGE" = "gettext"; then
|
||||
GT_NO="#NO#"
|
||||
GT_YES=
|
||||
else
|
||||
GT_NO=
|
||||
GT_YES="#YES#"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
AC_SUBST(GT_NO)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(GT_YES)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl If the AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR macro for autoconf is used we possibly
|
||||
dnl find the mkinstalldirs script in another subdir but ($top_srcdir).
|
||||
dnl Try to locate is.
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS=
|
||||
if test $ac_aux_dir; then
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS="$ac_aux_dir/mkinstalldirs"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
if test -z $MKINSTALLDIRS; then
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS="\$(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
AC_SUBST(MKINSTALLDIRS)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Generate list of files to be processed by xgettext which will
|
||||
dnl be included in po/Makefile.
|
||||
test -d po || mkdir po
|
||||
if test "x$srcdir" != "x."; then
|
||||
if test "x`echo $srcdir | sed 's@/.*@@'`" = "x"; then
|
||||
posrcprefix="$srcdir/"
|
||||
else
|
||||
posrcprefix="../$srcdir/"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
else
|
||||
posrcprefix="../"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
sed -e "/^#/d" -e "/^\$/d" -e "s,.*, $posrcprefix& \\\\," -e "\$s/\(.*\) \\\\/\1/" \
|
||||
< $srcdir/po/POTFILES.in > po/POTFILES
|
||||
])
|
||||
844
bootstrap
844
bootstrap
@@ -1,13 +1,13 @@
|
||||
#! /bin/sh
|
||||
|
||||
# Bootstrap 'tar' from CVS.
|
||||
# Bootstrap this package from checked-out sources.
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2003-2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
# any later version.
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
|
||||
# (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
@@ -15,83 +15,160 @@
|
||||
# GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
|
||||
# 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
|
||||
|
||||
# Written by Paul Eggert and Sergey Poznyakoff.
|
||||
|
||||
# URL of our text domain page in Translation Project
|
||||
TP_URL="http://www.iro.umontreal.ca/translation/maint/tar/"
|
||||
nl='
|
||||
'
|
||||
|
||||
# Ensure file names are sorted consistently across platforms;
|
||||
# e.g., m4/ulonglong_gl.m4 should follow m4/ulonglong.m4.
|
||||
# Ensure file names are sorted consistently across platforms.
|
||||
LC_ALL=C
|
||||
export LC_ALL
|
||||
|
||||
local_gl_dir=gl
|
||||
|
||||
# Temporary directory names.
|
||||
bt='._bootmp'
|
||||
bt_regex=`echo "$bt"| sed 's/\./[.]/g'`
|
||||
bt2=${bt}2
|
||||
|
||||
usage() {
|
||||
cat <<EOF
|
||||
usage: $0 [--gnulib-srcdir=DIR][--paxutils-srcdir=DIR][--cvs-auth=AUTH-METHOD][--cvs-user=USERNAME][--no-po]
|
||||
Options are:
|
||||
--paxutils-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where paxutils
|
||||
sources reside. Use this if you already
|
||||
have paxutils sources on your machine, and
|
||||
do not want to waste your bandwidth dowloading
|
||||
them again.
|
||||
--gnulib-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where gnulib
|
||||
sources reside. Use this if you already
|
||||
have gnulib sources on your machine, and
|
||||
do not want to waste your bandwidth dowloading
|
||||
them again.
|
||||
--cvs-auth=METHOD Set the CVS access method used for downloading
|
||||
gnulib files. METHOD is one of the keywords
|
||||
accepted by cvs -d option (see info cvs
|
||||
repository).
|
||||
--cvs-user=USERNAME Set the CVS username to be used when accessing
|
||||
the gnulib repository.
|
||||
--no-po Do not download po files.
|
||||
--update-po[=LANG] Update po file(s) and exit.
|
||||
echo >&2 "\
|
||||
Usage: $0 [OPTION]...
|
||||
Bootstrap this package from the checked-out sources.
|
||||
|
||||
If the file \`.bootstrap' exists in the current working directory, its
|
||||
contents is read, comments and empty lines removed, shell variables expanded
|
||||
and the result is prepended to the command line options.
|
||||
Options:
|
||||
--paxutils-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where paxutils
|
||||
sources reside. Use this if you already
|
||||
have paxutils sources on your machine, and
|
||||
do not want to waste your bandwidth dowloading
|
||||
them again.
|
||||
--gnulib-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where gnulib
|
||||
sources reside. Use this if you already
|
||||
have gnulib sources on your machine, and
|
||||
do not want to waste your bandwidth downloading
|
||||
them again.
|
||||
--copy Copy files instead of creating symbolic links.
|
||||
--force Attempt to bootstrap even if the sources seem
|
||||
not to have been checked out.
|
||||
--skip-po Do not download po files.
|
||||
|
||||
Running without arguments will suffice in most cases. It is equivalent
|
||||
to
|
||||
If the file $0.conf exists in the same directory as this script, its
|
||||
contents are read as shell variables to configure the bootstrap.
|
||||
|
||||
./bootstrap --cvs-auth=pserver
|
||||
|
||||
EOF
|
||||
Running without arguments will suffice in most cases.
|
||||
"
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
update_po() {
|
||||
if [ $# = 1 ]; then
|
||||
case $1 in
|
||||
*.po) POFILE=$1;;
|
||||
*) POFILE=${1}.po;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
echo "$0: getting translation for $1..."
|
||||
wget -r --cache=off $TP_URL/$POFILE
|
||||
else
|
||||
echo "$0: getting translations into po..."
|
||||
(cd po &&
|
||||
rm -f dummy `ls | sed -n '/\.gmo$/p; /\.po/p'` &&
|
||||
wget -nv -nd -r -l 1 -A .po --cache off $TP_URL &&
|
||||
rm -f index.html index.html.[0-9]*
|
||||
ls *.po | sed 's/\.po$//' >LINGUAS
|
||||
) || exit
|
||||
fi
|
||||
}
|
||||
# Configuration.
|
||||
|
||||
# Read configuration file
|
||||
if [ -r .bootstrap ]; then
|
||||
echo "$0: Reading configuration file .bootstrap"
|
||||
eval set -- "`sed 's/#.*$//;/^$/d' .bootstrap | tr '\n' ' '` $*"
|
||||
# Name of the Makefile.am
|
||||
gnulib_mk=gnulib.mk
|
||||
|
||||
# List of gnulib modules needed.
|
||||
gnulib_modules=
|
||||
|
||||
# Any gnulib files needed that are not in modules.
|
||||
gnulib_files=
|
||||
|
||||
# The command to download all .po files for a specified domain into
|
||||
# a specified directory. Fill in the first %s is the domain name, and
|
||||
# the second with the destination directory. Use rsync's -L and -r
|
||||
# options because the latest/%s directory and the .po files within are
|
||||
# all symlinks.
|
||||
po_download_command_format=\
|
||||
"rsync -Lrtvz 'translationproject.org::tp/latest/%s/' '%s'"
|
||||
|
||||
extract_package_name='
|
||||
/^AC_INIT(/{
|
||||
/.*,.*,.*, */{
|
||||
s///
|
||||
s/[][]//g
|
||||
s/)$//
|
||||
p
|
||||
q
|
||||
}
|
||||
s/AC_INIT(\[*//
|
||||
s/]*,.*//
|
||||
s/^GNU //
|
||||
y/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/
|
||||
s/[^A-Za-z0-9_]/-/g
|
||||
p
|
||||
}
|
||||
'
|
||||
package=`sed -n "$extract_package_name" configure.ac` || exit
|
||||
gnulib_name=lib$package
|
||||
|
||||
build_aux=build-aux
|
||||
source_base=lib
|
||||
m4_base=m4
|
||||
doc_base=doc
|
||||
tests_base=tests
|
||||
|
||||
# Extra files from gnulib, which override files from other sources.
|
||||
gnulib_extra_files="
|
||||
$build_aux/install-sh
|
||||
$build_aux/missing
|
||||
$build_aux/mdate-sh
|
||||
$build_aux/texinfo.tex
|
||||
$build_aux/depcomp
|
||||
$build_aux/config.guess
|
||||
$build_aux/config.sub
|
||||
doc/INSTALL
|
||||
"
|
||||
|
||||
# Additional gnulib-tool options to use. Use "\newline" to break lines.
|
||||
gnulib_tool_option_extras=
|
||||
|
||||
# Other locale categories that need message catalogs.
|
||||
EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES=
|
||||
|
||||
# Additional xgettext options to use. Use "\\\newline" to break lines.
|
||||
XGETTEXT_OPTIONS='\\\
|
||||
--flag=_:1:pass-c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=N_:1:pass-c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=error:3:c-format --flag=error_at_line:5:c-format\\\
|
||||
'
|
||||
|
||||
# Package bug report address for gettext files
|
||||
MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS=bug-$package@gnu.org
|
||||
|
||||
# Files we don't want to import.
|
||||
excluded_files=
|
||||
|
||||
# File that should exist in the top directory of a checked out hierarchy,
|
||||
# but not in a distribution tarball.
|
||||
checkout_only_file=README-hacking
|
||||
|
||||
# Whether to use copies instead of symlinks.
|
||||
copy=false
|
||||
|
||||
# Set this to '.cvsignore .gitignore' in bootstrap.conf if you want
|
||||
# those files to be generated in directories like lib/, m4/, and po/.
|
||||
# Or set it to 'auto' to make this script select which to use based
|
||||
# on which version control system (if any) is used in the source directory.
|
||||
vc_ignore=auto
|
||||
|
||||
# Override the default configuration, if necessary.
|
||||
# Make sure that bootstrap.conf is sourced from the current directory
|
||||
# if we were invoked as "sh bootstrap".
|
||||
case "$0" in
|
||||
*/*) test -r "$0.conf" && . "$0.conf" ;;
|
||||
*) test -r "$0.conf" && . ./"$0.conf" ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$vc_ignore" = auto; then
|
||||
vc_ignore=
|
||||
test -d .git && vc_ignore=.gitignore
|
||||
test -d CVS && vc_ignore="$vc_ignore .cvsignore"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# Translate configuration into internal form.
|
||||
|
||||
# Parse options.
|
||||
|
||||
DOWNLOAD_PO=yes
|
||||
for option
|
||||
do
|
||||
case $option in
|
||||
@@ -99,95 +176,445 @@ do
|
||||
usage
|
||||
exit;;
|
||||
--gnulib-srcdir=*)
|
||||
GNULIB_SRCDIR=`expr "$option" : '--gnulib-srcdir=\(.*\)'`;;
|
||||
GNULIB_SRCDIR=`expr "X$option" : 'X--gnulib-srcdir=\(.*\)'`;;
|
||||
--paxutils-srcdir=*)
|
||||
PAXUTILS_SRCDIR=`expr "$option" : '--paxutils-srcdir=\(.*\)'`;;
|
||||
--cvs-auth=*)
|
||||
CVS_AUTH=`expr "$option" : '--cvs-auth=\(.*\)'`;;
|
||||
--cvs-user=*)
|
||||
CVS_USER=`expr "$option" : '--cvs-user=\(.*\)'`;;
|
||||
--no-po)
|
||||
DOWNLOAD_PO=no;;
|
||||
--update-po=*)
|
||||
DOWNLOAD_PO=`expr "$option" : '--update-po=\(.*\)'`;;
|
||||
--update-po)
|
||||
DOWNLOAD_PO=only;;
|
||||
--skip-po)
|
||||
SKIP_PO=t;;
|
||||
--force)
|
||||
checkout_only_file=;;
|
||||
--copy)
|
||||
copy=true;;
|
||||
*)
|
||||
echo >&2 "$0: $option: unknown option"
|
||||
exit 1;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
case $DOWNLOAD_PO in
|
||||
only) update_po
|
||||
exit 0
|
||||
;;
|
||||
no|yes) ;;
|
||||
*) update_po $DOWNLOAD_PO
|
||||
exit 0
|
||||
if test -n "$checkout_only_file" && test ! -r "$checkout_only_file"; then
|
||||
echo "$0: Bootstrapping from a non-checked-out distribution is risky." >&2
|
||||
exit 1
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# If $STR is not already on a line by itself in $FILE, insert it,
|
||||
# sorting the new contents of the file and replacing $FILE with the result.
|
||||
insert_sorted_if_absent() {
|
||||
file=$1
|
||||
str=$2
|
||||
test -f $file || touch $file
|
||||
echo "$str" | sort -u - $file | cmp -s - $file \
|
||||
|| echo "$str" | sort -u - $file -o $file \
|
||||
|| exit 1
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# Die if there is no AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR($build_aux) line in configure.ac.
|
||||
found_aux_dir=no
|
||||
grep '^[ ]*AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR(\['"$build_aux"'\])' configure.ac \
|
||||
>/dev/null && found_aux_dir=yes
|
||||
grep '^[ ]*AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR('"$build_aux"')' configure.ac \
|
||||
>/dev/null && found_aux_dir=yes
|
||||
if test $found_aux_dir = no; then
|
||||
echo "$0: expected line not found in configure.ac. Add the following:" >&2
|
||||
echo " AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR([$build_aux])" >&2
|
||||
exit 1
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# If $build_aux doesn't exist, create it now, otherwise some bits
|
||||
# below will malfunction. If creating it, also mark it as ignored.
|
||||
if test ! -d $build_aux; then
|
||||
mkdir $build_aux
|
||||
for dot_ig in x $vc_ignore; do
|
||||
test $dot_ig = x && continue
|
||||
insert_sorted_if_absent $dot_ig $build_aux
|
||||
done
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
echo "$0: Bootstrapping from checked-out $package sources..."
|
||||
|
||||
# See if we can use gnulib's git-merge-changelog merge driver.
|
||||
if test -d .git && (git --version) >/dev/null 2>/dev/null ; then
|
||||
if git config merge.merge-changelog.driver >/dev/null ; then
|
||||
:
|
||||
elif (git-merge-changelog --version) >/dev/null 2>/dev/null ; then
|
||||
echo "initializing git-merge-changelog driver"
|
||||
git config merge.merge-changelog.name 'GNU-style ChangeLog merge driver'
|
||||
git config merge.merge-changelog.driver 'git-merge-changelog %O %A %B'
|
||||
else
|
||||
echo "consider installing git-merge-changelog from gnulib"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
cleanup() {
|
||||
status=$?
|
||||
rm -fr $1
|
||||
exit $status
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
git_modules_config () {
|
||||
GIT_CONFIG_LOCAL=.gitmodules git config "$@"
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# Get paxutils files.
|
||||
case ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR--} in
|
||||
-) if [ ! -d paxutils ]; then
|
||||
echo "$0: getting paxutils files..."
|
||||
|
||||
trap "cleanup paxutils" 1 2 13 15
|
||||
|
||||
git clone --depth 1 git://git.sv.gnu.org/paxutils || cleanup paxutils
|
||||
|
||||
trap - 1 2 13 15
|
||||
fi
|
||||
PAXUTILS_SRCDIR=paxutils
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
echo "$0: Bootstrapping CVS tar..."
|
||||
if [ -r $PAXUTILS_SRCDIR/gnulib.modules ]; then
|
||||
gnulib_modules=`
|
||||
(echo "$gnulib_modules"; grep '^[^#]' $PAXUTILS_SRCDIR/gnulib.modules) |
|
||||
sort -u
|
||||
`
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
build_cvs_prefix() {
|
||||
CVS_PREFIX=:${1}:
|
||||
if [ "${2}" != - ]; then
|
||||
CVS_PREFIX=${CVS_PREFIX}${2}@
|
||||
# Get gnulib files.
|
||||
|
||||
case ${GNULIB_SRCDIR--} in
|
||||
-)
|
||||
if git_modules_config submodule.gnulib.url >/dev/null; then
|
||||
echo "$0: getting gnulib files..."
|
||||
git submodule init || exit $?
|
||||
git submodule update || exit $?
|
||||
|
||||
elif [ ! -d gnulib ]; then
|
||||
echo "$0: getting gnulib files..."
|
||||
|
||||
trap cleanup_gnulib 1 2 13 15
|
||||
|
||||
git clone --help|grep depth > /dev/null && shallow='--depth 2' || shallow=
|
||||
git clone $shallow git://git.sv.gnu.org/gnulib ||
|
||||
"cleanup $1"
|
||||
|
||||
trap - 1 2 13 15
|
||||
fi
|
||||
if [ "$1" = "ext" ]; then
|
||||
if [ -z "${CVS_RSH}" ]; then
|
||||
CVS_RSH=ssh
|
||||
export CVS_RSH
|
||||
GNULIB_SRCDIR=gnulib
|
||||
;;
|
||||
*)
|
||||
# Redirect the gnulib submodule to the directory on the command line
|
||||
# if possible.
|
||||
if test -d "$GNULIB_SRCDIR"/.git && \
|
||||
git_modules_config submodule.gnulib.url >/dev/null; then
|
||||
git submodule init
|
||||
GNULIB_SRCDIR=`cd $GNULIB_SRCDIR && pwd`
|
||||
git config --replace-all submodule.gnulib.url $GNULIB_SRCDIR
|
||||
echo "$0: getting gnulib files..."
|
||||
git submodule update || exit $?
|
||||
GNULIB_SRCDIR=gnulib
|
||||
fi
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
gnulib_tool=$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool
|
||||
<$gnulib_tool || exit
|
||||
|
||||
# Get translations.
|
||||
|
||||
download_po_files() {
|
||||
subdir=$1
|
||||
domain=$2
|
||||
echo "$0: getting translations into $subdir for $domain..."
|
||||
cmd=`printf "$po_download_command_format" "$domain" "$subdir"`
|
||||
eval "$cmd"
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# Download .po files to $po_dir/.reference and copy only the new
|
||||
# or modified ones into $po_dir. Also update $po_dir/LINGUAS.
|
||||
update_po_files() {
|
||||
# Directory containing primary .po files.
|
||||
# Overwrite them only when we're sure a .po file is new.
|
||||
po_dir=$1
|
||||
domain=$2
|
||||
|
||||
# Download *.po files into this dir.
|
||||
# Usually contains *.s1 checksum files.
|
||||
ref_po_dir="$po_dir/.reference"
|
||||
|
||||
test -d $ref_po_dir || mkdir $ref_po_dir || return
|
||||
download_po_files $ref_po_dir $domain \
|
||||
&& ls "$ref_po_dir"/*.po 2>/dev/null |
|
||||
sed 's|.*/||; s|\.po$||' > "$po_dir/LINGUAS"
|
||||
|
||||
langs=`cd $ref_po_dir && echo *.po|sed 's/\.po//g'`
|
||||
test "$langs" = '*' && langs=x
|
||||
for po in $langs; do
|
||||
case $po in x) continue;; esac
|
||||
new_po="$ref_po_dir/$po.po"
|
||||
cksum_file="$ref_po_dir/$po.s1"
|
||||
if ! test -f "$cksum_file" ||
|
||||
! test -f "$po_dir/$po.po" ||
|
||||
! sha1sum -c --status "$cksum_file" < "$new_po" > /dev/null; then
|
||||
echo "updated $po_dir/$po.po..."
|
||||
cp "$new_po" "$po_dir/$po.po" && sha1sum < "$new_po" > "$cksum_file"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
done
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
case $SKIP_PO in
|
||||
'')
|
||||
if test -d po; then
|
||||
update_po_files po $package || exit
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if test -d runtime-po; then
|
||||
update_po_files runtime-po $package-runtime || exit
|
||||
fi;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
symlink_to_dir()
|
||||
{
|
||||
src=$1/$2
|
||||
dst=${3-$2}
|
||||
|
||||
test -f "$src" && {
|
||||
|
||||
# If the destination directory doesn't exist, create it.
|
||||
# This is required at least for "lib/uniwidth/cjk.h".
|
||||
dst_dir=`dirname "$dst"`
|
||||
if ! test -d "$dst_dir"; then
|
||||
mkdir -p "$dst_dir"
|
||||
|
||||
# If we've just created a directory like lib/uniwidth,
|
||||
# tell version control system(s) it's ignorable.
|
||||
# FIXME: for now, this does only one level
|
||||
parent=`dirname "$dst_dir"`
|
||||
for dot_ig in x $vc_ignore; do
|
||||
test $dot_ig = x && continue
|
||||
ig=$parent/$dot_ig
|
||||
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig `echo "$dst_dir"|sed 's,.*/,,'`
|
||||
done
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if $copy; then
|
||||
{
|
||||
test ! -h "$dst" || {
|
||||
echo "$0: rm -f $dst" &&
|
||||
rm -f "$dst"
|
||||
}
|
||||
} &&
|
||||
test -f "$dst" &&
|
||||
cmp -s "$src" "$dst" || {
|
||||
echo "$0: cp -fp $src $dst" &&
|
||||
cp -fp "$src" "$dst"
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
test -h "$dst" &&
|
||||
src_ls=`ls -diL "$src" 2>/dev/null` && set $src_ls && src_i=$1 &&
|
||||
dst_ls=`ls -diL "$dst" 2>/dev/null` && set $dst_ls && dst_i=$1 &&
|
||||
test "$src_i" = "$dst_i" || {
|
||||
dot_dots=
|
||||
case $src in
|
||||
/*) ;;
|
||||
*)
|
||||
case /$dst/ in
|
||||
*//* | */../* | */./* | /*/*/*/*/*/)
|
||||
echo >&2 "$0: invalid symlink calculation: $src -> $dst"
|
||||
exit 1;;
|
||||
/*/*/*/*/) dot_dots=../../../;;
|
||||
/*/*/*/) dot_dots=../../;;
|
||||
/*/*/) dot_dots=../;;
|
||||
esac;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
echo "$0: ln -fs $dot_dots$src $dst" &&
|
||||
ln -fs "$dot_dots$src" "$dst"
|
||||
}
|
||||
fi
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
cp_mark_as_generated()
|
||||
{
|
||||
cp_src=$1
|
||||
cp_dst=$2
|
||||
|
||||
if cmp -s "$cp_src" "$GNULIB_SRCDIR/$cp_dst"; then
|
||||
symlink_to_dir "$GNULIB_SRCDIR" "$cp_dst"
|
||||
elif cmp -s "$cp_src" "$local_gl_dir/$cp_dst"; then
|
||||
symlink_to_dir $local_gl_dir "$cp_dst"
|
||||
else
|
||||
case $cp_dst in
|
||||
*.[ch]) c1='/* '; c2=' */';;
|
||||
*.texi) c1='@c '; c2= ;;
|
||||
*.m4|*/Make*|Make*) c1='# ' ; c2= ;;
|
||||
*) c1= ; c2= ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
# If the destination directory doesn't exist, create it.
|
||||
# This is required at least for "lib/uniwidth/cjk.h".
|
||||
dst_dir=`dirname "$cp_dst"`
|
||||
test -d "$dst_dir" || mkdir -p "$dst_dir"
|
||||
|
||||
if test -z "$c1"; then
|
||||
cmp -s "$cp_src" "$cp_dst" || {
|
||||
# Copy the file first to get proper permissions if it
|
||||
# doesn't already exist. Then overwrite the copy.
|
||||
echo "$0: cp -f $cp_src $cp_dst" &&
|
||||
rm -f "$cp_dst" &&
|
||||
cp "$cp_src" "$cp_dst-t" &&
|
||||
sed "s!$bt_regex/!!g" "$cp_src" > "$cp_dst-t" &&
|
||||
mv -f "$cp_dst-t" "$cp_dst"
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
# Copy the file first to get proper permissions if it
|
||||
# doesn't already exist. Then overwrite the copy.
|
||||
cp "$cp_src" "$cp_dst-t" &&
|
||||
(
|
||||
echo "$c1-*- buffer-read-only: t -*- vi: set ro:$c2" &&
|
||||
echo "${c1}DO NOT EDIT! GENERATED AUTOMATICALLY!$c2" &&
|
||||
sed "s!$bt_regex/!!g" "$cp_src"
|
||||
) > $cp_dst-t &&
|
||||
if cmp -s "$cp_dst-t" "$cp_dst"; then
|
||||
rm -f "$cp_dst-t"
|
||||
else
|
||||
echo "$0: cp $cp_src $cp_dst # with edits" &&
|
||||
mv -f "$cp_dst-t" "$cp_dst"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# checkout package
|
||||
checkout() {
|
||||
if [ ! -d $1 ]; then
|
||||
echo "$0: getting $1 files..."
|
||||
|
||||
trap exit 1 2 13 15
|
||||
trap 'rm -fr $1; exit 1' 0
|
||||
|
||||
case "${CVS_AUTH-pserver}" in
|
||||
pserver) build_cvs_prefix pserver ${CVS_USER:-anonymous}
|
||||
;;
|
||||
gserver|server)
|
||||
build_cvs_prefix $CVS_AUTH ${CVS_USER--}
|
||||
;;
|
||||
ext) build_cvs_prefix $CVS_AUTH ${CVS_USER--}
|
||||
;;
|
||||
*) echo "$0: Unknown CVS access method" >&2
|
||||
exit 1;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
cvs -q -d ${CVS_PREFIX}cvs.sv.gnu.org:/cvsroot/$1 co $1 || exit
|
||||
|
||||
trap - 0
|
||||
version_controlled_file() {
|
||||
dir=$1
|
||||
file=$2
|
||||
found=no
|
||||
if test -d CVS; then
|
||||
grep -F "/$file/" $dir/CVS/Entries 2>/dev/null |
|
||||
grep '^/[^/]*/[0-9]' > /dev/null && found=yes
|
||||
elif test -d .git; then
|
||||
git rm -n "$dir/$file" > /dev/null 2>&1 && found=yes
|
||||
elif test -d .svn; then
|
||||
svn log -r HEAD "$dir/$file" > /dev/null 2>&1 && found=yes
|
||||
else
|
||||
echo "$0: no version control for $dir/$file?" >&2
|
||||
fi
|
||||
test $found = yes
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
gnulib_modules=
|
||||
newline='
|
||||
'
|
||||
slurp() {
|
||||
for dir in . `(cd $1 && find * -type d -print)`; do
|
||||
copied=
|
||||
sep=
|
||||
for file in `ls -a $1/$dir`; do
|
||||
case $file in
|
||||
.|..) continue;;
|
||||
.*) continue;; # FIXME: should all file names starting with "." be ignored?
|
||||
esac
|
||||
test -d $1/$dir/$file && continue
|
||||
for excluded_file in $excluded_files; do
|
||||
test "$dir/$file" = "$excluded_file" && continue 2
|
||||
done
|
||||
if test $file = Makefile.am; then
|
||||
copied=$copied${sep}$gnulib_mk; sep=$nl
|
||||
remove_intl='/^[^#].*\/intl/s/^/#/;'"s!$bt_regex/!!g"
|
||||
sed "$remove_intl" $1/$dir/$file | cmp -s - $dir/$gnulib_mk || {
|
||||
echo "$0: Copying $1/$dir/$file to $dir/$gnulib_mk ..." &&
|
||||
rm -f $dir/$gnulib_mk &&
|
||||
sed "$remove_intl" $1/$dir/$file >$dir/$gnulib_mk
|
||||
}
|
||||
elif { test "${2+set}" = set && test -r $2/$dir/$file; } ||
|
||||
version_controlled_file $dir $file; then
|
||||
echo "$0: $dir/$file overrides $1/$dir/$file"
|
||||
else
|
||||
copied=$copied$sep$file; sep=$nl
|
||||
if test $file = gettext.m4; then
|
||||
echo "$0: patching m4/gettext.m4 to remove need for intl/* ..."
|
||||
rm -f $dir/$file
|
||||
sed '
|
||||
/^AC_DEFUN(\[AM_INTL_SUBDIR],/,/^]/c\
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([AM_INTL_SUBDIR], [
|
||||
/^AC_DEFUN(\[gt_INTL_SUBDIR_CORE],/,/^]/c\
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([gt_INTL_SUBDIR_CORE], [])
|
||||
$a\
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([gl_LOCK_EARLY], [])
|
||||
' $1/$dir/$file >$dir/$file
|
||||
else
|
||||
cp_mark_as_generated $1/$dir/$file $dir/$file
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi || exit
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
get_modules() {
|
||||
new_gnulib_modules=`sed '/^[ ]*#/d; /^[ ]*$/d' $*`
|
||||
case $gnulib_modules,$new_gnulib_modules in
|
||||
?*,?*) new_gnulib_modules=$newline$new_gnulib_modules;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
gnulib_modules=$gnulib_modules$new_gnulib_modules
|
||||
for dot_ig in x $vc_ignore; do
|
||||
test $dot_ig = x && continue
|
||||
ig=$dir/$dot_ig
|
||||
if test -n "$copied"; then
|
||||
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig "$copied"
|
||||
# If an ignored file name ends with .in.h, then also add
|
||||
# the name with just ".h". Many gnulib headers are generated,
|
||||
# e.g., stdint.in.h -> stdint.h, dirent.in.h ->..., etc.
|
||||
# Likewise for .gperf -> .h, .y -> .c, and .sin -> .sed
|
||||
f=`echo "$copied"|sed 's/\.in\.h$/.h/;s/\.sin$/.sed/;s/\.y$/.c/;s/\.gperf$/.h/'`
|
||||
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig "$f"
|
||||
|
||||
# For files like sys_stat.in.h and sys_time.in.h, record as
|
||||
# ignorable the directory we might eventually create: sys/.
|
||||
f=`echo "$copied"|sed 's/sys_.*\.in\.h$/sys/'`
|
||||
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig "$f"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
done
|
||||
done
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# Get paxutils files
|
||||
case ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR--} in
|
||||
-) checkout paxutils
|
||||
PAXUTILS_SRCDIR=paxutils
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
if [ -r $PAXUTILS_SRCDIR/gnulib.modules ]; then
|
||||
get_modules $PAXUTILS_SRCDIR/gnulib.modules
|
||||
# Create boot temporary directories to import from gnulib and gettext.
|
||||
rm -fr $bt $bt2 &&
|
||||
mkdir $bt $bt2 || exit
|
||||
|
||||
# Import from gnulib.
|
||||
|
||||
gnulib_tool_options="\
|
||||
--import\
|
||||
--no-changelog\
|
||||
--aux-dir $bt/$build_aux\
|
||||
--doc-base $bt/$doc_base\
|
||||
--lib $gnulib_name\
|
||||
--m4-base $bt/$m4_base/\
|
||||
--source-base $bt/$source_base/\
|
||||
--tests-base $bt/$tests_base\
|
||||
--local-dir $local_gl_dir\
|
||||
$gnulib_tool_option_extras\
|
||||
"
|
||||
echo "$0: $gnulib_tool $gnulib_tool_options --import ..."
|
||||
$gnulib_tool $gnulib_tool_options --import $gnulib_modules &&
|
||||
slurp $bt || exit
|
||||
|
||||
for file in $gnulib_files; do
|
||||
symlink_to_dir "$GNULIB_SRCDIR" $file || exit
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Import from gettext.
|
||||
with_gettext=yes
|
||||
grep '^[ ]*AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION(' configure.ac >/dev/null || \
|
||||
with_gettext=no
|
||||
|
||||
if test $with_gettext = yes; then
|
||||
echo "$0: (cd $bt2; autopoint) ..."
|
||||
cp configure.ac $bt2 &&
|
||||
(cd $bt2 && autopoint && rm configure.ac) &&
|
||||
slurp $bt2 $bt || exit
|
||||
fi
|
||||
rm -fr $bt $bt2 || exit
|
||||
|
||||
# Remove any dangling symlink matching "*.m4" or "*.[ch]" in some
|
||||
# gnulib-populated directories. Such .m4 files would cause aclocal to fail.
|
||||
# The following requires GNU find 4.2.3 or newer. Considering the usual
|
||||
# portability constraints of this script, that may seem a very demanding
|
||||
# requirement, but it should be ok. Ignore any failure, which is fine,
|
||||
# since this is only a convenience to help developers avoid the relatively
|
||||
# unusual case in which a symlinked-to .m4 file is git-removed from gnulib
|
||||
# between successive runs of this script.
|
||||
find "$m4_base" "$source_base" \
|
||||
-depth \( -name '*.m4' -o -name '*.[ch]' \) \
|
||||
-type l -xtype l -delete > /dev/null 2>&1
|
||||
|
||||
# copy_files srcdir dstdir
|
||||
copy_files() {
|
||||
@@ -203,18 +630,21 @@ copy_files() {
|
||||
*) dst=${3}$dst;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
fi
|
||||
echo "$0: Copying file $1/$file to $2/$dst"
|
||||
cp -p $1/$file $2/$dst
|
||||
symlink_to_dir "$1" "$file" "$2/$dst" || exit
|
||||
# FIXME ignorefile $2 $dst
|
||||
done
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/m4 m4
|
||||
# Import from paxutils
|
||||
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR} .
|
||||
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/am m4
|
||||
echo "$0: Creating m4/paxutils.m4"
|
||||
(echo "# This file is generated automatically. Please, do not edit."
|
||||
echo "#"
|
||||
echo "AC_DEFUN([tar_PAXUTILS],["
|
||||
cat ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/m4/DISTFILES | sed '/^#/d;s/\(.*\)\.m4/pu_\1/' | tr a-z A-Z
|
||||
echo "AC_DEFUN([${package}_PAXUTILS],["
|
||||
cat ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/am/DISTFILES | sed '/^#/d;s/\(.*\)\.m4/pu_\1/' | tr a-z A-Z
|
||||
echo "])") > ./m4/paxutils.m4
|
||||
#FIXME ignorefile m4 paxutils.m4
|
||||
|
||||
if [ -d rmt ]; then
|
||||
:
|
||||
@@ -229,89 +659,75 @@ done
|
||||
|
||||
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/paxlib lib pax
|
||||
|
||||
# Get gnulib files.
|
||||
|
||||
case ${GNULIB_SRCDIR--} in
|
||||
-) checkout gnulib
|
||||
GNULIB_SRCDIR=gnulib
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
<$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool || exit
|
||||
|
||||
get_modules gnulib.modules
|
||||
|
||||
gnulib_modules=`echo "$gnulib_modules" | sort -u`
|
||||
previous_gnulib_modules=
|
||||
while [ "$gnulib_modules" != "$previous_gnulib_modules" ]; do
|
||||
previous_gnulib_modules=$gnulib_modules
|
||||
gnulib_modules=`
|
||||
(echo "$gnulib_modules"
|
||||
for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
|
||||
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-dependencies $gnulib_module
|
||||
done) | sort -u
|
||||
`
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
gnulib_files=`
|
||||
(for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
|
||||
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-filelist $gnulib_module
|
||||
done) | sort -u
|
||||
`
|
||||
|
||||
gnulib_dirs=`echo "$gnulib_files" | sed 's,/[^/]*$,,' | sort -u`
|
||||
mkdir -p $gnulib_dirs || exit
|
||||
|
||||
for gnulib_file in $gnulib_files; do
|
||||
dest=$gnulib_file
|
||||
|
||||
case $gnulib_file in
|
||||
m4/codeset.m4) continue;;
|
||||
m4/intdiv0.m4) continue;;
|
||||
m4/inttypes-pri.m4) continue;;
|
||||
m4/isc-posix.m4) continue;;
|
||||
m4/lcmessage.m4) continue;;
|
||||
m4/onceonly_2_57.m4) dest=m4/onceonly.m4;;
|
||||
# These will be overwritten by autopoint, which still uses
|
||||
# old jm_.* macro names, so we have to keep both copies.
|
||||
m4/gettext.m4 | m4/glibc21.m4 | m4/inttypes_h.m4 | m4/lib-ld.m4 | \
|
||||
m4/lib-prefix.m4 | m4/po.m4 | m4/stdint_h.m4 | m4/uintmax_t.m4 | \
|
||||
m4/ulonglong.m4)
|
||||
dest=`expr $gnulib_file : '\(.*\).m4'`_gl.m4;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
|
||||
rm -f $dest &&
|
||||
echo "$0: Copying file $GNULIB_SRCDIR/$gnulib_file" &&
|
||||
cp -p $GNULIB_SRCDIR/$gnulib_file $dest || exit
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
echo "$0: Creating m4/gnulib.m4"
|
||||
(echo "# This file is generated automatically. Please, do not edit."
|
||||
echo "#"
|
||||
echo "AC_DEFUN([tar_GNULIB],["
|
||||
for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
|
||||
echo "# $gnulib_module"
|
||||
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-autoconf-snippet $gnulib_module
|
||||
done | sed '/AM_GNU_GETTEXT/d'
|
||||
echo "])") > ./m4/gnulib.m4
|
||||
|
||||
echo "$0: Creating lib/Makefile.am"
|
||||
(echo "# This file is generated automatically. Do not edit!"
|
||||
cat lib/Makefile.tmpl
|
||||
|
||||
for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
|
||||
echo "# $gnulib_module"
|
||||
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-automake-snippet $gnulib_module
|
||||
done | sed 's/lib_SOURCES/libtar_a_SOURCES/g' ) > lib/Makefile.am
|
||||
|
||||
# Get translations.
|
||||
if test "$DOWNLOAD_PO" = "yes"; then
|
||||
update_po
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
# Reconfigure, getting other files.
|
||||
|
||||
echo "$0: autoreconf --verbose --install --force ..."
|
||||
autoreconf --verbose --install --force || exit 1
|
||||
for command in \
|
||||
libtool \
|
||||
'aclocal --force -I m4' \
|
||||
'autoconf --force' \
|
||||
'autoheader --force' \
|
||||
'automake --add-missing --copy --force-missing';
|
||||
do
|
||||
if test "$command" = libtool; then
|
||||
use_libtool=0
|
||||
# We'd like to use grep -E, to see if any of LT_INIT,
|
||||
# AC_PROG_LIBTOOL, AM_PROG_LIBTOOL is used in configure.ac,
|
||||
# but that's not portable enough (e.g., for Solaris).
|
||||
grep '^[ ]*A[CM]_PROG_LIBTOOL' configure.ac >/dev/null \
|
||||
&& use_libtool=1
|
||||
grep '^[ ]*LT_INIT' configure.ac >/dev/null \
|
||||
&& use_libtool=1
|
||||
test $use_libtool = 0 \
|
||||
&& continue
|
||||
command='libtoolize -c -f'
|
||||
fi
|
||||
echo "$0: $command ..."
|
||||
$command || exit
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Get some extra files from gnulib, overriding existing files.
|
||||
for file in $gnulib_extra_files; do
|
||||
case $file in
|
||||
*/INSTALL) dst=INSTALL;;
|
||||
build-aux/*) dst=$build_aux/`expr "$file" : 'build-aux/\(.*\)'`;;
|
||||
*) dst=$file;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
symlink_to_dir "$GNULIB_SRCDIR" $file $dst || exit
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
if test $with_gettext = yes; then
|
||||
# Create gettext configuration.
|
||||
echo "$0: Creating po/Makevars from po/Makevars.template ..."
|
||||
rm -f po/Makevars
|
||||
sed '
|
||||
/^EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES *=/s/=.*/= '"$EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES"'/
|
||||
/^MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS *=/s/=.*/= '"$MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS"'/
|
||||
/^XGETTEXT_OPTIONS *=/{
|
||||
s/$/ \\/
|
||||
a\
|
||||
'"$XGETTEXT_OPTIONS"' $${end_of_xgettext_options+}
|
||||
}
|
||||
' po/Makevars.template >po/Makevars
|
||||
|
||||
if test -d runtime-po; then
|
||||
# Similarly for runtime-po/Makevars, but not quite the same.
|
||||
rm -f runtime-po/Makevars
|
||||
sed '
|
||||
/^DOMAIN *=.*/s/=.*/= '"$package"'-runtime/
|
||||
/^subdir *=.*/s/=.*/= runtime-po/
|
||||
/^MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS *=/s/=.*/= bug-'"$package"'@gnu.org/
|
||||
/^XGETTEXT_OPTIONS *=/{
|
||||
s/$/ \\/
|
||||
a\
|
||||
'"$XGETTEXT_OPTIONS_RUNTIME"' $${end_of_xgettext_options+}
|
||||
}
|
||||
' <po/Makevars.template >runtime-po/Makevars
|
||||
|
||||
# Copy identical files from po to runtime-po.
|
||||
(cd po && cp -p Makefile.in.in *-quot *.header *.sed *.sin ../runtime-po)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
echo "$0: done. Now you can run './configure'."
|
||||
|
||||
74
bootstrap.conf
Normal file
74
bootstrap.conf
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
|
||||
# Bootstrap configuration for GNU tar.
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
# any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
# GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
|
||||
# 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
source_base=gnu
|
||||
gnulib_name=libgnu
|
||||
gnulib_mk=Makefile.am
|
||||
|
||||
# We don't need these modules, even though gnulib-tool mistakenly
|
||||
# includes them because of gettext dependencies.
|
||||
avoided_gnulib_modules='
|
||||
--avoid=lock
|
||||
'
|
||||
|
||||
# gnulib modules used by this package.
|
||||
gnulib_modules="$avoided_gnulib_modules
|
||||
`grep '^[^#]' gnulib.modules`
|
||||
"
|
||||
|
||||
# Additional xgettext options to use. Use "\\\newline" to break lines.
|
||||
XGETTEXT_OPTIONS=$XGETTEXT_OPTIONS'\\\
|
||||
--flag=_:1:pass-c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=N_:1:pass-c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=error:3:c-format --flag=error_at_line:5:c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=asnprintf:3:c-format --flag=vasnprintf:3:c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=argp_error:2:c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=__argp_error:2:c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=argp_failure:4:c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=__argp_failure:4:c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=argp_fmtstream_printf:2:c-format\\\
|
||||
--flag=__argp_fmtstream_printf:2:c-format\\\
|
||||
'
|
||||
|
||||
# Gettext supplies these files, but we don't need them since
|
||||
# we don't have an intl subdirectory.
|
||||
excluded_files='
|
||||
m4/glibc2.m4
|
||||
m4/intdiv0.m4
|
||||
m4/lcmessage.m4
|
||||
m4/lock.m4
|
||||
m4/printf-posix.m4
|
||||
m4/uintmax_t.m4
|
||||
m4/ulonglong.m4
|
||||
m4/visibility.m4
|
||||
'
|
||||
|
||||
# Read local configuration file
|
||||
if [ -r .bootstrap ]; then
|
||||
echo "$0: Reading configuration file .bootstrap"
|
||||
eval set -- "`sed 's/#.*$//;/^$/d' .bootstrap | tr '\n' ' '` $*"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
test -d m4 || mkdir m4
|
||||
test -d $source_base || mkdir $source_base
|
||||
|
||||
cat > ChangeLog <<EOT
|
||||
This file is a placeholder. It will be replaced with the actual ChangeLog
|
||||
by make dist. Run make ChangeLog if you wish to create it earlier.
|
||||
EOT
|
||||
28
configure.ac
28
configure.ac
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
|
||||
# Configure template for GNU tar.
|
||||
# Configure template for GNU tar. -*- autoconf -*-
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1991, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
|
||||
# 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
# any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
@@ -18,18 +18,19 @@
|
||||
# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
|
||||
# 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_INIT([GNU tar], [1.15.91], [bug-tar@gnu.org])
|
||||
AC_INIT([GNU tar], [1.22], [bug-tar@gnu.org])
|
||||
AC_CONFIG_SRCDIR([src/tar.c])
|
||||
AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR([build-aux])
|
||||
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([config.h:config.hin])
|
||||
AC_PREREQ([2.59])
|
||||
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([config.h])
|
||||
AC_PREREQ([2.60])
|
||||
AM_INIT_AUTOMAKE([1.9 gnits tar-ustar dist-bzip2 dist-shar std-options])
|
||||
|
||||
gl_USE_SYSTEM_EXTENSIONS
|
||||
AC_PROG_CC
|
||||
AC_EXEEXT
|
||||
AC_PROG_RANLIB
|
||||
AC_PROG_YACC
|
||||
gl_EARLY
|
||||
|
||||
AC_SYS_LARGEFILE
|
||||
AC_ISC_POSIX
|
||||
AC_C_INLINE
|
||||
@@ -47,7 +48,6 @@ AC_CHECK_HEADERS([sys/buf.h], [], [],
|
||||
#endif])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_HEADER_SYS_WAIT
|
||||
AM_STDBOOL_H
|
||||
|
||||
AC_HEADER_DIRENT
|
||||
AC_HEADER_MAJOR
|
||||
@@ -80,15 +80,13 @@ AC_CHECK_TYPE(dev_t, unsigned)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_TYPE(ino_t, unsigned)
|
||||
|
||||
gt_TYPE_SSIZE_T
|
||||
gl_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T
|
||||
jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T
|
||||
|
||||
# gnulib modules
|
||||
tar_GNULIB
|
||||
gl_INIT
|
||||
# paxutils modules
|
||||
tar_PAXUTILS
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(fsync lstat mkfifo readlink strerror symlink setlocale utimes)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(fsync getdtablesize lstat mkfifo readlink symlink setlocale utimes)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_DECLS([getgrgid],,, [#include <grp.h>])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_DECLS([getpwuid],,, [#include <pwd.h>])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_DECLS([time],,, [#include <time.h>])
|
||||
@@ -214,8 +212,8 @@ AC_CHECK_TYPE(iconv_t,:,
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
# Gettext.
|
||||
AM_GNU_GETTEXT([external], [need-ngettext])
|
||||
AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION(0.12.1)
|
||||
AM_GNU_GETTEXT([external], [need-formatstring-macros])
|
||||
AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION([0.16])
|
||||
|
||||
# Initialize the test suite.
|
||||
AC_CONFIG_TESTDIR(tests)
|
||||
@@ -240,9 +238,9 @@ else
|
||||
BACKUP_SED_COND='/^\#IF_DATE_FORMAT_OK/,/^\#ELSE_DATE_FORMAT_OK/d;/^\#ENDIF_DATE_FORMAT_OK/d'
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
AC_OUTPUT([Makefile\
|
||||
doc/Makefile\
|
||||
gnu/Makefile\
|
||||
lib/Makefile\
|
||||
po/Makefile.in\
|
||||
scripts/Makefile\
|
||||
|
||||
29
doc/.cvsignore → doc/.gitignore
vendored
29
doc/.cvsignore → doc/.gitignore
vendored
@@ -1,37 +1,26 @@
|
||||
*.stamp
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
genfile.texi
|
||||
getdate.texi
|
||||
header.texi
|
||||
html_chapter
|
||||
html_mono
|
||||
html_node
|
||||
manual
|
||||
stamp-vti
|
||||
tar.at
|
||||
tar.ats
|
||||
tar.aux
|
||||
tar.cp
|
||||
tar.cps
|
||||
tar.dvi
|
||||
tar.ex
|
||||
tar.exs
|
||||
tar.fl
|
||||
tar.fn
|
||||
tar.fns
|
||||
tar.html
|
||||
tar.info
|
||||
tar.info*
|
||||
tar.info-*
|
||||
tar.kw
|
||||
tar.kws
|
||||
tar.ky
|
||||
tar.log
|
||||
tar.mt
|
||||
tar.op
|
||||
tar.ops
|
||||
tar.pdf
|
||||
tar.pg
|
||||
tar.pgs
|
||||
tar.ps
|
||||
tar.pr
|
||||
tar.t2d
|
||||
tar.toc
|
||||
tar.tp
|
||||
tar.vr
|
||||
tar.vrs
|
||||
version.texi
|
||||
genfile.texi
|
||||
header.texi
|
||||
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
|
||||
# Makefile for GNU tar documentation.
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2006 Free
|
||||
# Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2006,
|
||||
# 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
## any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
@@ -20,17 +20,18 @@
|
||||
info_TEXINFOS = tar.texi
|
||||
tar_TEXINFOS = \
|
||||
dumpdir.texi\
|
||||
tar-snapshot-edit.texi\
|
||||
fdl.texi\
|
||||
freemanuals.texi\
|
||||
genfile.texi\
|
||||
getdate.texi\
|
||||
intern.texi\
|
||||
header.texi\
|
||||
intern.texi\
|
||||
rendition.texi\
|
||||
snapshot.texi\
|
||||
sparse.texi\
|
||||
value.texi
|
||||
EXTRA_DIST = gendocs_template mastermenu.el texify.sed
|
||||
DISTCLEANFILES=*.info*
|
||||
EXTRA_DIST = gendocs_template mastermenu.el texify.sed untabify.el
|
||||
|
||||
# The rendering level is anyone of PUBLISH, DISTRIB or PROOF.
|
||||
# Just call `make RENDITION=PROOF [target]' if you want PROOF rendition.
|
||||
@@ -45,6 +46,18 @@ header.texi: $(top_srcdir)/src/tar.h
|
||||
master-menu: $(tar_TEXINFOS)
|
||||
emacs -batch -l mastermenu.el -f make-master-menu $(info_TEXINFOS)
|
||||
|
||||
untabify:
|
||||
emacs -batch -l untabify.el $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS)
|
||||
|
||||
final: untabify master-menu
|
||||
|
||||
# Checking
|
||||
check-format:
|
||||
@if test -n "`cat $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS) | tr -d -c '\t'`"; then \
|
||||
echo "Sources contain tabs; run make untabify"; \
|
||||
false; \
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
check-options:
|
||||
@ARGP_HELP_FMT='usage-indent=0,short-opt-col=0,long-opt-col=0,\
|
||||
doc-opt-col=0,opt-doc-col=0,header-col=0,rmargin=1' \
|
||||
@@ -66,6 +79,52 @@ doc-opt-col=0,opt-doc-col=0,header-col=0,rmargin=1' \
|
||||
fi;\
|
||||
rm report.$$$$
|
||||
|
||||
check-refs:
|
||||
@for file in $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS); \
|
||||
do \
|
||||
sed -e = $$file | \
|
||||
sed -n 'N;/@FIXME-.*ref/{s/\(^[0-9][0-9]*\).*@FIXME-.*ref{\([^}]*\).*/'$$file':\1: \2/gp}'; \
|
||||
done > $@-t; \
|
||||
if [ -s $@-t ]; then \
|
||||
echo "Unresolved cross-references:"; \
|
||||
cat $@-t;\
|
||||
rm $@-t; \
|
||||
else \
|
||||
rm -f $@-t; \
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
check-fixmes:
|
||||
@for file in $(info_TEXINFOS); \
|
||||
do \
|
||||
sed -e = $$file | \
|
||||
sed -n 'N;/@FIXME{/{s/\(^[0-9][0-9]*\).*@FIXME{\([^}]*\).*/'$$file':\1: \2/gp}'; \
|
||||
done > $@-t; \
|
||||
if [ -s $@-t ]; then \
|
||||
echo "Unresolved FIXMEs:"; \
|
||||
cat $@-t; \
|
||||
rm $@-t; \
|
||||
false; \
|
||||
else \
|
||||
rm -f $@-t; \
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
check-unrevised:
|
||||
@grep -Hn @UNREVISED $(info_TEXINFOS) > $@-t; \
|
||||
if [ -s $@-t ]; then \
|
||||
echo "Unrevised nodes:"; \
|
||||
cat $@-t; \
|
||||
rm $@-t; \
|
||||
false;\
|
||||
else \
|
||||
rm $@-t; \
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
all-check-docs: check-format check-options check-refs check-fixmes check-unrevised
|
||||
|
||||
check-docs:
|
||||
$(MAKE) -k all-check-docs
|
||||
|
||||
#
|
||||
|
||||
clean-local:
|
||||
rm -rf manual
|
||||
@@ -78,8 +137,8 @@ TEXI2DVI=texi2dvi -t '@set $(RENDITION)' -E
|
||||
# Usual value is:
|
||||
# /usr/share/texmf/pdftex/plain/misc:/usr/share/texmf/pdftex/config
|
||||
manual:
|
||||
TEXINPUTS=$(srcdir):$(top_srcdir)/config:$(TEXINPUTS) \
|
||||
TEXINPUTS=$(srcdir):$(top_srcdir)/build-tex:$(TEXINPUTS) \
|
||||
MAKEINFO="$(MAKEINFO) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS)" \
|
||||
TEXI2DVI="$(TEXI2DVI) -t @finalout" \
|
||||
$(GENDOCS) tar 'GNU tar manual'
|
||||
$(GENDOCS) --texi2html tar 'GNU tar manual'
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
|
||||
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
|
||||
@c Copyright (C) 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
@c Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
@c Written by Sergey Poznyakoff
|
||||
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
|
||||
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
|
||||
@@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ changed since the last backup.
|
||||
|
||||
@item R
|
||||
This code requests renaming of the @var{filename} to the name
|
||||
specified with the following @samp{T} command.
|
||||
specified with the @samp{T} command, that immediately follows it.
|
||||
|
||||
@item T
|
||||
Specify target file name for @samp{R} command (see below).
|
||||
@@ -90,9 +90,9 @@ New incremental dump was made.
|
||||
@end enumerate
|
||||
|
||||
This case cannot be handled by three successive renames, since
|
||||
renaming @file{a} to @file{b} will destroy existing directory.
|
||||
To handle such case a temporary directory is required. @GNUTAR{}
|
||||
will create the following dumpdir (newlines have been added for
|
||||
renaming @file{a} to @file{b} will destroy the existing directory.
|
||||
To correctly process it, @GNUTAR{} needs a temporary directory, so
|
||||
it creates the following dumpdir (newlines have been added for
|
||||
readability):
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
@@ -125,7 +125,7 @@ corresponding directory, in variable @code{GNU.dumpdir}.
|
||||
@item GNU and old GNU archives
|
||||
|
||||
These formats implement special header type @samp{D}, which is similar
|
||||
to ustar header @samp{5} (directory), except that it preceeds a data
|
||||
to ustar header @samp{5} (directory), except that it precedes a data
|
||||
block containing the dumpdir.
|
||||
@end itemize
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8" ?>
|
||||
<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
|
||||
"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
|
||||
<!-- $Id: gendocs_template,v 1.2 2005/05/15 03:59:09 eggert Exp $ -->
|
||||
<!-- $Id: gendocs_template,v 1.5 2007/10/30 14:58:52 gray Exp $ -->
|
||||
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en">
|
||||
|
||||
<head>
|
||||
@@ -30,24 +30,41 @@
|
||||
alt=" [image of the head of a GNU] "
|
||||
width="129" height="122" />
|
||||
</a>
|
||||
<a href="/philosophy/gif.html">(no gifs due to patent problems)</a>
|
||||
</p>
|
||||
<hr />
|
||||
|
||||
The manual for %%PACKAGE%% is available in the following formats:</p>
|
||||
<p>The manual for %%PACKAGE%% is available in the following formats:</p>
|
||||
|
||||
<ul>
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html">HTML
|
||||
(%%HTML_MONO_SIZE%%K characters)</a> - entirely on one web page.</li>
|
||||
(%%HTML_MONO_SIZE%%K bytes)</a> - entirely on one web page.</li>
|
||||
<li><a href="html_node/index.html">HTML</a> - with one web page per
|
||||
node.</li>
|
||||
%%IF HTML_SECTION%%
|
||||
<li><a href="html_section/index.html">HTML</a> - with one web page per
|
||||
section.</li>
|
||||
%%ENDIF HTML_SECTION%%
|
||||
%%IF HTML_CHAPTER%%
|
||||
<li><a href="html_chapter/index.html">HTML</a> - with one web page per
|
||||
chapter.</li>
|
||||
%%ENDIF HTML_CHAPTER%%
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html.gz">HTML compressed
|
||||
(%%HTML_MONO_GZ_SIZE%%K gzipped characters)</a> - entirely on
|
||||
one web page.</li>
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%_html_node.tar.gz">HTML compressed
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html_node.tar.gz">HTML compressed
|
||||
(%%HTML_NODE_TGZ_SIZE%%K gzipped tar file)</a> -
|
||||
with one web page per node.</li>
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%-info.tar.gz">Info document
|
||||
%%IF HTML_SECTION%%
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html_section.tar.gz">HTML compressed
|
||||
(%%HTML_SECTION_TGZ_SIZE%%K gzipped tar file)</a> -
|
||||
with one web page per section.</li>
|
||||
%%ENDIF HTML_SECTION%%
|
||||
%%IF HTML_CHAPTER%%
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html_chapter.tar.gz">HTML compressed
|
||||
(%%HTML_CHAPTER_TGZ_SIZE%%K gzipped tar file)</a> -
|
||||
with one web page per chapter.</li>
|
||||
%%ENDIF HTML_CHAPTER%%
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.info.tar.gz">Info document
|
||||
(%%INFO_TGZ_SIZE%%K characters gzipped tar file)</a>.</li>
|
||||
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.txt">ASCII text
|
||||
(%%ASCII_SIZE%%K characters)</a>.</li>
|
||||
@@ -99,7 +116,7 @@ permitted in any medium, provided this notice is preserved.
|
||||
<p>
|
||||
Updated:
|
||||
<!-- timestamp start -->
|
||||
$Date: 2005/05/15 03:59:09 $ $Author: eggert $
|
||||
$Date: 2007/10/30 14:58:52 $ $Author: gray $
|
||||
<!-- timestamp end -->
|
||||
</p>
|
||||
</div>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -6,6 +6,7 @@
|
||||
@menu
|
||||
* Standard:: Basic Tar Format
|
||||
* Extensions:: @acronym{GNU} Extensions to the Archive Format
|
||||
* Sparse Formats:: Storing Sparse Files
|
||||
* Snapshot Files::
|
||||
* Dumpdir::
|
||||
@end menu
|
||||
@@ -35,8 +36,6 @@ Archives are permitted to have more than one member with the same
|
||||
member name. One way this situation can occur is if more than one
|
||||
version of a file has been stored in the archive. For information
|
||||
about adding new versions of a file to an archive, see @ref{update}.
|
||||
@FIXME-xref{To learn more about having more than one archive member with the
|
||||
same name, see -backup node, when it's written.}
|
||||
|
||||
In addition to entries describing archive members, an archive may
|
||||
contain entries which @command{tar} itself uses to store information.
|
||||
@@ -95,7 +94,7 @@ The @code{name} field is the file name of the file, with directory names
|
||||
@FIXME{how big a name before field overflows?}
|
||||
|
||||
The @code{mode} field provides nine bits specifying file permissions
|
||||
and three bits to specify the Set UID, Set GID, and Save Text
|
||||
and three bits to specify the Set @acronym{UID}, Set @acronym{GID}, and Save Text
|
||||
(@dfn{sticky}) modes. Values for these bits are defined above.
|
||||
When special permissions are required to create a file with a given
|
||||
mode, and the user restoring files from the archive does not hold such
|
||||
@@ -106,12 +105,12 @@ should be faked up when creating or updating an archive; e.g., the
|
||||
group permission could be copied from the @emph{other} permission.
|
||||
|
||||
The @code{uid} and @code{gid} fields are the numeric user and group
|
||||
ID of the file owners, respectively. If the operating system does
|
||||
not support numeric user or group IDs, these fields should be ignored.
|
||||
@acronym{ID} of the file owners, respectively. If the operating system does
|
||||
not support numeric user or group @acronym{ID}s, these fields should
|
||||
be ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
The @code{size} field is the size of the file in bytes; linked files
|
||||
are archived with this field specified as zero. @FIXME-xref{Modifiers, in
|
||||
particular the @option{--incremental} (@option{-G}) option.}
|
||||
are archived with this field specified as zero.
|
||||
|
||||
The @code{mtime} field is the data modification time of the file at
|
||||
the time it was archived. It is the ASCII representation of the octal
|
||||
@@ -257,7 +256,7 @@ The @code{magic} field indicates that this archive was output in
|
||||
the P1003 archive format. If this field contains @code{TMAGIC},
|
||||
the @code{uname} and @code{gname} fields will contain the ASCII
|
||||
representation of the owner and group of the file respectively.
|
||||
If found, the user and group IDs are used rather than the values in
|
||||
If found, the user and group @acronym{ID}s are used rather than the values in
|
||||
the @code{uid} and @code{gid} fields.
|
||||
|
||||
For references, see ISO/IEC 9945-1:1990 or IEEE Std 1003.1-1990, pages
|
||||
@@ -320,6 +319,10 @@ use the @acronym{GNU}-added fields of the header, other versions of
|
||||
@command{tar} program will give an error, the most likely one being a
|
||||
checksum error.
|
||||
|
||||
@node Sparse Formats
|
||||
@unnumberedsec Storing Sparse Files
|
||||
@include sparse.texi
|
||||
|
||||
@node Snapshot Files
|
||||
@unnumberedsec Format of the Incremental Snapshot Files
|
||||
@include snapshot.texi
|
||||
@@ -327,3 +330,4 @@ checksum error.
|
||||
@node Dumpdir
|
||||
@unnumberedsec Dumpdir
|
||||
@include dumpdir.texi
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
|
||||
;;; mastermenu.el --- Redefinition of texinfo-master-menu-list
|
||||
|
||||
;; Copyright (C) 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
;; Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
;; Author: Sergey Poznyakoff
|
||||
;; Maintainer: bug-tar@gnu.org
|
||||
@@ -10,7 +10,7 @@
|
||||
|
||||
;; This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
;; it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
;; the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
;; the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
;; any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
;; This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -55,8 +55,6 @@
|
||||
@c Output various FIXME information only in PROOF rendition.
|
||||
|
||||
@macro FIXME{string}
|
||||
@allow-recursion
|
||||
@quote-arg
|
||||
@ifset PROOF
|
||||
@ifset PROOF_FOOTNOTED
|
||||
@footnote{@strong{FIXME:} \string\}
|
||||
@@ -71,25 +69,31 @@
|
||||
@end macro
|
||||
|
||||
@macro FIXME-ref{string}
|
||||
@quote-arg
|
||||
@ifset PROOF
|
||||
@strong{<REF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
|
||||
@end ifset
|
||||
@ifclear PROOF
|
||||
@cite{\string\}
|
||||
@end ifclear
|
||||
@end macro
|
||||
|
||||
@macro FIXME-pxref{string}
|
||||
@quote-arg
|
||||
@ifset PROOF
|
||||
@strong{<PXREF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
|
||||
See @strong{<PXREF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
|
||||
@end ifset
|
||||
@ifclear PROOF
|
||||
See @cite{\string\}
|
||||
@end ifclear
|
||||
|
||||
@end macro
|
||||
|
||||
@macro FIXME-xref{string}
|
||||
@quote-arg
|
||||
@ifset PROOF
|
||||
@strong{<XREF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
|
||||
See @strong{<XREF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
|
||||
@end ifset
|
||||
@ifclear PROOF
|
||||
See @cite{\string\}
|
||||
@end ifclear
|
||||
@end macro
|
||||
|
||||
@c End of rendition.texi
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,35 +1,63 @@
|
||||
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
|
||||
@c Copyright (C) 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
@c Copyright (C) 2005, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
@c Written by Sergey Poznyakoff
|
||||
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
|
||||
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
|
||||
|
||||
A @dfn{snapshot file} (or @dfn{directory file}) is created during
|
||||
incremental backups (@pxref{Incremental Dumps}). It
|
||||
contains the status of the filesystem at the time of the dump and is
|
||||
contains the status of the file system at the time of the dump and is
|
||||
used to determine which files were modified since the last backup.
|
||||
|
||||
@GNUTAR{} version @value{VERSION} supports two snapshot file
|
||||
@GNUTAR{} version @value{VERSION} supports three snapshot file
|
||||
formats. The first format, called @dfn{format 0}, is the one used by
|
||||
@GNUTAR{} versions up to 1.15.1. The second format, called @dfn{format
|
||||
1} is an extended version of this format, that contains more metadata
|
||||
and allows for further extensions.
|
||||
and allows for further extensions. It was used by version
|
||||
1.15.1. Starting from version 1.16 and up to @value{VERSION}, the
|
||||
@dfn{format 2} is used.
|
||||
|
||||
@GNUTAR{} is able to read all three formats, but will create
|
||||
snapshots only in format 2.
|
||||
|
||||
This appendix describes all three formats in detail.
|
||||
|
||||
@enumerate 0
|
||||
@cindex format 0, snapshot file
|
||||
@cindex snapshot file, format 0
|
||||
@item
|
||||
@samp{Format 0} snapshot file begins with a line containing a
|
||||
decimal number that represents the UNIX timestamp of the beginning of
|
||||
the last archivation. This line is followed by directory metadata
|
||||
descriptions, one per line. Each description has the following format:
|
||||
decimal number that represents a @acronym{UNIX} timestamp of the
|
||||
beginning of the last archivation. This line is followed by directory
|
||||
metadata descriptions, one per line. Each description has the
|
||||
following format:
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
[@var{nfs}]@var{dev} @var{inode} @var{name}
|
||||
@var{nfs}@var{dev} @var{inode} @var{name}
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
@noindent
|
||||
where optional @var{nfs} is a single plus character (@samp{+}) if this
|
||||
directory is located on an NFS-mounted partition, @var{dev} and
|
||||
@var{inode} are the device and inode numbers of the directory, and
|
||||
@var{name} is the directory name.
|
||||
where:
|
||||
|
||||
@table @var
|
||||
@item nfs
|
||||
A single plus character (@samp{+}), if this directory is located on
|
||||
an @acronym{NFS}-mounted partition, or a single space otherwise;
|
||||
|
||||
@item dev
|
||||
Device number of the directory;
|
||||
|
||||
@item inode
|
||||
I-node number of the directory;
|
||||
|
||||
@item name
|
||||
Name of the directory. Any special characters (white-space,
|
||||
backslashes, etc.) are quoted.
|
||||
@end table
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex format 1, snapshot file
|
||||
@cindex snapshot file, format 1
|
||||
@item
|
||||
@samp{Format 1} snapshot file begins with a line specifying the
|
||||
format of the file. This line has the following structure:
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -38,28 +66,75 @@ format of the file. This line has the following structure:
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
@noindent
|
||||
where @var{tar-version} is the version of @GNUTAR{} implementation
|
||||
that created this snapshot, and @var{incr-format-version} is the
|
||||
version number of the snapshot format (in this case @samp{1}).
|
||||
where @var{tar-version} is the version number of @GNUTAR{}
|
||||
implementation that created this snapshot, and
|
||||
@var{incr-format-version} is the version number of the snapshot format
|
||||
(in this case @samp{1}).
|
||||
|
||||
The following line contains two decimal numbers, representing the
|
||||
Next line contains two decimal numbers, representing the
|
||||
time of the last backup. First number is the number of seconds, the
|
||||
second one is the number of nanoseconds, since the beginning of the
|
||||
epoch.
|
||||
|
||||
Following lines contain directory metadate, one line per
|
||||
directory. The line format is:
|
||||
Lines that follow contain directory metadata, one line per
|
||||
directory. Each line is formatted as follows:
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
[@var{nfs}]@var{mtime-sec} @var{mtime-nsec} @var{dev} @var{inode} @var{name}
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
@noindent
|
||||
where @var{mtime-sec} and @var{mtime-nsec} represent the last
|
||||
where @var{mtime-sec} and @var{mtime-nsec} represent last
|
||||
modification time of this directory with nanosecond precision;
|
||||
@var{nfs}, @var{dev}, @var{inode} and @var{name} have the same meaning
|
||||
as with @samp{format 0}.
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex format 2, snapshot file
|
||||
@cindex snapshot file, format 2
|
||||
@item
|
||||
@FIXME{}
|
||||
A snapshot file begins with a format identifier, as described for
|
||||
version 1, e.g.:
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
GNU tar-@value{VERSION}-2
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
This line is followed by newline. Rest of file consists of
|
||||
records, separated by null (@acronym{ASCII} 0)
|
||||
characters. Thus, in contrast to the previous formats, format 2
|
||||
snapshot is a binary file.
|
||||
|
||||
First two records are decimal numbers, representing the
|
||||
time of the last backup. First number is the number of seconds, the
|
||||
second one is the number of nanoseconds, since the beginning of the
|
||||
epoch. These are followed by arbitrary number of directory records.
|
||||
|
||||
Each @dfn{directory record} contains a set of metadata describing a
|
||||
particular directory. Parts of a directory record are delimited with
|
||||
@acronym{ASCII} 0 characters. The following table describes each
|
||||
part. The @dfn{Number} type in this table stands for a decimal number
|
||||
in @acronym{ASCII} notation.
|
||||
|
||||
@multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.2 0.6
|
||||
@headitem Field @tab Type @tab Description
|
||||
@item nfs @tab Character @tab @samp{1} if the directory is located on
|
||||
an @acronym{NFS}-mounted partition, or @samp{0} otherwise;
|
||||
@item mtime-sec @tab Number @tab Modification time, seconds;
|
||||
@item mtime-nano @tab Number @tab Modification time, nanoseconds;
|
||||
@item dev-no @tab Number @tab Device number;
|
||||
@item i-no @tab Number @tab I-node number;
|
||||
@item name @tab String @tab Directory name; In contrast to the
|
||||
previous versions it is not quoted.
|
||||
@item contents @tab Dumpdir @tab Contents of the directory;
|
||||
@xref{Dumpdir}, for a description of its format.
|
||||
@item
|
||||
@end multitable
|
||||
|
||||
Dumpdirs stored in snapshot files contain only records of types
|
||||
@samp{Y}, @samp{N} and @samp{D}.
|
||||
|
||||
@end enumerate
|
||||
|
||||
@c End of snapshot.texi
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
235
doc/sparse.texi
Normal file
235
doc/sparse.texi
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,235 @@
|
||||
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
|
||||
@c Copyright (C) 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
|
||||
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex sparse formats
|
||||
@cindex sparse versions
|
||||
The notion of sparse file, and the ways of handling it from the point
|
||||
of view of @GNUTAR{} user have been described in detail in
|
||||
@ref{sparse}. This chapter describes the internal format @GNUTAR{}
|
||||
uses to store such files.
|
||||
|
||||
The support for sparse files in @GNUTAR{} has a long history. The
|
||||
earliest version featuring this support that I was able to find was 1.09,
|
||||
released in November, 1990. The format introduced back then is called
|
||||
@dfn{old GNU} sparse format and in spite of the fact that its design
|
||||
contained many flaws, it was the only format @GNUTAR{} supported
|
||||
until version 1.14 (May, 2004), which introduced initial support for
|
||||
sparse archives in @acronym{PAX} archives (@pxref{posix}). This
|
||||
format was not free from design flows, either and it was subsequently
|
||||
improved in versions 1.15.2 (November, 2005) and 1.15.92 (June,
|
||||
2006).
|
||||
|
||||
In addition to GNU sparse format, @GNUTAR{} is able to read and
|
||||
extract sparse files archived by @command{star}.
|
||||
|
||||
The following subsections describe each format in detail.
|
||||
|
||||
@menu
|
||||
* Old GNU Format::
|
||||
* PAX 0:: PAX Format, Versions 0.0 and 0.1
|
||||
* PAX 1:: PAX Format, Version 1.0
|
||||
@end menu
|
||||
|
||||
@node Old GNU Format
|
||||
@appendixsubsec Old GNU Format
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex sparse formats, Old GNU
|
||||
@cindex Old GNU sparse format
|
||||
The format introduced some time around 1990 (v. 1.09). It was
|
||||
designed on top of standard @code{ustar} headers in such an
|
||||
unfortunate way that some of its fields overwrote fields required by
|
||||
POSIX.
|
||||
|
||||
An old GNU sparse header is designated by type @samp{S}
|
||||
(@code{GNUTYPE_SPARSE}) and has the following layout:
|
||||
|
||||
@multitable @columnfractions 0.10 0.10 0.20 0.20 0.40
|
||||
@headitem Offset @tab Size @tab Name @tab Data type @tab Contents
|
||||
@item 0 @tab 345 @tab @tab N/A @tab Not used.
|
||||
@item 345 @tab 12 @tab atime @tab Number @tab @code{atime} of the file.
|
||||
@item 357 @tab 12 @tab ctime @tab Number @tab @code{ctime} of the file .
|
||||
@item 369 @tab 12 @tab offset @tab Number @tab For
|
||||
multivolume archives: the offset of the start of this volume.
|
||||
@item 381 @tab 4 @tab @tab N/A @tab Not used.
|
||||
@item 385 @tab 1 @tab @tab N/A @tab Not used.
|
||||
@item 386 @tab 96 @tab sp @tab @code{sparse_header} @tab (4 entries) File map.
|
||||
@item 482 @tab 1 @tab isextended @tab Bool @tab @code{1} if an
|
||||
extension sparse header follows, @code{0} otherwise.
|
||||
@item 483 @tab 12 @tab realsize @tab Number @tab Real size of the file.
|
||||
@end multitable
|
||||
|
||||
Each of @code{sparse_header} object at offset 386 describes a single
|
||||
data chunk. It has the following structure:
|
||||
|
||||
@multitable @columnfractions 0.10 0.10 0.20 0.60
|
||||
@headitem Offset @tab Size @tab Data type @tab Contents
|
||||
@item 0 @tab 12 @tab Number @tab Offset of the
|
||||
beginning of the chunk.
|
||||
@item 12 @tab 12 @tab Number @tab Size of the chunk.
|
||||
@end multitable
|
||||
|
||||
If the member contains more than four chunks, the @code{isextended}
|
||||
field of the header has the value @code{1} and the main header is
|
||||
followed by one or more @dfn{extension headers}. Each such header has
|
||||
the following structure:
|
||||
|
||||
@multitable @columnfractions 0.10 0.10 0.20 0.20 0.40
|
||||
@headitem Offset @tab Size @tab Name @tab Data type @tab Contents
|
||||
@item 0 @tab 21 @tab sp @tab @code{sparse_header} @tab
|
||||
(21 entires) File map.
|
||||
@item 504 @tab 1 @tab isextended @tab Bool @tab @code{1} if an
|
||||
extension sparse header follows, or @code{0} otherwise.
|
||||
@end multitable
|
||||
|
||||
A header with @code{isextended=0} ends the map.
|
||||
|
||||
@node PAX 0
|
||||
@appendixsubsec PAX Format, Versions 0.0 and 0.1
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex sparse formats, v.0.0
|
||||
There are two formats available in this branch. The version @code{0.0}
|
||||
is the initial version of sparse format used by @command{tar}
|
||||
versions 1.14--1.15.1. The sparse file map is kept in extended
|
||||
(@code{x}) PAX header variables:
|
||||
|
||||
@table @code
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.size, extended header variable
|
||||
@item GNU.sparse.size
|
||||
Real size of the stored file
|
||||
|
||||
@item GNU.sparse.numblocks
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.numblocks, extended header variable
|
||||
Number of blocks in the sparse map
|
||||
|
||||
@item GNU.sparse.offset
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.offset, extended header variable
|
||||
Offset of the data block
|
||||
|
||||
@item GNU.sparse.numbytes
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.numbytes, extended header variable
|
||||
Size of the data block
|
||||
@end table
|
||||
|
||||
The latter two variables repeat for each data block, so the overall
|
||||
structure is like this:
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
@group
|
||||
GNU.sparse.size=@var{size}
|
||||
GNU.sparse.numblocks=@var{numblocks}
|
||||
repeat @var{numblocks} times
|
||||
GNU.sparse.offset=@var{offset}
|
||||
GNU.sparse.numbytes=@var{numbytes}
|
||||
end repeat
|
||||
@end group
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
This format presented the following two problems:
|
||||
|
||||
@enumerate 1
|
||||
@item
|
||||
Whereas the POSIX specification allows a variable to appear multiple
|
||||
times in a header, it requires that only the last occurrence be
|
||||
meaningful. Thus, multiple occurrences of @code{GNU.sparse.offset} and
|
||||
@code{GNU.sparse.numbytes} are conflicting with the POSIX specs.
|
||||
|
||||
@item
|
||||
Attempting to extract such archives using a third-party @command{tar}s
|
||||
results in extraction of sparse files in @emph{compressed form}. If
|
||||
the @command{tar} implementation in question does not support POSIX
|
||||
format, it will also extract a file containing extension header
|
||||
attributes. This file can be used to expand the file to its original
|
||||
state. However, posix-aware @command{tar}s will usually ignore the
|
||||
unknown variables, which makes restoring the file more
|
||||
difficult. @xref{extracting sparse v.0.x, Extraction of sparse
|
||||
members in v.0.0 format}, for the detailed description of how to
|
||||
restore such members using non-GNU @command{tar}s.
|
||||
@end enumerate
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex sparse formats, v.0.1
|
||||
@GNUTAR{} 1.15.2 introduced sparse format version @code{0.1}, which
|
||||
attempted to solve these problems. As its predecessor, this format
|
||||
stores sparse map in the extended POSIX header. It retains
|
||||
@code{GNU.sparse.size} and @code{GNU.sparse.numblocks} variables, but
|
||||
instead of @code{GNU.sparse.offset}/@code{GNU.sparse.numbytes} pairs
|
||||
it uses a single variable:
|
||||
|
||||
@table @code
|
||||
@item GNU.sparse.map
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.map, extended header variable
|
||||
Map of non-null data chunks. It is a string consisting of
|
||||
comma-separated values "@var{offset},@var{size}[,@var{offset-1},@var{size-1}...]"
|
||||
@end table
|
||||
|
||||
To address the 2nd problem, the @code{name} field in @code{ustar}
|
||||
is replaced with a special name, constructed using the following pattern:
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
%d/GNUSparseFile.%p/%f
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.name, extended header variable
|
||||
The real name of the sparse file is stored in the variable
|
||||
@code{GNU.sparse.name}. Thus, those @command{tar} implementations
|
||||
that are not aware of GNU extensions will at least extract the files
|
||||
into separate directories, giving the user a possibility to expand it
|
||||
afterwards. @xref{extracting sparse v.0.x, Extraction of sparse
|
||||
members in v.0.1 format}, for the detailed description of how to
|
||||
restore such members using non-GNU @command{tar}s.
|
||||
|
||||
The resulting @code{GNU.sparse.map} string can be @emph{very} long.
|
||||
Although POSIX does not impose any limit on the length of a @code{x}
|
||||
header variable, this possibly can confuse some tars.
|
||||
|
||||
@node PAX 1
|
||||
@appendixsubsec PAX Format, Version 1.0
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex sparse formats, v.1.0
|
||||
The version @code{1.0} of sparse format was introduced with @GNUTAR{}
|
||||
1.15.92. Its main objective was to make the resulting file
|
||||
extractable with little effort even by non-posix aware @command{tar}
|
||||
implementations. Starting from this version, the extended header
|
||||
preceding a sparse member always contains the following variables that
|
||||
identify the format being used:
|
||||
|
||||
@table @code
|
||||
@item GNU.sparse.major
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.major, extended header variable
|
||||
Major version
|
||||
|
||||
@item GNU.sparse.minor
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.minor, extended header variable
|
||||
Minor version
|
||||
@end table
|
||||
|
||||
The @code{name} field in @code{ustar} header contains a special name,
|
||||
constructed using the following pattern:
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
%d/GNUSparseFile.%p/%f
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.name, extended header variable, in v.1.0
|
||||
@vrindex GNU.sparse.realsize, extended header variable
|
||||
The real name of the sparse file is stored in the variable
|
||||
@code{GNU.sparse.name}. The real size of the file is stored in the
|
||||
variable @code{GNU.sparse.realsize}.
|
||||
|
||||
The sparse map itself is stored in the file data block, preceding the actual
|
||||
file data. It consists of a series of octal numbers of arbitrary length, delimited
|
||||
by newlines. The map is padded with nulls to the nearest block boundary.
|
||||
|
||||
The first number gives the number of entries in the map. Following are map entries,
|
||||
each one consisting of two numbers giving the offset and size of the
|
||||
data block it describes.
|
||||
|
||||
The format is designed in such a way that non-posix aware tars and tars not
|
||||
supporting @code{GNU.sparse.*} keywords will extract each sparse file
|
||||
in its condensed form with the file map prepended and will place it
|
||||
into a separate directory. Then, using a simple program it would be
|
||||
possible to expand the file to its original form even without @GNUTAR{}.
|
||||
@xref{Sparse Recovery}, for the detailed information on how to extract
|
||||
sparse members without @GNUTAR{}.
|
||||
|
||||
58
doc/tar-snapshot-edit.texi
Normal file
58
doc/tar-snapshot-edit.texi
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
|
||||
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
|
||||
@c Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
|
||||
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
|
||||
|
||||
@cindex Device numbers, changing
|
||||
@cindex snapshot files, editing
|
||||
@cindex snapshot files, fixing device numbers
|
||||
Sometimes device numbers can change after upgrading your kernel
|
||||
version or recofiguring the harvare. Reportedly this is the case with
|
||||
some newer @i{Linux} kernels, when using @acronym{LVM}. In majority of
|
||||
cases this change is unnoticed by the users. However, it influences
|
||||
@command{tar} incremental backups: the device number is stored in tar
|
||||
snapshot files (@pxref{Snapshot Files}) and is used to determine whether
|
||||
the file has changed since the last backup. If the device numbers
|
||||
change for some reason, the next backup you run will be a full backup.
|
||||
|
||||
@pindex tar-snapshot-edit
|
||||
To minimize the impact in these cases, GNU @command{tar} comes with
|
||||
the @command{tar-snapshot-edit} utility for inspecting and updating
|
||||
device numbers in snapshot files. The utility, written by
|
||||
Dustin J.@: Mitchell, is available from
|
||||
@uref{http://www.gnu.org/@/software/@/tar/@/utils/@/tar-snapshot-edit.html,
|
||||
@GNUTAR{} home page}.
|
||||
|
||||
To obtain the device numbers used in the snapshot file, run
|
||||
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
$ @kbd{tar-snapshot-edit @var{snapfile}}
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
@noindent
|
||||
where @var{snapfile} is the name of the snapshot file (you can supply as many
|
||||
files as you wish in a single command line ).
|
||||
|
||||
To update all occurrences of the given device number in the file, use
|
||||
@option{-r} option. It takes a single argument of the form
|
||||
@samp{@var{olddev}-@var{newdev}}, where @var{olddev} is the device number
|
||||
used in the snapshot file, and @var{newdev} is the corresponding new device
|
||||
number. Both numbers may be specified in hex (e.g., @samp{0xfe01}),
|
||||
decimal (e.g., @samp{65025}), or as a major:minor number pair (e.g.,
|
||||
@samp{254:1}). To change several device numbers at once, specify them
|
||||
in a single comma-separated list, as in
|
||||
@option{-r 0x3060-0x4500,0x307-0x4600}.
|
||||
|
||||
Before updating the snapshot file, it is a good idea to create a backup
|
||||
copy of it. This is accomplished by @samp{-b} option. The name of the
|
||||
backup file is obtained by appending @samp{~} to the original file name.
|
||||
|
||||
An example session:
|
||||
@smallexample
|
||||
$ @kbd{tar-snapshot-edit /var/backup/snap.a}
|
||||
file version 2
|
||||
/tmp/snap: Device 0x0306 occurs 634 times.
|
||||
$ @kbd{tar-snapshot-edit -b -r 0x0306-0x4500 /var/backup/snap.a}
|
||||
file version 2
|
||||
@end smallexample
|
||||
|
||||
2853
doc/tar.texi
2853
doc/tar.texi
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
|
||||
# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
|
||||
# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at
|
||||
# your option) any later version.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
|
||||
|
||||
13
doc/untabify.el
Normal file
13
doc/untabify.el
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
|
||||
;;;; Untabify the sources.
|
||||
;;;; Usage: emacs -batch -l untabify.el [file ...]
|
||||
|
||||
(defun global-untabify (buflist)
|
||||
(mapcar
|
||||
(lambda (bufname)
|
||||
(set-buffer (find-file bufname))
|
||||
(untabify (point-min) (point-max))
|
||||
(save-buffer)
|
||||
(kill-buffer (current-buffer)))
|
||||
buflist))
|
||||
|
||||
(global-untabify command-line-args-left)
|
||||
@@ -6,12 +6,14 @@ argmatch
|
||||
argp
|
||||
backupfile
|
||||
closeout
|
||||
configmake
|
||||
dirname
|
||||
error
|
||||
exclude
|
||||
exitfail
|
||||
fileblocks
|
||||
fnmatch-gnu
|
||||
fseeko
|
||||
ftruncate
|
||||
full-write
|
||||
getdate
|
||||
@@ -20,26 +22,29 @@ getopt
|
||||
getpagesize
|
||||
gettext
|
||||
gettime
|
||||
gitlog-to-changelog
|
||||
hash
|
||||
human
|
||||
inttypes
|
||||
lchown
|
||||
localcharset
|
||||
memset
|
||||
mkdtemp
|
||||
modechange
|
||||
obstack
|
||||
quote
|
||||
quotearg
|
||||
rmdir
|
||||
rpmatch
|
||||
safe-read
|
||||
save-cwd
|
||||
savedir
|
||||
setenv
|
||||
snprintf
|
||||
stat-time
|
||||
stdbool
|
||||
stdint
|
||||
stpcpy
|
||||
strdup
|
||||
strdup-posix
|
||||
strerror
|
||||
strtol
|
||||
strtoul
|
||||
timespec
|
||||
|
||||
223
lib/.cvsignore
223
lib/.cvsignore
@@ -1,223 +0,0 @@
|
||||
.deps
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
Makefile.am
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
__fpending.c
|
||||
__fpending.h
|
||||
alloca.c
|
||||
alloca.h
|
||||
alloca_.h
|
||||
allocsa.c
|
||||
allocsa.h
|
||||
allocsa.valgrind
|
||||
argmatch.c
|
||||
argmatch.h
|
||||
argp-ba.c
|
||||
argp-eexst.c
|
||||
argp-fmtstream.c
|
||||
argp-fmtstream.h
|
||||
argp-fs-xinl.c
|
||||
argp-help.c
|
||||
argp-namefrob.h
|
||||
argp-parse.c
|
||||
argp-pin.c
|
||||
argp-pv.c
|
||||
argp-pvh.c
|
||||
argp-xinl.c
|
||||
argp.h
|
||||
asnprintf.c
|
||||
atexit.c
|
||||
backupfile.c
|
||||
backupfile.h
|
||||
basename.c
|
||||
charset.alias
|
||||
chdir-long.c
|
||||
chdir-long.h
|
||||
chown.c
|
||||
closeout.c
|
||||
closeout.h
|
||||
config.charset
|
||||
creat-safer.c
|
||||
dirname.c
|
||||
dirname.h
|
||||
dup-safer.c
|
||||
error.c
|
||||
error.h
|
||||
exclude.c
|
||||
exclude.h
|
||||
exit.c
|
||||
exit.h
|
||||
exitfail.c
|
||||
exitfail.h
|
||||
fchown-stub.c
|
||||
fcntl--.h
|
||||
fcntl-safer.h
|
||||
fd-safer.c
|
||||
fileblocks.c
|
||||
fnmatch.c
|
||||
fnmatch.h
|
||||
fnmatch_.h
|
||||
fnmatch_loop.c
|
||||
ftruncate.c
|
||||
full-write.c
|
||||
full-write.h
|
||||
getcwd.c
|
||||
getcwd.h
|
||||
getdate.c
|
||||
getdate.h
|
||||
getdate.y
|
||||
getdelim.c
|
||||
getdelim.h
|
||||
getline.c
|
||||
getline.h
|
||||
getndelim2.c
|
||||
getndelim2.h
|
||||
getopt.c
|
||||
getopt.h
|
||||
getopt1.c
|
||||
getopt_.h
|
||||
getopt_int.h
|
||||
getpagesize.h
|
||||
gettext.h
|
||||
gettime.c
|
||||
gettimeofday.c
|
||||
hash.c
|
||||
hash.h
|
||||
human.c
|
||||
human.h
|
||||
imaxtostr.c
|
||||
intprops.h
|
||||
inttostr.c
|
||||
inttostr.h
|
||||
lchown.c
|
||||
lchown.h
|
||||
localcharset.c
|
||||
localcharset.h
|
||||
localedir.h
|
||||
malloc.c
|
||||
mbchar.c
|
||||
mbchar.h
|
||||
mbuiter.h
|
||||
memchr.c
|
||||
mempcpy.c
|
||||
mempcpy.h
|
||||
memrchr.c
|
||||
memrchr.h
|
||||
memset.c
|
||||
minmax.h
|
||||
mkdirat.c
|
||||
mkdtemp.c
|
||||
mkdtemp.h
|
||||
modechange.c
|
||||
modechange.h
|
||||
obstack.c
|
||||
obstack.h
|
||||
offtostr.c
|
||||
open-safer.c
|
||||
openat-die.c
|
||||
openat-priv.h
|
||||
openat.c
|
||||
openat.h
|
||||
pathmax.h
|
||||
paxconvert.c
|
||||
paxerror.c
|
||||
paxerror.h
|
||||
paxexit.c
|
||||
paxlib.h
|
||||
paxnames.c
|
||||
pipe-safer.c
|
||||
printf-args.c
|
||||
printf-args.h
|
||||
printf-parse.c
|
||||
printf-parse.h
|
||||
quote.c
|
||||
quote.h
|
||||
quotearg.c
|
||||
quotearg.h
|
||||
ref-add.sed
|
||||
ref-add.sin
|
||||
ref-del.sed
|
||||
ref-del.sin
|
||||
regcomp.c
|
||||
regex.c
|
||||
regex.h
|
||||
regex_internal.c
|
||||
regex_internal.h
|
||||
regexec.c
|
||||
rmdir.c
|
||||
rmt.h
|
||||
rpmatch.c
|
||||
rtapelib.c
|
||||
safe-read.c
|
||||
safe-read.h
|
||||
safe-write.c
|
||||
safe-write.h
|
||||
save-cwd.c
|
||||
save-cwd.h
|
||||
savedir.c
|
||||
savedir.h
|
||||
setenv.c
|
||||
setenv.h
|
||||
size_max.h
|
||||
stat-macros.h
|
||||
stat-time.h
|
||||
stdbool.h
|
||||
stdbool_.h
|
||||
stpcpy.c
|
||||
stpcpy.h
|
||||
strcase.h
|
||||
strcasecmp.c
|
||||
strchrnul.c
|
||||
strchrnul.h
|
||||
strdup.c
|
||||
strdup.h
|
||||
stripslash.c
|
||||
strncasecmp.c
|
||||
strndup.c
|
||||
strndup.h
|
||||
strnlen.c
|
||||
strnlen.h
|
||||
strnlen1.c
|
||||
strnlen1.h
|
||||
strtoimax.c
|
||||
strtol.c
|
||||
strtoll.c
|
||||
strtoul.c
|
||||
strtoull.c
|
||||
strtoumax.c
|
||||
sysexit_.h
|
||||
sysexits.h
|
||||
system-ioctl.h
|
||||
system.h
|
||||
time_r.c
|
||||
time_r.h
|
||||
timespec.h
|
||||
umaxtostr.c
|
||||
unistd--.h
|
||||
unistd-safer.h
|
||||
unlinkdir.c
|
||||
unlinkdir.h
|
||||
unlocked-io.h
|
||||
unsetenv.c
|
||||
utime.c
|
||||
utimens.c
|
||||
utimens.h
|
||||
vasnprintf.c
|
||||
vasnprintf.h
|
||||
verify.h
|
||||
version-etc-fsf.c
|
||||
version-etc.c
|
||||
version-etc.h
|
||||
vsnprintf.c
|
||||
vsnprintf.h
|
||||
xalloc-die.c
|
||||
xalloc.h
|
||||
xgetcwd.c
|
||||
xgetcwd.h
|
||||
xmalloc.c
|
||||
xsize.h
|
||||
xstrdup.c
|
||||
xstrtol.c
|
||||
xstrtol.h
|
||||
xstrtoul.c
|
||||
xstrtoumax.c
|
||||
39
lib/Makefile.am
Normal file
39
lib/Makefile.am
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
|
||||
# Makefile for GNU tar library. -*- Makefile -*-
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004,
|
||||
# 2005, 2006, 2007, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
|
||||
# (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
# GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
|
||||
# with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
|
||||
# 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
|
||||
|
||||
noinst_LIBRARIES=libtar.a
|
||||
rmt-command.h : Makefile
|
||||
rm -f $@-t $@
|
||||
echo "#ifndef DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND" >> $@-t
|
||||
echo "# define DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND \"$(DEFAULT_RMT_DIR)/`echo rmt | sed '$(transform)'`$(EXEEXT)\"" >> $@-t
|
||||
echo "#endif" >> $@-t
|
||||
mv $@-t $@
|
||||
BUILT_SOURCES = rmt-command.h
|
||||
CLEANFILES = rmt-command.h rmt-command.h-t
|
||||
INCLUDES = -I$(top_srcdir)/gnu -I../ -I../gnu
|
||||
|
||||
noinst_HEADERS = system.h system-ioctl.h rmt.h paxlib.h stdopen.h
|
||||
libtar_a_SOURCES = \
|
||||
paxerror.c paxexit.c paxlib.h paxnames.c \
|
||||
prepargs.c prepargs.h \
|
||||
rtapelib.c \
|
||||
rmt.h \
|
||||
stdopen.c stdopen.h \
|
||||
system.h system-ioctl.h
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,56 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# Makefile for GNU tar library. -*- Makefile -*-
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004,
|
||||
# 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
## any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
## but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
## MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
## GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
## You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
## along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
## Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
|
||||
## 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
noinst_LIBRARIES = libtar.a
|
||||
noinst_HEADERS = system.h system-ioctl.h localedir.h rmt.h paxlib.h stdopen.h
|
||||
libtar_a_SOURCES = prepargs.c prepargs.h rtapelib.c paxerror.c paxexit.c paxnames.c stdopen.c
|
||||
|
||||
localedir = $(datadir)/locale
|
||||
|
||||
DISTCLEANFILES = localedir.h
|
||||
localedir.h : Makefile
|
||||
echo '#define LOCALEDIR "$(localedir)"' >$@
|
||||
echo "#ifndef DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND" >> $@
|
||||
echo "# define DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND \"$(DEFAULT_RMT_DIR)/`echo rmt | sed '$(transform)'`$(EXEEXT)\"" >> $@
|
||||
echo "#endif" >> $@
|
||||
|
||||
rtapelib.o: localedir.h
|
||||
|
||||
libtar_a_LIBADD = $(LIBOBJS) $(ALLOCA)
|
||||
libtar_a_DEPENDENCIES = $(libtar_a_LIBADD)
|
||||
|
||||
BUILT_SOURCES =
|
||||
AM_CPPFLAGS =
|
||||
EXTRA_DIST = Makefile.tmpl
|
||||
MAINTAINERCLEANFILES =
|
||||
MOSTLYCLEANFILES =
|
||||
lib_OBJECTS = $(libtar_a_OBJECTS)
|
||||
|
||||
# Special rule for getdate
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Say $(srcdir), so GNU make does not report an ambiguity with the .y.c rule.
|
||||
$(srcdir)/getdate.c: getdate.y
|
||||
cd $(srcdir) && \
|
||||
$(YACC) $(YFLAGS) getdate.y && \
|
||||
mv -f y.tab.c getdate.c
|
||||
|
||||
SUFFIXES = .o .c .h
|
||||
CLEANFILES =
|
||||
# gnulib modules
|
||||
508
lib/alloca.c
508
lib/alloca.c
@@ -1,508 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* alloca.c -- allocate automatically reclaimed memory
|
||||
(Mostly) portable public-domain implementation -- D A Gwyn
|
||||
|
||||
This implementation of the PWB library alloca function,
|
||||
which is used to allocate space off the run-time stack so
|
||||
that it is automatically reclaimed upon procedure exit,
|
||||
was inspired by discussions with J. Q. Johnson of Cornell.
|
||||
J.Otto Tennant <jot@cray.com> contributed the Cray support.
|
||||
|
||||
There are some preprocessor constants that can
|
||||
be defined when compiling for your specific system, for
|
||||
improved efficiency; however, the defaults should be okay.
|
||||
|
||||
The general concept of this implementation is to keep
|
||||
track of all alloca-allocated blocks, and reclaim any
|
||||
that are found to be deeper in the stack than the current
|
||||
invocation. This heuristic does not reclaim storage as
|
||||
soon as it becomes invalid, but it will do so eventually.
|
||||
|
||||
As a special case, alloca(0) reclaims storage without
|
||||
allocating any. It is a good idea to use alloca(0) in
|
||||
your main control loop, etc. to force garbage collection. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef emacs
|
||||
# include "lisp.h"
|
||||
# include "blockinput.h"
|
||||
# define xalloc_die() memory_full ()
|
||||
# ifdef EMACS_FREE
|
||||
# undef free
|
||||
# define free EMACS_FREE
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# include <xalloc.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* If compiling with GCC 2, this file's not needed. */
|
||||
#if !defined (__GNUC__) || __GNUC__ < 2
|
||||
|
||||
/* If someone has defined alloca as a macro,
|
||||
there must be some other way alloca is supposed to work. */
|
||||
# ifndef alloca
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef emacs
|
||||
# ifdef static
|
||||
/* actually, only want this if static is defined as ""
|
||||
-- this is for usg, in which emacs must undefine static
|
||||
in order to make unexec workable
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifndef STACK_DIRECTION
|
||||
you
|
||||
lose
|
||||
-- must know STACK_DIRECTION at compile-time
|
||||
/* Using #error here is not wise since this file should work for
|
||||
old and obscure compilers. */
|
||||
# endif /* STACK_DIRECTION undefined */
|
||||
# endif /* static */
|
||||
# endif /* emacs */
|
||||
|
||||
/* If your stack is a linked list of frames, you have to
|
||||
provide an "address metric" ADDRESS_FUNCTION macro. */
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined (CRAY) && defined (CRAY_STACKSEG_END)
|
||||
long i00afunc ();
|
||||
# define ADDRESS_FUNCTION(arg) (char *) i00afunc (&(arg))
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ADDRESS_FUNCTION(arg) &(arg)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef POINTER_TYPE
|
||||
# ifdef __STDC__
|
||||
# define POINTER_TYPE void
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define POINTER_TYPE char
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
typedef POINTER_TYPE *pointer;
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef NULL
|
||||
# define NULL 0
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Define STACK_DIRECTION if you know the direction of stack
|
||||
growth for your system; otherwise it will be automatically
|
||||
deduced at run-time.
|
||||
|
||||
STACK_DIRECTION > 0 => grows toward higher addresses
|
||||
STACK_DIRECTION < 0 => grows toward lower addresses
|
||||
STACK_DIRECTION = 0 => direction of growth unknown */
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef STACK_DIRECTION
|
||||
# define STACK_DIRECTION 0 /* Direction unknown. */
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if STACK_DIRECTION != 0
|
||||
|
||||
# define STACK_DIR STACK_DIRECTION /* Known at compile-time. */
|
||||
|
||||
# else /* STACK_DIRECTION == 0; need run-time code. */
|
||||
|
||||
static int stack_dir; /* 1 or -1 once known. */
|
||||
# define STACK_DIR stack_dir
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
find_stack_direction ()
|
||||
{
|
||||
static char *addr = NULL; /* Address of first `dummy', once known. */
|
||||
auto char dummy; /* To get stack address. */
|
||||
|
||||
if (addr == NULL)
|
||||
{ /* Initial entry. */
|
||||
addr = ADDRESS_FUNCTION (dummy);
|
||||
|
||||
find_stack_direction (); /* Recurse once. */
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Second entry. */
|
||||
if (ADDRESS_FUNCTION (dummy) > addr)
|
||||
stack_dir = 1; /* Stack grew upward. */
|
||||
else
|
||||
stack_dir = -1; /* Stack grew downward. */
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# endif /* STACK_DIRECTION == 0 */
|
||||
|
||||
/* An "alloca header" is used to:
|
||||
(a) chain together all alloca'ed blocks;
|
||||
(b) keep track of stack depth.
|
||||
|
||||
It is very important that sizeof(header) agree with malloc
|
||||
alignment chunk size. The following default should work okay. */
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef ALIGN_SIZE
|
||||
# define ALIGN_SIZE sizeof(double)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
typedef union hdr
|
||||
{
|
||||
char align[ALIGN_SIZE]; /* To force sizeof(header). */
|
||||
struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
union hdr *next; /* For chaining headers. */
|
||||
char *deep; /* For stack depth measure. */
|
||||
} h;
|
||||
} header;
|
||||
|
||||
static header *last_alloca_header = NULL; /* -> last alloca header. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return a pointer to at least SIZE bytes of storage,
|
||||
which will be automatically reclaimed upon exit from
|
||||
the procedure that called alloca. Originally, this space
|
||||
was supposed to be taken from the current stack frame of the
|
||||
caller, but that method cannot be made to work for some
|
||||
implementations of C, for example under Gould's UTX/32. */
|
||||
|
||||
pointer
|
||||
alloca (size)
|
||||
size_t size;
|
||||
{
|
||||
auto char probe; /* Probes stack depth: */
|
||||
register char *depth = ADDRESS_FUNCTION (probe);
|
||||
|
||||
# if STACK_DIRECTION == 0
|
||||
if (STACK_DIR == 0) /* Unknown growth direction. */
|
||||
find_stack_direction ();
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Reclaim garbage, defined as all alloca'd storage that
|
||||
was allocated from deeper in the stack than currently. */
|
||||
|
||||
{
|
||||
register header *hp; /* Traverses linked list. */
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef emacs
|
||||
BLOCK_INPUT;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
for (hp = last_alloca_header; hp != NULL;)
|
||||
if ((STACK_DIR > 0 && hp->h.deep > depth)
|
||||
|| (STACK_DIR < 0 && hp->h.deep < depth))
|
||||
{
|
||||
register header *np = hp->h.next;
|
||||
|
||||
free ((pointer) hp); /* Collect garbage. */
|
||||
|
||||
hp = np; /* -> next header. */
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
break; /* Rest are not deeper. */
|
||||
|
||||
last_alloca_header = hp; /* -> last valid storage. */
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef emacs
|
||||
UNBLOCK_INPUT;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (size == 0)
|
||||
return NULL; /* No allocation required. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Allocate combined header + user data storage. */
|
||||
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Address of header. */
|
||||
register pointer new;
|
||||
|
||||
size_t combined_size = sizeof (header) + size;
|
||||
if (combined_size < sizeof (header))
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
|
||||
new = xmalloc (combined_size);
|
||||
|
||||
if (new == 0)
|
||||
abort();
|
||||
|
||||
((header *) new)->h.next = last_alloca_header;
|
||||
((header *) new)->h.deep = depth;
|
||||
|
||||
last_alloca_header = (header *) new;
|
||||
|
||||
/* User storage begins just after header. */
|
||||
|
||||
return (pointer) ((char *) new + sizeof (header));
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined (CRAY) && defined (CRAY_STACKSEG_END)
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
|
||||
# include <stdio.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef CRAY_STACK
|
||||
# define CRAY_STACK
|
||||
# ifndef CRAY2
|
||||
/* Stack structures for CRAY-1, CRAY X-MP, and CRAY Y-MP */
|
||||
struct stack_control_header
|
||||
{
|
||||
long shgrow:32; /* Number of times stack has grown. */
|
||||
long shaseg:32; /* Size of increments to stack. */
|
||||
long shhwm:32; /* High water mark of stack. */
|
||||
long shsize:32; /* Current size of stack (all segments). */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* The stack segment linkage control information occurs at
|
||||
the high-address end of a stack segment. (The stack
|
||||
grows from low addresses to high addresses.) The initial
|
||||
part of the stack segment linkage control information is
|
||||
0200 (octal) words. This provides for register storage
|
||||
for the routine which overflows the stack. */
|
||||
|
||||
struct stack_segment_linkage
|
||||
{
|
||||
long ss[0200]; /* 0200 overflow words. */
|
||||
long sssize:32; /* Number of words in this segment. */
|
||||
long ssbase:32; /* Offset to stack base. */
|
||||
long:32;
|
||||
long sspseg:32; /* Offset to linkage control of previous
|
||||
segment of stack. */
|
||||
long:32;
|
||||
long sstcpt:32; /* Pointer to task common address block. */
|
||||
long sscsnm; /* Private control structure number for
|
||||
microtasking. */
|
||||
long ssusr1; /* Reserved for user. */
|
||||
long ssusr2; /* Reserved for user. */
|
||||
long sstpid; /* Process ID for pid based multi-tasking. */
|
||||
long ssgvup; /* Pointer to multitasking thread giveup. */
|
||||
long sscray[7]; /* Reserved for Cray Research. */
|
||||
long ssa0;
|
||||
long ssa1;
|
||||
long ssa2;
|
||||
long ssa3;
|
||||
long ssa4;
|
||||
long ssa5;
|
||||
long ssa6;
|
||||
long ssa7;
|
||||
long sss0;
|
||||
long sss1;
|
||||
long sss2;
|
||||
long sss3;
|
||||
long sss4;
|
||||
long sss5;
|
||||
long sss6;
|
||||
long sss7;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
# else /* CRAY2 */
|
||||
/* The following structure defines the vector of words
|
||||
returned by the STKSTAT library routine. */
|
||||
struct stk_stat
|
||||
{
|
||||
long now; /* Current total stack size. */
|
||||
long maxc; /* Amount of contiguous space which would
|
||||
be required to satisfy the maximum
|
||||
stack demand to date. */
|
||||
long high_water; /* Stack high-water mark. */
|
||||
long overflows; /* Number of stack overflow ($STKOFEN) calls. */
|
||||
long hits; /* Number of internal buffer hits. */
|
||||
long extends; /* Number of block extensions. */
|
||||
long stko_mallocs; /* Block allocations by $STKOFEN. */
|
||||
long underflows; /* Number of stack underflow calls ($STKRETN). */
|
||||
long stko_free; /* Number of deallocations by $STKRETN. */
|
||||
long stkm_free; /* Number of deallocations by $STKMRET. */
|
||||
long segments; /* Current number of stack segments. */
|
||||
long maxs; /* Maximum number of stack segments so far. */
|
||||
long pad_size; /* Stack pad size. */
|
||||
long current_address; /* Current stack segment address. */
|
||||
long current_size; /* Current stack segment size. This
|
||||
number is actually corrupted by STKSTAT to
|
||||
include the fifteen word trailer area. */
|
||||
long initial_address; /* Address of initial segment. */
|
||||
long initial_size; /* Size of initial segment. */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following structure describes the data structure which trails
|
||||
any stack segment. I think that the description in 'asdef' is
|
||||
out of date. I only describe the parts that I am sure about. */
|
||||
|
||||
struct stk_trailer
|
||||
{
|
||||
long this_address; /* Address of this block. */
|
||||
long this_size; /* Size of this block (does not include
|
||||
this trailer). */
|
||||
long unknown2;
|
||||
long unknown3;
|
||||
long link; /* Address of trailer block of previous
|
||||
segment. */
|
||||
long unknown5;
|
||||
long unknown6;
|
||||
long unknown7;
|
||||
long unknown8;
|
||||
long unknown9;
|
||||
long unknown10;
|
||||
long unknown11;
|
||||
long unknown12;
|
||||
long unknown13;
|
||||
long unknown14;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
# endif /* CRAY2 */
|
||||
# endif /* not CRAY_STACK */
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef CRAY2
|
||||
/* Determine a "stack measure" for an arbitrary ADDRESS.
|
||||
I doubt that "lint" will like this much. */
|
||||
|
||||
static long
|
||||
i00afunc (long *address)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct stk_stat status;
|
||||
struct stk_trailer *trailer;
|
||||
long *block, size;
|
||||
long result = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* We want to iterate through all of the segments. The first
|
||||
step is to get the stack status structure. We could do this
|
||||
more quickly and more directly, perhaps, by referencing the
|
||||
$LM00 common block, but I know that this works. */
|
||||
|
||||
STKSTAT (&status);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set up the iteration. */
|
||||
|
||||
trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) (status.current_address
|
||||
+ status.current_size
|
||||
- 15);
|
||||
|
||||
/* There must be at least one stack segment. Therefore it is
|
||||
a fatal error if "trailer" is null. */
|
||||
|
||||
if (trailer == 0)
|
||||
abort ();
|
||||
|
||||
/* Discard segments that do not contain our argument address. */
|
||||
|
||||
while (trailer != 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
block = (long *) trailer->this_address;
|
||||
size = trailer->this_size;
|
||||
if (block == 0 || size == 0)
|
||||
abort ();
|
||||
trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) trailer->link;
|
||||
if ((block <= address) && (address < (block + size)))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set the result to the offset in this segment and add the sizes
|
||||
of all predecessor segments. */
|
||||
|
||||
result = address - block;
|
||||
|
||||
if (trailer == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return result;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (trailer->this_size <= 0)
|
||||
abort ();
|
||||
result += trailer->this_size;
|
||||
trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) trailer->link;
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (trailer != 0);
|
||||
|
||||
/* We are done. Note that if you present a bogus address (one
|
||||
not in any segment), you will get a different number back, formed
|
||||
from subtracting the address of the first block. This is probably
|
||||
not what you want. */
|
||||
|
||||
return (result);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# else /* not CRAY2 */
|
||||
/* Stack address function for a CRAY-1, CRAY X-MP, or CRAY Y-MP.
|
||||
Determine the number of the cell within the stack,
|
||||
given the address of the cell. The purpose of this
|
||||
routine is to linearize, in some sense, stack addresses
|
||||
for alloca. */
|
||||
|
||||
static long
|
||||
i00afunc (long address)
|
||||
{
|
||||
long stkl = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
long size, pseg, this_segment, stack;
|
||||
long result = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
struct stack_segment_linkage *ssptr;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Register B67 contains the address of the end of the
|
||||
current stack segment. If you (as a subprogram) store
|
||||
your registers on the stack and find that you are past
|
||||
the contents of B67, you have overflowed the segment.
|
||||
|
||||
B67 also points to the stack segment linkage control
|
||||
area, which is what we are really interested in. */
|
||||
|
||||
stkl = CRAY_STACKSEG_END ();
|
||||
ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
|
||||
|
||||
/* If one subtracts 'size' from the end of the segment,
|
||||
one has the address of the first word of the segment.
|
||||
|
||||
If this is not the first segment, 'pseg' will be
|
||||
nonzero. */
|
||||
|
||||
pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
|
||||
size = ssptr->sssize;
|
||||
|
||||
this_segment = stkl - size;
|
||||
|
||||
/* It is possible that calling this routine itself caused
|
||||
a stack overflow. Discard stack segments which do not
|
||||
contain the target address. */
|
||||
|
||||
while (!(this_segment <= address && address <= stkl))
|
||||
{
|
||||
# ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "%011o %011o %011o\n", this_segment, address, stkl);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
if (pseg == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
stkl = stkl - pseg;
|
||||
ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
|
||||
size = ssptr->sssize;
|
||||
pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
|
||||
this_segment = stkl - size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
result = address - this_segment;
|
||||
|
||||
/* If you subtract pseg from the current end of the stack,
|
||||
you get the address of the previous stack segment's end.
|
||||
This seems a little convoluted to me, but I'll bet you save
|
||||
a cycle somewhere. */
|
||||
|
||||
while (pseg != 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
# ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "%011o %011o\n", pseg, size);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
stkl = stkl - pseg;
|
||||
ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
|
||||
size = ssptr->sssize;
|
||||
pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
|
||||
result += size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return (result);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# endif /* not CRAY2 */
|
||||
# endif /* CRAY */
|
||||
|
||||
# endif /* no alloca */
|
||||
#endif /* not GCC version 2 */
|
||||
280
lib/argmatch.c
280
lib/argmatch.c
@@ -1,280 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* argmatch.c -- find a match for a string in an array
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1990, 1998, 1999, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software
|
||||
Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@ai.mit.edu>
|
||||
Modified by Akim Demaille <demaille@inf.enst.fr> */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Specification. */
|
||||
#include "argmatch.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "gettext.h"
|
||||
#define _(msgid) gettext (msgid)
|
||||
|
||||
#include "error.h"
|
||||
#include "quotearg.h"
|
||||
#include "quote.h"
|
||||
#include "unlocked-io.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* When reporting an invalid argument, show nonprinting characters
|
||||
by using the quoting style ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE. Do not use
|
||||
literal_quoting_style. */
|
||||
#ifndef ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE
|
||||
# define ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE locale_quoting_style
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef EXIT_FAILURE
|
||||
# define EXIT_FAILURE 1
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Non failing version of argmatch call this function after failing. */
|
||||
#ifndef ARGMATCH_DIE
|
||||
# define ARGMATCH_DIE exit (EXIT_FAILURE)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef ARGMATCH_DIE_DECL
|
||||
ARGMATCH_DIE_DECL;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
__argmatch_die (void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
ARGMATCH_DIE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Used by XARGMATCH and XARGCASEMATCH. See description in argmatch.h.
|
||||
Default to __argmatch_die, but allow caller to change this at run-time. */
|
||||
argmatch_exit_fn argmatch_die = __argmatch_die;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* If ARG is an unambiguous match for an element of the
|
||||
null-terminated array ARGLIST, return the index in ARGLIST
|
||||
of the matched element, else -1 if it does not match any element
|
||||
or -2 if it is ambiguous (is a prefix of more than one element).
|
||||
|
||||
If VALLIST is none null, use it to resolve ambiguities limited to
|
||||
synonyms, i.e., for
|
||||
"yes", "yop" -> 0
|
||||
"no", "nope" -> 1
|
||||
"y" is a valid argument, for `0', and "n" for `1'. */
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
argmatch (const char *arg, const char *const *arglist,
|
||||
const char *vallist, size_t valsize)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i; /* Temporary index in ARGLIST. */
|
||||
size_t arglen; /* Length of ARG. */
|
||||
int matchind = -1; /* Index of first nonexact match. */
|
||||
int ambiguous = 0; /* If nonzero, multiple nonexact match(es). */
|
||||
|
||||
arglen = strlen (arg);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Test all elements for either exact match or abbreviated matches. */
|
||||
for (i = 0; arglist[i]; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!strncmp (arglist[i], arg, arglen))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (strlen (arglist[i]) == arglen)
|
||||
/* Exact match found. */
|
||||
return i;
|
||||
else if (matchind == -1)
|
||||
/* First nonexact match found. */
|
||||
matchind = i;
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Second nonexact match found. */
|
||||
if (vallist == NULL
|
||||
|| memcmp (vallist + valsize * matchind,
|
||||
vallist + valsize * i, valsize))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* There is a real ambiguity, or we could not
|
||||
disambiguate. */
|
||||
ambiguous = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (ambiguous)
|
||||
return -2;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return matchind;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Error reporting for argmatch.
|
||||
CONTEXT is a description of the type of entity that was being matched.
|
||||
VALUE is the invalid value that was given.
|
||||
PROBLEM is the return value from argmatch. */
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
argmatch_invalid (const char *context, const char *value, int problem)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char const *format = (problem == -1
|
||||
? _("invalid argument %s for %s")
|
||||
: _("ambiguous argument %s for %s"));
|
||||
|
||||
error (0, 0, format, quotearg_n_style (0, ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE, value),
|
||||
quote_n (1, context));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* List the valid arguments for argmatch.
|
||||
ARGLIST is the same as in argmatch.
|
||||
VALLIST is a pointer to an array of values.
|
||||
VALSIZE is the size of the elements of VALLIST */
|
||||
void
|
||||
argmatch_valid (const char *const *arglist,
|
||||
const char *vallist, size_t valsize)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
const char *last_val = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
/* We try to put synonyms on the same line. The assumption is that
|
||||
synonyms follow each other */
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, _("Valid arguments are:"));
|
||||
for (i = 0; arglist[i]; i++)
|
||||
if ((i == 0)
|
||||
|| memcmp (last_val, vallist + valsize * i, valsize))
|
||||
{
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "\n - `%s'", arglist[i]);
|
||||
last_val = vallist + valsize * i;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, ", `%s'", arglist[i]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
putc ('\n', stderr);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Never failing versions of the previous functions.
|
||||
|
||||
CONTEXT is the context for which argmatch is called (e.g.,
|
||||
"--version-control", or "$VERSION_CONTROL" etc.). Upon failure,
|
||||
calls the (supposed never to return) function EXIT_FN. */
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
__xargmatch_internal (const char *context,
|
||||
const char *arg, const char *const *arglist,
|
||||
const char *vallist, size_t valsize,
|
||||
argmatch_exit_fn exit_fn)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int res = argmatch (arg, arglist, vallist, valsize);
|
||||
if (res >= 0)
|
||||
/* Success. */
|
||||
return res;
|
||||
|
||||
/* We failed. Explain why. */
|
||||
argmatch_invalid (context, arg, res);
|
||||
argmatch_valid (arglist, vallist, valsize);
|
||||
(*exit_fn) ();
|
||||
|
||||
return -1; /* To please the compilers. */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Look for VALUE in VALLIST, an array of objects of size VALSIZE and
|
||||
return the first corresponding argument in ARGLIST */
|
||||
const char *
|
||||
argmatch_to_argument (const char *value,
|
||||
const char *const *arglist,
|
||||
const char *vallist, size_t valsize)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; arglist[i]; i++)
|
||||
if (!memcmp (value, vallist + valsize * i, valsize))
|
||||
return arglist[i];
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef TEST
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Based on "getversion.c" by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *program_name;
|
||||
extern const char *getenv ();
|
||||
|
||||
/* When to make backup files. */
|
||||
enum backup_type
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Never make backups. */
|
||||
none,
|
||||
|
||||
/* Make simple backups of every file. */
|
||||
simple,
|
||||
|
||||
/* Make numbered backups of files that already have numbered backups,
|
||||
and simple backups of the others. */
|
||||
numbered_existing,
|
||||
|
||||
/* Make numbered backups of every file. */
|
||||
numbered
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Two tables describing arguments (keys) and their corresponding
|
||||
values */
|
||||
static const char *const backup_args[] =
|
||||
{
|
||||
"no", "none", "off",
|
||||
"simple", "never",
|
||||
"existing", "nil",
|
||||
"numbered", "t",
|
||||
0
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static const enum backup_type backup_vals[] =
|
||||
{
|
||||
none, none, none,
|
||||
simple, simple,
|
||||
numbered_existing, numbered_existing,
|
||||
numbered, numbered
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main (int argc, const char *const *argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *cp;
|
||||
enum backup_type backup_type = none;
|
||||
|
||||
program_name = (char *) argv[0];
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc > 2)
|
||||
{
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "Usage: %s [VERSION_CONTROL]\n", program_name);
|
||||
exit (1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if ((cp = getenv ("VERSION_CONTROL")))
|
||||
backup_type = XARGMATCH ("$VERSION_CONTROL", cp,
|
||||
backup_args, backup_vals);
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc == 2)
|
||||
backup_type = XARGMATCH (program_name, argv[1],
|
||||
backup_args, backup_vals);
|
||||
|
||||
printf ("The version control is `%s'\n",
|
||||
ARGMATCH_TO_ARGUMENT (backup_type, backup_args, backup_vals));
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
@@ -1,9 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
char *base_name PARAMS ((char const *name));
|
||||
407
lib/error.c
407
lib/error.c
@@ -1,407 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Error handler for noninteractive utilities
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1990-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
|
||||
with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# include <libintl.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# include "gettext.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# include <wchar.h>
|
||||
# define mbsrtowcs __mbsrtowcs
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_VPRINTF || HAVE_DOPRNT || _LIBC
|
||||
# if __STDC__
|
||||
# include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
# define VA_START(args, lastarg) va_start(args, lastarg)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# include <varargs.h>
|
||||
# define VA_START(args, lastarg) va_start(args)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define va_alist a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8
|
||||
# define va_dcl char *a1, *a2, *a3, *a4, *a5, *a6, *a7, *a8;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if STDC_HEADERS || _LIBC
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
void exit ();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "error.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if !_LIBC
|
||||
# include "unlocked-io.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _
|
||||
# define _(String) String
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* If NULL, error will flush stdout, then print on stderr the program
|
||||
name, a colon and a space. Otherwise, error will call this
|
||||
function without parameters instead. */
|
||||
void (*error_print_progname) (
|
||||
#if __STDC__ - 0
|
||||
void
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
);
|
||||
|
||||
/* This variable is incremented each time `error' is called. */
|
||||
unsigned int error_message_count;
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
/* In the GNU C library, there is a predefined variable for this. */
|
||||
|
||||
# define program_name program_invocation_name
|
||||
# include <errno.h>
|
||||
# include <libio/libioP.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/* In GNU libc we want do not want to use the common name `error' directly.
|
||||
Instead make it a weak alias. */
|
||||
extern void __error (int status, int errnum, const char *message, ...)
|
||||
__attribute__ ((__format__ (__printf__, 3, 4)));
|
||||
extern void __error_at_line (int status, int errnum, const char *file_name,
|
||||
unsigned int line_number, const char *message,
|
||||
...)
|
||||
__attribute__ ((__format__ (__printf__, 5, 6)));;
|
||||
# define error __error
|
||||
# define error_at_line __error_at_line
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
# include <libio/iolibio.h>
|
||||
# define fflush(s) INTUSE(_IO_fflush) (s)
|
||||
# undef putc
|
||||
# define putc(c, fp) INTUSE(_IO_putc) (c, fp)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
#else /* not _LIBC */
|
||||
|
||||
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRERROR_R && STRERROR_R_CHAR_P
|
||||
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRERROR_R
|
||||
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
char *strerror_r ();
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The calling program should define program_name and set it to the
|
||||
name of the executing program. */
|
||||
extern char *program_name;
|
||||
|
||||
# if HAVE_STRERROR_R || defined strerror_r
|
||||
# define __strerror_r strerror_r
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# if HAVE_STRERROR
|
||||
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRERROR
|
||||
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRERROR
|
||||
char *strerror ();
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# else
|
||||
static char *
|
||||
private_strerror (int errnum)
|
||||
{
|
||||
extern char *sys_errlist[];
|
||||
extern int sys_nerr;
|
||||
|
||||
if (errnum > 0 && errnum <= sys_nerr)
|
||||
return _(sys_errlist[errnum]);
|
||||
return _("Unknown system error");
|
||||
}
|
||||
# define strerror private_strerror
|
||||
# endif /* HAVE_STRERROR */
|
||||
# endif /* HAVE_STRERROR_R || defined strerror_r */
|
||||
#endif /* not _LIBC */
|
||||
|
||||
static void
|
||||
print_errno_message (int errnum)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char const *s;
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined HAVE_STRERROR_R || _LIBC
|
||||
char errbuf[1024];
|
||||
# if STRERROR_R_CHAR_P || _LIBC
|
||||
s = __strerror_r (errnum, errbuf, sizeof errbuf);
|
||||
# else
|
||||
if (__strerror_r (errnum, errbuf, sizeof errbuf) == 0)
|
||||
s = errbuf;
|
||||
else
|
||||
s = 0;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#else
|
||||
s = strerror (errnum);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if !_LIBC
|
||||
if (! s)
|
||||
s = _("Unknown system error");
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
__fwprintf (stderr, L": %s", s);
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, ": %s", s);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef VA_START
|
||||
static void
|
||||
error_tail (int status, int errnum, const char *message, va_list args)
|
||||
{
|
||||
# if HAVE_VPRINTF || _LIBC
|
||||
# if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
# define ALLOCA_LIMIT 2000
|
||||
size_t len = strlen (message) + 1;
|
||||
wchar_t *wmessage = NULL;
|
||||
mbstate_t st;
|
||||
size_t res;
|
||||
const char *tmp;
|
||||
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (len < ALLOCA_LIMIT)
|
||||
wmessage = (wchar_t *) alloca (len * sizeof (wchar_t));
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (wmessage != NULL && len / 2 < ALLOCA_LIMIT)
|
||||
wmessage = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
wmessage = (wchar_t *) realloc (wmessage,
|
||||
len * sizeof (wchar_t));
|
||||
|
||||
if (wmessage == NULL)
|
||||
{
|
||||
fputws_unlocked (L"out of memory\n", stderr);
|
||||
return;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
memset (&st, '\0', sizeof (st));
|
||||
tmp =message;
|
||||
}
|
||||
while ((res = mbsrtowcs (wmessage, &tmp, len, &st)) == len);
|
||||
|
||||
if (res == (size_t) -1)
|
||||
/* The string cannot be converted. */
|
||||
wmessage = (wchar_t *) L"???";
|
||||
|
||||
__vfwprintf (stderr, wmessage, args);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
vfprintf (stderr, message, args);
|
||||
# else
|
||||
_doprnt (message, args, stderr);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
va_end (args);
|
||||
|
||||
++error_message_count;
|
||||
if (errnum)
|
||||
print_errno_message (errnum);
|
||||
# if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
|
||||
putwc (L'\n', stderr);
|
||||
else
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
putc ('\n', stderr);
|
||||
fflush (stderr);
|
||||
if (status)
|
||||
exit (status);
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Print the program name and error message MESSAGE, which is a printf-style
|
||||
format string with optional args.
|
||||
If ERRNUM is nonzero, print its corresponding system error message.
|
||||
Exit with status STATUS if it is nonzero. */
|
||||
/* VARARGS */
|
||||
void
|
||||
#if defined VA_START && __STDC__
|
||||
error (int status, int errnum, const char *message, ...)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
error (status, errnum, message, va_alist)
|
||||
int status;
|
||||
int errnum;
|
||||
char *message;
|
||||
va_dcl
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
{
|
||||
#ifdef VA_START
|
||||
va_list args;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
fflush (stdout);
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
_IO_flockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# else
|
||||
__flockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
if (error_print_progname)
|
||||
(*error_print_progname) ();
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
|
||||
__fwprintf (stderr, L"%s: ", program_name);
|
||||
else
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "%s: ", program_name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef VA_START
|
||||
VA_START (args, message);
|
||||
error_tail (status, errnum, message, args);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, message, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8);
|
||||
|
||||
++error_message_count;
|
||||
if (errnum)
|
||||
print_errno_message (errnum);
|
||||
putc ('\n', stderr);
|
||||
fflush (stderr);
|
||||
if (status)
|
||||
exit (status);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
_IO_funlockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# else
|
||||
__funlockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Sometimes we want to have at most one error per line. This
|
||||
variable controls whether this mode is selected or not. */
|
||||
int error_one_per_line;
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
#if defined VA_START && __STDC__
|
||||
error_at_line (int status, int errnum, const char *file_name,
|
||||
unsigned int line_number, const char *message, ...)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
error_at_line (status, errnum, file_name, line_number, message, va_alist)
|
||||
int status;
|
||||
int errnum;
|
||||
const char *file_name;
|
||||
unsigned int line_number;
|
||||
char *message;
|
||||
va_dcl
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
{
|
||||
#ifdef VA_START
|
||||
va_list args;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
if (error_one_per_line)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static const char *old_file_name;
|
||||
static unsigned int old_line_number;
|
||||
|
||||
if (old_line_number == line_number
|
||||
&& (file_name == old_file_name
|
||||
|| strcmp (old_file_name, file_name) == 0))
|
||||
/* Simply return and print nothing. */
|
||||
return;
|
||||
|
||||
old_file_name = file_name;
|
||||
old_line_number = line_number;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
fflush (stdout);
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
_IO_flockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# else
|
||||
__flockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
if (error_print_progname)
|
||||
(*error_print_progname) ();
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
|
||||
__fwprintf (stderr, L"%s: ", program_name);
|
||||
else
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "%s:", program_name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (file_name != NULL)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
|
||||
__fwprintf (stderr, L"%s:%d: ", file_name, line_number);
|
||||
else
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "%s:%d: ", file_name, line_number);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef VA_START
|
||||
VA_START (args, message);
|
||||
error_tail (status, errnum, message, args);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, message, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8);
|
||||
|
||||
++error_message_count;
|
||||
if (errnum)
|
||||
print_errno_message (errnum);
|
||||
putc ('\n', stderr);
|
||||
fflush (stderr);
|
||||
if (status)
|
||||
exit (status);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
|
||||
_IO_funlockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# else
|
||||
__funlockfile (stderr);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
/* Make the weak alias. */
|
||||
# undef error
|
||||
# undef error_at_line
|
||||
weak_alias (__error, error)
|
||||
weak_alias (__error_at_line, error_at_line)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
267
lib/exclude.c
267
lib/exclude.c
@@ -1,267 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* exclude.c -- exclude file names
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free
|
||||
Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; see the file COPYING.
|
||||
If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdbool.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRINGS_H
|
||||
# include <strings.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
|
||||
# include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# if HAVE_STDINT_H
|
||||
# include <stdint.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "exclude.h"
|
||||
#include "fnmatch.h"
|
||||
#include "unlocked-io.h"
|
||||
#include "xalloc.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef SIZE_MAX
|
||||
# define SIZE_MAX ((size_t) -1)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Verify a requirement at compile-time (unlike assert, which is runtime). */
|
||||
#define verify(name, assertion) struct name { char a[(assertion) ? 1 : -1]; }
|
||||
|
||||
/* Non-GNU systems lack these options, so we don't need to check them. */
|
||||
#ifndef FNM_CASEFOLD
|
||||
# define FNM_CASEFOLD 0
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef FNM_LEADING_DIR
|
||||
# define FNM_LEADING_DIR 0
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
verify (EXCLUDE_macros_do_not_collide_with_FNM_macros,
|
||||
(((EXCLUDE_ANCHORED | EXCLUDE_INCLUDE | EXCLUDE_WILDCARDS)
|
||||
& (FNM_PATHNAME | FNM_NOESCAPE | FNM_PERIOD | FNM_LEADING_DIR
|
||||
| FNM_CASEFOLD))
|
||||
== 0));
|
||||
|
||||
/* An exclude pattern-options pair. The options are fnmatch options
|
||||
ORed with EXCLUDE_* options. */
|
||||
|
||||
struct patopts
|
||||
{
|
||||
char const *pattern;
|
||||
int options;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* An exclude list, of pattern-options pairs. */
|
||||
|
||||
struct exclude
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct patopts *exclude;
|
||||
size_t exclude_alloc;
|
||||
size_t exclude_count;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return a newly allocated and empty exclude list. */
|
||||
|
||||
struct exclude *
|
||||
new_exclude (void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct exclude *ex = xmalloc (sizeof *ex);
|
||||
ex->exclude_count = 0;
|
||||
ex->exclude_alloc = (1 << 6); /* This must be a power of 2. */
|
||||
ex->exclude = xmalloc (ex->exclude_alloc * sizeof ex->exclude[0]);
|
||||
return ex;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Free the storage associated with an exclude list. */
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
free_exclude (struct exclude *ex)
|
||||
{
|
||||
free (ex->exclude);
|
||||
free (ex);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return zero if PATTERN matches F, obeying OPTIONS, except that
|
||||
(unlike fnmatch) wildcards are disabled in PATTERN. */
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
fnmatch_no_wildcards (char const *pattern, char const *f, int options)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (! (options & FNM_LEADING_DIR))
|
||||
return ((options & FNM_CASEFOLD)
|
||||
? strcasecmp (pattern, f)
|
||||
: strcmp (pattern, f));
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t patlen = strlen (pattern);
|
||||
int r = ((options & FNM_CASEFOLD)
|
||||
? strncasecmp (pattern, f, patlen)
|
||||
: strncmp (pattern, f, patlen));
|
||||
if (! r)
|
||||
{
|
||||
r = f[patlen];
|
||||
if (r == '/')
|
||||
r = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return r;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return true if EX excludes F. */
|
||||
|
||||
bool
|
||||
excluded_filename (struct exclude const *ex, char const *f)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t exclude_count = ex->exclude_count;
|
||||
|
||||
/* If no options are given, the default is to include. */
|
||||
if (exclude_count == 0)
|
||||
return false;
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct patopts const *exclude = ex->exclude;
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Otherwise, the default is the opposite of the first option. */
|
||||
bool excluded = !! (exclude[0].options & EXCLUDE_INCLUDE);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Scan through the options, seeing whether they change F from
|
||||
excluded to included or vice versa. */
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < exclude_count; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char const *pattern = exclude[i].pattern;
|
||||
int options = exclude[i].options;
|
||||
if (excluded == !! (options & EXCLUDE_INCLUDE))
|
||||
{
|
||||
int (*matcher) (char const *, char const *, int) =
|
||||
(options & EXCLUDE_WILDCARDS
|
||||
? fnmatch
|
||||
: fnmatch_no_wildcards);
|
||||
bool matched = ((*matcher) (pattern, f, options) == 0);
|
||||
char const *p;
|
||||
|
||||
if (! (options & EXCLUDE_ANCHORED))
|
||||
for (p = f; *p && ! matched; p++)
|
||||
if (*p == '/' && p[1] != '/')
|
||||
matched = ((*matcher) (pattern, p + 1, options) == 0);
|
||||
|
||||
excluded ^= matched;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return excluded;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Append to EX the exclusion PATTERN with OPTIONS. */
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
add_exclude (struct exclude *ex, char const *pattern, int options)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct patopts *patopts;
|
||||
|
||||
if (ex->exclude_alloc <= ex->exclude_count)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t s = 2 * ex->exclude_alloc;
|
||||
if (! (0 < s && s <= SIZE_MAX / sizeof ex->exclude[0]))
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
ex->exclude_alloc = s;
|
||||
ex->exclude = xrealloc (ex->exclude, s * sizeof ex->exclude[0]);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
patopts = &ex->exclude[ex->exclude_count++];
|
||||
patopts->pattern = pattern;
|
||||
patopts->options = options;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Use ADD_FUNC to append to EX the patterns in FILENAME, each with
|
||||
OPTIONS. LINE_END terminates each pattern in the file. Return -1
|
||||
on failure, 0 on success. */
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
add_exclude_file (void (*add_func) (struct exclude *, char const *, int),
|
||||
struct exclude *ex, char const *filename, int options,
|
||||
char line_end)
|
||||
{
|
||||
bool use_stdin = filename[0] == '-' && !filename[1];
|
||||
FILE *in;
|
||||
char *buf;
|
||||
char *p;
|
||||
char const *pattern;
|
||||
char const *lim;
|
||||
size_t buf_alloc = (1 << 10); /* This must be a power of two. */
|
||||
size_t buf_count = 0;
|
||||
int c;
|
||||
int e = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (use_stdin)
|
||||
in = stdin;
|
||||
else if (! (in = fopen (filename, "r")))
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
buf = xmalloc (buf_alloc);
|
||||
|
||||
while ((c = getc (in)) != EOF)
|
||||
{
|
||||
buf[buf_count++] = c;
|
||||
if (buf_count == buf_alloc)
|
||||
{
|
||||
buf_alloc *= 2;
|
||||
if (! buf_alloc)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
buf = xrealloc (buf, buf_alloc);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (ferror (in))
|
||||
e = errno;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!use_stdin && fclose (in) != 0)
|
||||
e = errno;
|
||||
|
||||
buf = xrealloc (buf, buf_count + 1);
|
||||
|
||||
for (pattern = p = buf, lim = buf + buf_count; p <= lim; p++)
|
||||
if (p < lim ? *p == line_end : buf < p && p[-1])
|
||||
{
|
||||
*p = '\0';
|
||||
(*add_func) (ex, pattern, options);
|
||||
pattern = p + 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
errno = e;
|
||||
return e ? -1 : 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
@@ -1,43 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* exclude.h -- declarations for excluding file names
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1999, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free
|
||||
Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; see the file COPYING.
|
||||
If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Exclude options, which can be ORed with fnmatch options. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Patterns must match the start of file names, instead of matching
|
||||
anywhere after a '/'. */
|
||||
#define EXCLUDE_ANCHORED (1 << 30)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Include instead of exclude. */
|
||||
#define EXCLUDE_INCLUDE (1 << 29)
|
||||
|
||||
/* '?', '*', '[', and '\\' are special in patterns. Without this
|
||||
option, these characters are ordinary and fnmatch is not used. */
|
||||
#define EXCLUDE_WILDCARDS (1 << 28)
|
||||
|
||||
struct exclude;
|
||||
|
||||
struct exclude *new_exclude (void);
|
||||
void free_exclude (struct exclude *);
|
||||
void add_exclude (struct exclude *, char const *, int);
|
||||
int add_exclude_file (void (*) (struct exclude *, char const *, int),
|
||||
struct exclude *, char const *, int, char);
|
||||
bool excluded_filename (struct exclude const *, char const *);
|
||||
385
lib/fnmatch.c
385
lib/fnmatch.c
@@ -1,385 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Copyright (C) 1991, 1992, 1993, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
|
||||
2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Enable GNU extensions in fnmatch.h. */
|
||||
#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
|
||||
# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __GNUC__
|
||||
# define alloca __builtin_alloca
|
||||
# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
|
||||
# include <alloca.h>
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# ifdef _AIX
|
||||
# pragma alloca
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# ifndef alloca
|
||||
char *alloca ();
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if ! defined __builtin_expect && __GNUC__ < 3
|
||||
# define __builtin_expect(expr, expected) (expr)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <assert.h>
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#include <fnmatch.h>
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# if HAVE_STRINGS_H
|
||||
# include <strings.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
|
||||
# include <stddef.h>
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define WIDE_CHAR_SUPPORT (HAVE_WCTYPE_H && HAVE_WCHAR_H && HAVE_BTOWC)
|
||||
|
||||
/* For platform which support the ISO C amendement 1 functionality we
|
||||
support user defined character classes. */
|
||||
#if defined _LIBC || WIDE_CHAR_SUPPORT
|
||||
/* Solaris 2.5 has a bug: <wchar.h> must be included before <wctype.h>. */
|
||||
# include <wchar.h>
|
||||
# include <wctype.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* We need some of the locale data (the collation sequence information)
|
||||
but there is no interface to get this information in general. Therefore
|
||||
we support a correct implementation only in glibc. */
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
|
||||
# include "../locale/elem-hash.h"
|
||||
# include "../locale/coll-lookup.h"
|
||||
# include <shlib-compat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
# define CONCAT(a,b) __CONCAT(a,b)
|
||||
# define mbsinit __mbsinit
|
||||
# define mbsrtowcs __mbsrtowcs
|
||||
# define fnmatch __fnmatch
|
||||
extern int fnmatch (const char *pattern, const char *string, int flags);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* We often have to test for FNM_FILE_NAME and FNM_PERIOD being both set. */
|
||||
#define NO_LEADING_PERIOD(flags) \
|
||||
((flags & (FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_PERIOD)) == (FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_PERIOD))
|
||||
|
||||
/* Comment out all this code if we are using the GNU C Library, are not
|
||||
actually compiling the library itself, and have not detected a bug
|
||||
in the library. This code is part of the GNU C
|
||||
Library, but also included in many other GNU distributions. Compiling
|
||||
and linking in this code is a waste when using the GNU C library
|
||||
(especially if it is a shared library). Rather than having every GNU
|
||||
program understand `configure --with-gnu-libc' and omit the object files,
|
||||
it is simpler to just do this in the source for each such file. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined _LIBC || !defined __GNU_LIBRARY__ || !HAVE_FNMATCH_GNU
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined STDC_HEADERS || !defined isascii
|
||||
# define ISASCII(c) 1
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ISASCII(c) isascii(c)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef isblank
|
||||
# define ISBLANK(c) (ISASCII (c) && isblank (c))
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ISBLANK(c) ((c) == ' ' || (c) == '\t')
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifdef isgraph
|
||||
# define ISGRAPH(c) (ISASCII (c) && isgraph (c))
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ISGRAPH(c) (ISASCII (c) && isprint (c) && !isspace (c))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# define ISPRINT(c) (ISASCII (c) && isprint (c))
|
||||
# define ISDIGIT(c) (ISASCII (c) && isdigit (c))
|
||||
# define ISALNUM(c) (ISASCII (c) && isalnum (c))
|
||||
# define ISALPHA(c) (ISASCII (c) && isalpha (c))
|
||||
# define ISCNTRL(c) (ISASCII (c) && iscntrl (c))
|
||||
# define ISLOWER(c) (ISASCII (c) && islower (c))
|
||||
# define ISPUNCT(c) (ISASCII (c) && ispunct (c))
|
||||
# define ISSPACE(c) (ISASCII (c) && isspace (c))
|
||||
# define ISUPPER(c) (ISASCII (c) && isupper (c))
|
||||
# define ISXDIGIT(c) (ISASCII (c) && isxdigit (c))
|
||||
|
||||
# define STREQ(s1, s2) ((strcmp (s1, s2) == 0))
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined _LIBC || WIDE_CHAR_SUPPORT
|
||||
/* The GNU C library provides support for user-defined character classes
|
||||
and the functions from ISO C amendement 1. */
|
||||
# ifdef CHARCLASS_NAME_MAX
|
||||
# define CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH CHARCLASS_NAME_MAX
|
||||
# else
|
||||
/* This shouldn't happen but some implementation might still have this
|
||||
problem. Use a reasonable default value. */
|
||||
# define CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH 256
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) __wctype (string)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) wctype (string)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# define ISWCTYPE(WC, WT) __iswctype (WC, WT)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ISWCTYPE(WC, WT) iswctype (WC, WT)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if (HAVE_MBSTATE_T && HAVE_MBSRTOWCS) || _LIBC
|
||||
/* In this case we are implementing the multibyte character handling. */
|
||||
# define HANDLE_MULTIBYTE 1
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH 6 /* Namely, `xdigit'. */
|
||||
|
||||
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) \
|
||||
(STREQ (string, "alpha") || STREQ (string, "upper") \
|
||||
|| STREQ (string, "lower") || STREQ (string, "digit") \
|
||||
|| STREQ (string, "alnum") || STREQ (string, "xdigit") \
|
||||
|| STREQ (string, "space") || STREQ (string, "print") \
|
||||
|| STREQ (string, "punct") || STREQ (string, "graph") \
|
||||
|| STREQ (string, "cntrl") || STREQ (string, "blank"))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Avoid depending on library functions or files
|
||||
whose names are inconsistent. */
|
||||
|
||||
# if !defined _LIBC && !defined getenv && !HAVE_DECL_GETENV
|
||||
extern char *getenv ();
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Global variable. */
|
||||
static int posixly_correct;
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef internal_function
|
||||
/* Inside GNU libc we mark some function in a special way. In other
|
||||
environments simply ignore the marking. */
|
||||
# define internal_function
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Note that this evaluates C many times. */
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) ? tolower (c) : (c))
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) && ISUPPER (c) ? tolower (c) : (c))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# define CHAR char
|
||||
# define UCHAR unsigned char
|
||||
# define INT int
|
||||
# define FCT internal_fnmatch
|
||||
# define EXT ext_match
|
||||
# define END end_pattern
|
||||
# define L(CS) CS
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# define BTOWC(C) __btowc (C)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define BTOWC(C) btowc (C)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# define STRLEN(S) strlen (S)
|
||||
# define STRCAT(D, S) strcat (D, S)
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) __mempcpy (D, S, N)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# if HAVE_MEMPCPY
|
||||
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) mempcpy (D, S, N)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) ((void *) ((char *) memcpy (D, S, N) + (N)))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# define MEMCHR(S, C, N) memchr (S, C, N)
|
||||
# define STRCOLL(S1, S2) strcoll (S1, S2)
|
||||
# include "fnmatch_loop.c"
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
|
||||
# define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) ? towlower (c) : (c))
|
||||
# define CHAR wchar_t
|
||||
# define UCHAR wint_t
|
||||
# define INT wint_t
|
||||
# define FCT internal_fnwmatch
|
||||
# define EXT ext_wmatch
|
||||
# define END end_wpattern
|
||||
# define L(CS) L##CS
|
||||
# define BTOWC(C) (C)
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# define STRLEN(S) __wcslen (S)
|
||||
# define STRCAT(D, S) __wcscat (D, S)
|
||||
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) __wmempcpy (D, S, N)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define STRLEN(S) wcslen (S)
|
||||
# define STRCAT(D, S) wcscat (D, S)
|
||||
# if HAVE_WMEMPCPY
|
||||
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) wmempcpy (D, S, N)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) (wmemcpy (D, S, N) + (N))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# define MEMCHR(S, C, N) wmemchr (S, C, N)
|
||||
# define STRCOLL(S1, S2) wcscoll (S1, S2)
|
||||
# define WIDE_CHAR_VERSION 1
|
||||
|
||||
# undef IS_CHAR_CLASS
|
||||
/* We have to convert the wide character string in a multibyte string. But
|
||||
we know that the character class names consist of alphanumeric characters
|
||||
from the portable character set, and since the wide character encoding
|
||||
for a member of the portable character set is the same code point as
|
||||
its single-byte encoding, we can use a simplified method to convert the
|
||||
string to a multibyte character string. */
|
||||
static wctype_t
|
||||
is_char_class (const wchar_t *wcs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char s[CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH + 1];
|
||||
char *cp = s;
|
||||
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Test for a printable character from the portable character set. */
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
if (*wcs < 0x20 || *wcs > 0x7e
|
||||
|| *wcs == 0x24 || *wcs == 0x40 || *wcs == 0x60)
|
||||
return (wctype_t) 0;
|
||||
# else
|
||||
switch (*wcs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case L' ': case L'!': case L'"': case L'#': case L'%':
|
||||
case L'&': case L'\'': case L'(': case L')': case L'*':
|
||||
case L'+': case L',': case L'-': case L'.': case L'/':
|
||||
case L'0': case L'1': case L'2': case L'3': case L'4':
|
||||
case L'5': case L'6': case L'7': case L'8': case L'9':
|
||||
case L':': case L';': case L'<': case L'=': case L'>':
|
||||
case L'?':
|
||||
case L'A': case L'B': case L'C': case L'D': case L'E':
|
||||
case L'F': case L'G': case L'H': case L'I': case L'J':
|
||||
case L'K': case L'L': case L'M': case L'N': case L'O':
|
||||
case L'P': case L'Q': case L'R': case L'S': case L'T':
|
||||
case L'U': case L'V': case L'W': case L'X': case L'Y':
|
||||
case L'Z':
|
||||
case L'[': case L'\\': case L']': case L'^': case L'_':
|
||||
case L'a': case L'b': case L'c': case L'd': case L'e':
|
||||
case L'f': case L'g': case L'h': case L'i': case L'j':
|
||||
case L'k': case L'l': case L'm': case L'n': case L'o':
|
||||
case L'p': case L'q': case L'r': case L's': case L't':
|
||||
case L'u': case L'v': case L'w': case L'x': case L'y':
|
||||
case L'z': case L'{': case L'|': case L'}': case L'~':
|
||||
break;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
return (wctype_t) 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Avoid overrunning the buffer. */
|
||||
if (cp == s + CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH)
|
||||
return (wctype_t) 0;
|
||||
|
||||
*cp++ = (char) *wcs++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (*wcs != L'\0');
|
||||
|
||||
*cp = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
return __wctype (s);
|
||||
# else
|
||||
return wctype (s);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) is_char_class (string)
|
||||
|
||||
# include "fnmatch_loop.c"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
fnmatch (pattern, string, flags)
|
||||
const char *pattern;
|
||||
const char *string;
|
||||
int flags;
|
||||
{
|
||||
# if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
|
||||
if (__builtin_expect (MB_CUR_MAX, 1) != 1)
|
||||
{
|
||||
mbstate_t ps;
|
||||
size_t n;
|
||||
wchar_t *wpattern;
|
||||
wchar_t *wstring;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Convert the strings into wide characters. */
|
||||
memset (&ps, '\0', sizeof (ps));
|
||||
n = mbsrtowcs (NULL, &pattern, 0, &ps);
|
||||
if (__builtin_expect (n, 0) == (size_t) -1)
|
||||
/* Something wrong.
|
||||
XXX Do we have to set `errno' to something which mbsrtows hasn't
|
||||
already done? */
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
wpattern = (wchar_t *) alloca ((n + 1) * sizeof (wchar_t));
|
||||
assert (mbsinit (&ps));
|
||||
(void) mbsrtowcs (wpattern, &pattern, n + 1, &ps);
|
||||
|
||||
assert (mbsinit (&ps));
|
||||
n = mbsrtowcs (NULL, &string, 0, &ps);
|
||||
if (__builtin_expect (n, 0) == (size_t) -1)
|
||||
/* Something wrong.
|
||||
XXX Do we have to set `errno' to something which mbsrtows hasn't
|
||||
already done? */
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
wstring = (wchar_t *) alloca ((n + 1) * sizeof (wchar_t));
|
||||
assert (mbsinit (&ps));
|
||||
(void) mbsrtowcs (wstring, &string, n + 1, &ps);
|
||||
|
||||
return internal_fnwmatch (wpattern, wstring, wstring + n,
|
||||
flags & FNM_PERIOD, flags);
|
||||
}
|
||||
# endif /* mbstate_t and mbsrtowcs or _LIBC. */
|
||||
|
||||
return internal_fnmatch (pattern, string, string + strlen (string),
|
||||
flags & FNM_PERIOD, flags);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
# undef fnmatch
|
||||
versioned_symbol (libc, __fnmatch, fnmatch, GLIBC_2_2_3);
|
||||
# if SHLIB_COMPAT(libc, GLIBC_2_0, GLIBC_2_2_3)
|
||||
strong_alias (__fnmatch, __fnmatch_old)
|
||||
compat_symbol (libc, __fnmatch_old, fnmatch, GLIBC_2_0);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _LIBC or not __GNU_LIBRARY__. */
|
||||
@@ -1,84 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Copyright (C) 1991, 92, 93, 96, 97, 98 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
This file is part of the GNU C Library.
|
||||
|
||||
The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as
|
||||
published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the
|
||||
License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
Library General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||||
License along with the GNU C Library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not,
|
||||
write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||||
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _FNMATCH_H
|
||||
#define _FNMATCH_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined __cplusplus || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__) || defined WINDOWS32
|
||||
# if !defined __GLIBC__ || !defined __P
|
||||
# undef __P
|
||||
# define __P(protos) protos
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#else /* Not C++ or ANSI C. */
|
||||
# undef __P
|
||||
# define __P(protos) ()
|
||||
/* We can get away without defining `const' here only because in this file
|
||||
it is used only inside the prototype for `fnmatch', which is elided in
|
||||
non-ANSI C where `const' is problematical. */
|
||||
#endif /* C++ or ANSI C. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef const
|
||||
# if (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__) || defined __cplusplus
|
||||
# define __const const
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define __const
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* We #undef these before defining them because some losing systems
|
||||
(HP-UX A.08.07 for example) define these in <unistd.h>. */
|
||||
#undef FNM_PATHNAME
|
||||
#undef FNM_NOESCAPE
|
||||
#undef FNM_PERIOD
|
||||
|
||||
/* Bits set in the FLAGS argument to `fnmatch'. */
|
||||
#define FNM_PATHNAME (1 << 0) /* No wildcard can ever match `/'. */
|
||||
#define FNM_NOESCAPE (1 << 1) /* Backslashes don't quote special chars. */
|
||||
#define FNM_PERIOD (1 << 2) /* Leading `.' is matched only explicitly. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if !defined _POSIX_C_SOURCE || _POSIX_C_SOURCE < 2 || defined _GNU_SOURCE
|
||||
# define FNM_FILE_NAME FNM_PATHNAME /* Preferred GNU name. */
|
||||
# define FNM_LEADING_DIR (1 << 3) /* Ignore `/...' after a match. */
|
||||
# define FNM_CASEFOLD (1 << 4) /* Compare without regard to case. */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Value returned by `fnmatch' if STRING does not match PATTERN. */
|
||||
#define FNM_NOMATCH 1
|
||||
|
||||
/* This value is returned if the implementation does not support
|
||||
`fnmatch'. Since this is not the case here it will never be
|
||||
returned but the conformance test suites still require the symbol
|
||||
to be defined. */
|
||||
#ifdef _XOPEN_SOURCE
|
||||
# define FNM_NOSYS (-1)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Match STRING against the filename pattern PATTERN,
|
||||
returning zero if it matches, FNM_NOMATCH if not. */
|
||||
extern int fnmatch __P ((__const char *__pattern, __const char *__string,
|
||||
int __flags));
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* fnmatch.h */
|
||||
@@ -1,474 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Copyright (C) 1991-1993, 1996-1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
This file is part of the GNU C Library.
|
||||
|
||||
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as
|
||||
published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the
|
||||
License, or (at your option) any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
Library General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||||
License along with this library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not,
|
||||
write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
|
||||
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Match STRING against the filename pattern PATTERN, returning zero if
|
||||
it matches, nonzero if not. */
|
||||
static int FCT (const CHAR *pattern, const CHAR *string,
|
||||
int no_leading_period, int flags) internal_function;
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
internal_function
|
||||
FCT (pattern, string, no_leading_period, flags)
|
||||
const CHAR *pattern;
|
||||
const CHAR *string;
|
||||
int no_leading_period;
|
||||
int flags;
|
||||
{
|
||||
register const CHAR *p = pattern, *n = string;
|
||||
register UCHAR c;
|
||||
#ifdef _LIBC
|
||||
const UCHAR *collseq = (const UCHAR *)
|
||||
_NL_CURRENT(LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_COLLSEQ,SUFFIX));
|
||||
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
|
||||
const wint_t *names = (const wint_t *)
|
||||
_NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_NAMES);
|
||||
size_t size = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_HASH_SIZE);
|
||||
size_t layers = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_HASH_LAYERS);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
while ((c = *p++) != L('\0'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
c = FOLD (c);
|
||||
|
||||
switch (c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case L('?'):
|
||||
if (*n == L('\0'))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
else if (*n == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
else if (*n == L('.') && no_leading_period
|
||||
&& (n == string
|
||||
|| (n[-1] == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case L('\\'):
|
||||
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE))
|
||||
{
|
||||
c = *p++;
|
||||
if (c == L('\0'))
|
||||
/* Trailing \ loses. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
c = FOLD (c);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (FOLD ((UCHAR) *n) != c)
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case L('*'):
|
||||
if (*n == L('.') && no_leading_period
|
||||
&& (n == string
|
||||
|| (n[-1] == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
for (c = *p++; c == L('?') || c == L('*'); c = *p++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (*n == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
|
||||
/* A slash does not match a wildcard under FNM_FILE_NAME. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
else if (c == L('?'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* A ? needs to match one character. */
|
||||
if (*n == L('\0'))
|
||||
/* There isn't another character; no match. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
else
|
||||
/* One character of the string is consumed in matching
|
||||
this ? wildcard, so *??? won't match if there are
|
||||
less than three characters. */
|
||||
++n;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (c == L('\0'))
|
||||
/* The wildcard(s) is/are the last element of the pattern.
|
||||
If the name is a file name and contains another slash
|
||||
this does mean it cannot match. If the FNM_LEADING_DIR
|
||||
flag is set and exactly one slash is following, we have
|
||||
a match. */
|
||||
{
|
||||
int result = (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME) == 0 ? 0 : FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
if (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)
|
||||
{
|
||||
const CHAR *slashp = STRCHR (n, L('/'));
|
||||
|
||||
if (flags & FNM_LEADING_DIR)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (slashp != NULL
|
||||
&& STRCHR (slashp + 1, L('/')) == NULL)
|
||||
result = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (slashp == NULL)
|
||||
result = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return result;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
const CHAR *endp;
|
||||
|
||||
endp = STRCHRNUL (n, (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME) ? L('/') : L('\0'));
|
||||
|
||||
if (c == L('['))
|
||||
{
|
||||
int flags2 = ((flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)
|
||||
? flags : (flags & ~FNM_PERIOD));
|
||||
|
||||
for (--p; n < endp; ++n)
|
||||
if (FCT (p, n, (no_leading_period
|
||||
&& (n == string
|
||||
|| (n[-1] == L('/')
|
||||
&& (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)))),
|
||||
flags2) == 0)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (c == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
|
||||
{
|
||||
while (*n != L('\0') && *n != L('/'))
|
||||
++n;
|
||||
if (*n == L('/')
|
||||
&& (FCT (p, n + 1, flags & FNM_PERIOD, flags) == 0))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
int flags2 = ((flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)
|
||||
? flags : (flags & ~FNM_PERIOD));
|
||||
|
||||
if (c == L('\\') && !(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE))
|
||||
c = *p;
|
||||
c = FOLD (c);
|
||||
for (--p; n < endp; ++n)
|
||||
if (FOLD ((UCHAR) *n) == c
|
||||
&& (FCT (p, n, (no_leading_period
|
||||
&& (n == string
|
||||
|| (n[-1] == L('/')
|
||||
&& (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)))),
|
||||
flags2) == 0))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* If we come here no match is possible with the wildcard. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
case L('['):
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Nonzero if the sense of the character class is inverted. */
|
||||
static int posixly_correct;
|
||||
register int not;
|
||||
CHAR cold;
|
||||
|
||||
if (posixly_correct == 0)
|
||||
posixly_correct = getenv ("POSIXLY_CORRECT") != NULL ? 1 : -1;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*n == L('\0'))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*n == L('.') && no_leading_period
|
||||
&& (n == string
|
||||
|| (n[-1] == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
if (*n == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
|
||||
/* `/' cannot be matched. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
not = (*p == L('!') || (posixly_correct < 0 && *p == L('^')));
|
||||
if (not)
|
||||
++p;
|
||||
|
||||
c = *p++;
|
||||
for (;;)
|
||||
{
|
||||
UCHAR fn = FOLD ((UCHAR) *n);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && c == L('\\'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (*p == L('\0'))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
c = FOLD ((UCHAR) *p);
|
||||
++p;
|
||||
|
||||
if (c == fn)
|
||||
goto matched;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (c == L('[') && *p == L(':'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Leave room for the null. */
|
||||
CHAR str[CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH + 1];
|
||||
size_t c1 = 0;
|
||||
#if defined _LIBC || (defined HAVE_WCTYPE_H && defined HAVE_WCHAR_H)
|
||||
wctype_t wt;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
const CHAR *startp = p;
|
||||
|
||||
for (;;)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (c1 == CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH)
|
||||
/* The name is too long and therefore the pattern
|
||||
is ill-formed. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
c = *++p;
|
||||
if (c == L(':') && p[1] == L(']'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
p += 2;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (c < L('a') || c >= L('z'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* This cannot possibly be a character class name.
|
||||
Match it as a normal range. */
|
||||
p = startp;
|
||||
c = L('[');
|
||||
goto normal_bracket;
|
||||
}
|
||||
str[c1++] = c;
|
||||
}
|
||||
str[c1] = L('\0');
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined _LIBC || (defined HAVE_WCTYPE_H && defined HAVE_WCHAR_H)
|
||||
wt = IS_CHAR_CLASS (str);
|
||||
if (wt == 0)
|
||||
/* Invalid character class name. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
if (ISWCTYPE (BTOWC ((UCHAR) *n), wt))
|
||||
goto matched;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
if ((STREQ (str, L("alnum")) && ISALNUM ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("alpha")) && ISALPHA ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("blank")) && ISBLANK ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("cntrl")) && ISCNTRL ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("digit")) && ISDIGIT ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("graph")) && ISGRAPH ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("lower")) && ISLOWER ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("print")) && ISPRINT ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("punct")) && ISPUNCT ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("space")) && ISSPACE ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("upper")) && ISUPPER ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
|| (STREQ (str, L("xdigit")) && ISXDIGIT ((UCHAR) *n)))
|
||||
goto matched;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (c == L('\0'))
|
||||
/* [ (unterminated) loses. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
c = FOLD (c);
|
||||
normal_bracket:
|
||||
if (c == fn)
|
||||
goto matched;
|
||||
|
||||
cold = c;
|
||||
c = *p++;
|
||||
|
||||
if (c == L('-') && *p != L(']'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if _LIBC
|
||||
/* We have to find the collation sequence
|
||||
value for C. Collation sequence is nothing
|
||||
we can regularly access. The sequence
|
||||
value is defined by the order in which the
|
||||
definitions of the collation values for the
|
||||
various characters appear in the source
|
||||
file. A strange concept, nowhere
|
||||
documented. */
|
||||
int32_t fseqidx;
|
||||
int32_t lseqidx;
|
||||
UCHAR cend = *p++;
|
||||
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
|
||||
size_t cnt;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && cend == L('\\'))
|
||||
cend = *p++;
|
||||
if (cend == L('\0'))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
|
||||
/* Search in the `names' array for the characters. */
|
||||
fseqidx = fn % size;
|
||||
cnt = 0;
|
||||
while (names[fseqidx] != fn)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (++cnt == layers)
|
||||
/* XXX We don't know anything about
|
||||
the character we are supposed to
|
||||
match. This means we are failing. */
|
||||
goto range_not_matched;
|
||||
|
||||
fseqidx += size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
lseqidx = cold % size;
|
||||
cnt = 0;
|
||||
while (names[lseqidx] != cold)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (++cnt == layers)
|
||||
{
|
||||
lseqidx = -1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
lseqidx += size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
# else
|
||||
fseqidx = fn;
|
||||
lseqidx = cold;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* XXX It is not entirely clear to me how to handle
|
||||
characters which are not mentioned in the
|
||||
collation specification. */
|
||||
if (
|
||||
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
|
||||
lseqidx == -1 ||
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
collseq[lseqidx] <= collseq[fseqidx])
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* We have to look at the upper bound. */
|
||||
int32_t hseqidx;
|
||||
|
||||
cend = FOLD (cend);
|
||||
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
|
||||
hseqidx = cend % size;
|
||||
cnt = 0;
|
||||
while (names[hseqidx] != cend)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (++cnt == layers)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Hum, no information about the upper
|
||||
bound. The matching succeeds if the
|
||||
lower bound is matched exactly. */
|
||||
if (lseqidx == -1 || cold != fn)
|
||||
goto range_not_matched;
|
||||
|
||||
goto matched;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
# else
|
||||
hseqidx = cend;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
if (
|
||||
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
|
||||
(lseqidx == -1
|
||||
&& collseq[fseqidx] == collseq[hseqidx]) ||
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
collseq[fseqidx] <= collseq[hseqidx])
|
||||
goto matched;
|
||||
}
|
||||
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
|
||||
range_not_matched:
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#else
|
||||
/* We use a boring value comparison of the character
|
||||
values. This is better than comparing using
|
||||
`strcoll' since the latter would have surprising
|
||||
and sometimes fatal consequences. */
|
||||
UCHAR cend = *p++;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && cend == L('\\'))
|
||||
cend = *p++;
|
||||
if (cend == L('\0'))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
/* It is a range. */
|
||||
if (cold <= fc && fc <= c)
|
||||
goto matched;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
c = *p++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (c == L(']'))
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (!not)
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
matched:
|
||||
/* Skip the rest of the [...] that already matched. */
|
||||
while (c != L(']'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (c == L('\0'))
|
||||
/* [... (unterminated) loses. */
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
|
||||
c = *p++;
|
||||
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && c == L('\\'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (*p == L('\0'))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
/* XXX 1003.2d11 is unclear if this is right. */
|
||||
++p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (c == L('[') && *p == L(':'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
do
|
||||
if (*++p == L('\0'))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
while (*p != L(':') || p[1] == L(']'));
|
||||
p += 2;
|
||||
c = *p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (not)
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
if (c != FOLD ((UCHAR) *n))
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
++n;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (*n == '\0')
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((flags & FNM_LEADING_DIR) && *n == L('/'))
|
||||
/* The FNM_LEADING_DIR flag says that "foo*" matches "foobar/frobozz". */
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
return FNM_NOMATCH;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FOLD
|
||||
#undef CHAR
|
||||
#undef UCHAR
|
||||
#undef FCT
|
||||
#undef STRCHR
|
||||
#undef STRCHRNUL
|
||||
#undef STRCOLL
|
||||
#undef L
|
||||
#undef BTOWC
|
||||
#undef SUFFIX
|
||||
@@ -1,50 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* full-read.c -- an interface to read that retries after interrupts
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1993, 1994, 1997, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
# include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Read LEN bytes at PTR from descriptor DESC, retrying if interrupted.
|
||||
Return the actual number of bytes read, zero for EOF, or negative
|
||||
for an error. */
|
||||
|
||||
ssize_t
|
||||
full_read (int desc, char *ptr, size_t len)
|
||||
{
|
||||
for (;;)
|
||||
{
|
||||
ssize_t n = read (desc, ptr, len);
|
||||
#ifdef EINTR
|
||||
if (n < 0 && errno == EINTR)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
return n;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
@@ -1,85 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* An interface to read and write that retries (if necessary) until complete.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1993, 1994, 1997-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Specification. */
|
||||
#ifdef FULL_READ
|
||||
# include "full-read.h"
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# include "full-write.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FULL_READ
|
||||
# include "safe-read.h"
|
||||
# define safe_rw safe_read
|
||||
# define full_rw full_read
|
||||
# undef const
|
||||
# define const /* empty */
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# include "safe-write.h"
|
||||
# define safe_rw safe_write
|
||||
# define full_rw full_write
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FULL_READ
|
||||
/* Set errno to zero upon EOF. */
|
||||
# define ZERO_BYTE_TRANSFER_ERRNO 0
|
||||
#else
|
||||
/* Some buggy drivers return 0 when one tries to write beyond
|
||||
a device's end. (Example: Linux 1.2.13 on /dev/fd0.)
|
||||
Set errno to ENOSPC so they get a sensible diagnostic. */
|
||||
# define ZERO_BYTE_TRANSFER_ERRNO ENOSPC
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write(read) COUNT bytes at BUF to(from) descriptor FD, retrying if
|
||||
interrupted or if a partial write(read) occurs. Return the number
|
||||
of bytes transferred.
|
||||
When writing, set errno if fewer than COUNT bytes are written.
|
||||
When reading, if fewer than COUNT bytes are read, you must examine
|
||||
errno to distinguish failure from EOF (errno == 0). */
|
||||
size_t
|
||||
full_rw (int fd, const void *buf, size_t count)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t total = 0;
|
||||
const char *ptr = buf;
|
||||
|
||||
while (count > 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t n_rw = safe_rw (fd, ptr, count);
|
||||
if (n_rw == (size_t) -1)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
if (n_rw == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
errno = ZERO_BYTE_TRANSFER_ERRNO;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
total += n_rw;
|
||||
ptr += n_rw;
|
||||
count -= n_rw;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return total;
|
||||
}
|
||||
@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* An interface to write() that writes all it is asked to write.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/* Write COUNT bytes at BUF to descriptor FD, retrying if interrupted
|
||||
or if partial writes occur. Return the number of bytes successfully
|
||||
written, setting errno if that is less than COUNT. */
|
||||
extern size_t full_write (int fd, const void *buf, size_t count);
|
||||
1114
lib/getdate.y
1114
lib/getdate.y
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
366
lib/human.c
366
lib/human.c
@@ -1,366 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* human.c -- print human readable file size
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software
|
||||
Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Originally contributed by lm@sgi.com;
|
||||
--si, output block size selection, and large file support
|
||||
added by eggert@twinsun.com. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
|
||||
# include <limits.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# include <strings.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef CHAR_BIT
|
||||
# define CHAR_BIT 8
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef HAVE_DECL_GETENV
|
||||
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if !HAVE_DECL_GETENV
|
||||
char *getenv ();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if ENABLE_NLS
|
||||
# include <libintl.h>
|
||||
# define _(Text) gettext (Text)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define _(Text) Text
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <argmatch.h>
|
||||
#include <error.h>
|
||||
#include <xstrtol.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "human.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static const char suffixes[] =
|
||||
{
|
||||
0, /* not used */
|
||||
'K', /* kibi ('k' for kilo is a special case) */
|
||||
'M', /* mega or mebi */
|
||||
'G', /* giga or gibi */
|
||||
'T', /* tera or tebi */
|
||||
'P', /* peta or pebi */
|
||||
'E', /* exa or exbi */
|
||||
'Z', /* zetta or 2**70 */
|
||||
'Y' /* yotta or 2**80 */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Generate into P[-1] (and possibly P[-2]) the proper suffix for
|
||||
POWER and BASE. Return the address of the generated suffix. */
|
||||
static char *
|
||||
generate_suffix_backwards (char *p, int power, int base)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char letter = suffixes[power];
|
||||
|
||||
if (base == 1000)
|
||||
{
|
||||
*--p = 'B';
|
||||
if (power == 1)
|
||||
letter = 'k';
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
*--p = letter;
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* If INEXACT_STYLE is not human_round_to_even, and if easily
|
||||
possible, adjust VALUE according to the style. */
|
||||
static double
|
||||
adjust_value (enum human_inexact_style inexact_style, double value)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Do not use the floor or ceil functions, as that would mean
|
||||
linking with the standard math library, which is a porting pain.
|
||||
So leave the value alone if it is too large to easily round. */
|
||||
if (inexact_style != human_round_to_even && value < (uintmax_t) -1)
|
||||
{
|
||||
uintmax_t u = value;
|
||||
value = u + (inexact_style == human_ceiling && u != value);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return value;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Like human_readable_inexact, except always round to even. */
|
||||
char *
|
||||
human_readable (uintmax_t n, char *buf,
|
||||
int from_block_size, int output_block_size)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return human_readable_inexact (n, buf, from_block_size, output_block_size,
|
||||
human_round_to_even);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Convert N to a human readable format in BUF.
|
||||
|
||||
N is expressed in units of FROM_BLOCK_SIZE. FROM_BLOCK_SIZE must
|
||||
be nonnegative.
|
||||
|
||||
OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE must be nonzero. If it is positive, use units of
|
||||
OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE in the output number.
|
||||
|
||||
Use INEXACT_STYLE to determine whether to take the ceiling or floor
|
||||
of any result that cannot be expressed exactly.
|
||||
|
||||
If OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is negative, use a format like "127K" if
|
||||
possible, using powers of -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE; otherwise, use
|
||||
ordinary decimal format. Normally -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is either
|
||||
1000 or 1024; it must be at least 2. Most people visually process
|
||||
strings of 3-4 digits effectively, but longer strings of digits are
|
||||
more prone to misinterpretation. Hence, converting to an
|
||||
abbreviated form usually improves readability. Use a suffix
|
||||
indicating which power is being used. For example, assuming
|
||||
-OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is 1024, 8500 would be converted to 8.3K,
|
||||
133456345 to 127M, 56990456345 to 53G, and so on. Numbers smaller
|
||||
than -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE aren't modified. If -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is
|
||||
1024, append a "B" after any size letter. */
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
human_readable_inexact (uintmax_t n, char *buf,
|
||||
int from_block_size, int output_block_size,
|
||||
enum human_inexact_style inexact_style)
|
||||
{
|
||||
uintmax_t amt;
|
||||
int base;
|
||||
int to_block_size;
|
||||
int tenths = 0;
|
||||
int power;
|
||||
char *p;
|
||||
|
||||
/* 0 means adjusted N == AMT.TENTHS;
|
||||
1 means AMT.TENTHS < adjusted N < AMT.TENTHS + 0.05;
|
||||
2 means adjusted N == AMT.TENTHS + 0.05;
|
||||
3 means AMT.TENTHS + 0.05 < adjusted N < AMT.TENTHS + 0.1. */
|
||||
int rounding = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (output_block_size < 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
base = -output_block_size;
|
||||
to_block_size = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
base = 0;
|
||||
to_block_size = output_block_size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
p = buf + LONGEST_HUMAN_READABLE;
|
||||
*p = '\0';
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef lint
|
||||
/* Suppress `used before initialized' warning. */
|
||||
power = 0;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Adjust AMT out of FROM_BLOCK_SIZE units and into TO_BLOCK_SIZE units. */
|
||||
|
||||
{
|
||||
int multiplier;
|
||||
int divisor;
|
||||
int r2;
|
||||
int r10;
|
||||
if (to_block_size <= from_block_size
|
||||
? (from_block_size % to_block_size != 0
|
||||
|| (multiplier = from_block_size / to_block_size,
|
||||
(amt = n * multiplier) / multiplier != n))
|
||||
: (from_block_size == 0
|
||||
|| to_block_size % from_block_size != 0
|
||||
|| (divisor = to_block_size / from_block_size,
|
||||
r10 = (n % divisor) * 10,
|
||||
r2 = (r10 % divisor) * 2,
|
||||
amt = n / divisor,
|
||||
tenths = r10 / divisor,
|
||||
rounding = r2 < divisor ? 0 < r2 : 2 + (divisor < r2),
|
||||
0)))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Either the result cannot be computed easily using uintmax_t,
|
||||
or from_block_size is zero. Fall back on floating point.
|
||||
FIXME: This can yield answers that are slightly off. */
|
||||
|
||||
double damt = n * (from_block_size / (double) to_block_size);
|
||||
|
||||
if (! base)
|
||||
sprintf (buf, "%.0f", adjust_value (inexact_style, damt));
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
char suffix[3];
|
||||
char const *psuffix;
|
||||
double e = 1;
|
||||
power = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
e *= base;
|
||||
power++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (e * base <= damt && power < sizeof suffixes - 1);
|
||||
|
||||
damt /= e;
|
||||
|
||||
suffix[2] = '\0';
|
||||
psuffix = generate_suffix_backwards (suffix + 2, power, base);
|
||||
sprintf (buf, "%.1f%s",
|
||||
adjust_value (inexact_style, damt), psuffix);
|
||||
if (4 + (base == 1000) < strlen (buf))
|
||||
sprintf (buf, "%.0f%s",
|
||||
adjust_value (inexact_style, damt * 10) / 10, psuffix);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return buf;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Use power of BASE notation if adjusted AMT is large enough. */
|
||||
|
||||
if (base && base <= amt)
|
||||
{
|
||||
power = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
int r10 = (amt % base) * 10 + tenths;
|
||||
int r2 = (r10 % base) * 2 + (rounding >> 1);
|
||||
amt /= base;
|
||||
tenths = r10 / base;
|
||||
rounding = (r2 < base
|
||||
? 0 < r2 + rounding
|
||||
: 2 + (base < r2 + rounding));
|
||||
power++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (base <= amt && power < sizeof suffixes - 1);
|
||||
|
||||
p = generate_suffix_backwards (p, power, base);
|
||||
|
||||
if (amt < 10)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (2 * (1 - (int) inexact_style)
|
||||
< rounding + (tenths & (inexact_style == human_round_to_even)))
|
||||
{
|
||||
tenths++;
|
||||
rounding = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (tenths == 10)
|
||||
{
|
||||
amt++;
|
||||
tenths = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (amt < 10)
|
||||
{
|
||||
*--p = '0' + tenths;
|
||||
*--p = '.';
|
||||
tenths = rounding = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (inexact_style == human_ceiling
|
||||
? 0 < tenths + rounding
|
||||
: inexact_style == human_round_to_even
|
||||
? 5 < tenths + (2 < rounding + (amt & 1))
|
||||
: /* inexact_style == human_floor */ 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
amt++;
|
||||
|
||||
if (amt == base && power < sizeof suffixes - 1)
|
||||
{
|
||||
*p = suffixes[power + 1];
|
||||
*--p = '0';
|
||||
*--p = '.';
|
||||
amt = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
do
|
||||
*--p = '0' + (int) (amt % 10);
|
||||
while ((amt /= 10) != 0);
|
||||
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* The default block size used for output. This number may change in
|
||||
the future as disks get larger. */
|
||||
#ifndef DEFAULT_BLOCK_SIZE
|
||||
# define DEFAULT_BLOCK_SIZE 1024
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static char const *const block_size_args[] = { "human-readable", "si", 0 };
|
||||
static int const block_size_types[] = { -1024, -1000 };
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
default_block_size (void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return getenv ("POSIXLY_CORRECT") ? 512 : DEFAULT_BLOCK_SIZE;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static strtol_error
|
||||
humblock (char const *spec, int *block_size)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
if (! spec && ! (spec = getenv ("BLOCK_SIZE")))
|
||||
*block_size = default_block_size ();
|
||||
else if (0 <= (i = ARGMATCH (spec, block_size_args, block_size_types)))
|
||||
*block_size = block_size_types[i];
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *ptr;
|
||||
unsigned long val;
|
||||
strtol_error e = xstrtoul (spec, &ptr, 0, &val, "eEgGkKmMpPtTyYzZ0");
|
||||
if (e != LONGINT_OK)
|
||||
return e;
|
||||
if (*ptr)
|
||||
return LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR;
|
||||
if ((int) val < 0 || val != (int) val)
|
||||
return LONGINT_OVERFLOW;
|
||||
*block_size = (int) val;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return LONGINT_OK;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
human_block_size (char const *spec, int report_errors, int *block_size)
|
||||
{
|
||||
strtol_error e = humblock (spec, block_size);
|
||||
if (*block_size == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
*block_size = default_block_size ();
|
||||
e = LONGINT_INVALID;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (e != LONGINT_OK && report_errors)
|
||||
STRTOL_FATAL_ERROR (spec, _("block size"), e);
|
||||
}
|
||||
46
lib/human.h
46
lib/human.h
@@ -1,46 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#ifndef HUMAN_H_
|
||||
# define HUMAN_H_ 1
|
||||
|
||||
# if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
|
||||
# include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if HAVE_LIMITS_H
|
||||
# include <limits.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef CHAR_BIT
|
||||
# define CHAR_BIT 8
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* A conservative bound on the maximum length of a human-readable string.
|
||||
The output can be the product of the largest uintmax_t and the largest int,
|
||||
so add their sizes before converting to a bound on digits. */
|
||||
# define LONGEST_HUMAN_READABLE ((sizeof (uintmax_t) + sizeof (int)) \
|
||||
* CHAR_BIT / 3)
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
enum human_inexact_style
|
||||
{
|
||||
human_floor = -1,
|
||||
human_round_to_even = 0,
|
||||
human_ceiling = 1
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
char *human_readable PARAMS ((uintmax_t, char *, int, int));
|
||||
char *human_readable_inexact PARAMS ((uintmax_t, char *, int, int,
|
||||
enum human_inexact_style));
|
||||
|
||||
void human_block_size PARAMS ((char const *, int, int *));
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* HUMAN_H_ */
|
||||
@@ -1,9 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Some systems don't have ENOSYS. */
|
||||
#ifndef ENOSYS
|
||||
# ifdef ENOTSUP
|
||||
# define ENOSYS ENOTSUP
|
||||
# else
|
||||
/* Some systems don't have ENOTSUP either. */
|
||||
# define ENOSYS ENOMSG
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
@@ -1,9 +1,9 @@
|
||||
/* Parse arguments from a string and prepend them to an argv.
|
||||
Copyright 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
Copyright 1999, 2000, 2001, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,57 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Print a copyright notice suitable for the current locale.
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Paul Eggert. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "print-copyr.h"
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if ENABLE_NLS
|
||||
# include "unicodeio.h"
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define unicode_to_mb(code, callback, error_callback, callback_arg) \
|
||||
error_callback (code, callback_arg)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define COPYRIGHT_SIGN 0x00A9
|
||||
|
||||
/* Print "(C)". */
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
print_parenthesized_c (unsigned int code, void *callback_arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *stream = callback_arg;
|
||||
return fputs ("(C)", stream);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Print "Copyright (C) " followed by NOTICE and then a newline,
|
||||
transliterating "(C)" to an actual copyright sign (C-in-a-circle)
|
||||
if possible. */
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
print_copyright (char const *notice)
|
||||
{
|
||||
fputs ("Copyright ", stdout);
|
||||
unicode_to_mb (COPYRIGHT_SIGN, print_unicode_char, print_parenthesized_c,
|
||||
stdout);
|
||||
fputc (' ', stdout);
|
||||
puts (notice);
|
||||
}
|
||||
@@ -1,9 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if PROTOTYPES || (defined (__STDC__) && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(args) args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
void print_copyright PARAMS((char const *));
|
||||
658
lib/quotearg.c
658
lib/quotearg.c
@@ -1,658 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* quotearg.c - quote arguments for output
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDDEF_H
|
||||
# include <stddef.h> /* For the definition of size_t on windows w/MSVC. */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#include <quotearg.h>
|
||||
#include <xalloc.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if ENABLE_NLS
|
||||
# include <libintl.h>
|
||||
# define _(text) gettext (text)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define _(text) text
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#define N_(text) text
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
|
||||
# include <limits.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef CHAR_BIT
|
||||
# define CHAR_BIT 8
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef SIZE_MAX
|
||||
# define SIZE_MAX ((size_t) -1)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef UCHAR_MAX
|
||||
# define UCHAR_MAX ((unsigned char) -1)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef UINT_MAX
|
||||
# define UINT_MAX ((unsigned int) -1)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_C_BACKSLASH_A
|
||||
# define ALERT_CHAR '\a'
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define ALERT_CHAR '\7'
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_WCHAR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* BSD/OS 4.1 wchar.h requires FILE and struct tm to be declared. */
|
||||
# include <stdio.h>
|
||||
# include <time.h>
|
||||
|
||||
# include <wchar.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if !HAVE_MBRTOWC
|
||||
/* Disable multibyte processing entirely. Since MB_CUR_MAX is 1, the
|
||||
other macros are defined only for documentation and to satisfy C
|
||||
syntax. */
|
||||
# undef MB_CUR_MAX
|
||||
# define MB_CUR_MAX 1
|
||||
# define mbrtowc(pwc, s, n, ps) ((*(pwc) = *(s)) != 0)
|
||||
# define mbsinit(ps) 1
|
||||
# define iswprint(wc) ISPRINT ((unsigned char) (wc))
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef iswprint
|
||||
# if HAVE_WCTYPE_H
|
||||
# include <wctype.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if !defined iswprint && !HAVE_ISWPRINT
|
||||
# define iswprint(wc) 1
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define INT_BITS (sizeof (int) * CHAR_BIT)
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined (STDC_HEADERS) || (!defined (isascii) && !defined (HAVE_ISASCII))
|
||||
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) 1
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) isascii(c)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Undefine to protect against the definition in wctype.h of solaris2.6. */
|
||||
#undef ISPRINT
|
||||
#define ISPRINT(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isprint (c))
|
||||
|
||||
struct quoting_options
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Basic quoting style. */
|
||||
enum quoting_style style;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Quote the characters indicated by this bit vector even if the
|
||||
quoting style would not normally require them to be quoted. */
|
||||
int quote_these_too[(UCHAR_MAX / INT_BITS) + 1];
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Names of quoting styles. */
|
||||
char const *const quoting_style_args[] =
|
||||
{
|
||||
"literal",
|
||||
"shell",
|
||||
"shell-always",
|
||||
"c",
|
||||
"escape",
|
||||
"locale",
|
||||
"clocale",
|
||||
0
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Correspondences to quoting style names. */
|
||||
enum quoting_style const quoting_style_vals[] =
|
||||
{
|
||||
literal_quoting_style,
|
||||
shell_quoting_style,
|
||||
shell_always_quoting_style,
|
||||
c_quoting_style,
|
||||
escape_quoting_style,
|
||||
locale_quoting_style,
|
||||
clocale_quoting_style
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* The default quoting options. */
|
||||
static struct quoting_options default_quoting_options;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Allocate a new set of quoting options, with contents initially identical
|
||||
to O if O is not null, or to the default if O is null.
|
||||
It is the caller's responsibility to free the result. */
|
||||
struct quoting_options *
|
||||
clone_quoting_options (struct quoting_options *o)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct quoting_options *p
|
||||
= (struct quoting_options *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct quoting_options));
|
||||
*p = *(o ? o : &default_quoting_options);
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Get the value of O's quoting style. If O is null, use the default. */
|
||||
enum quoting_style
|
||||
get_quoting_style (struct quoting_options *o)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return (o ? o : &default_quoting_options)->style;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
|
||||
set the value of the quoting style to S. */
|
||||
void
|
||||
set_quoting_style (struct quoting_options *o, enum quoting_style s)
|
||||
{
|
||||
(o ? o : &default_quoting_options)->style = s;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
|
||||
set the value of the quoting options for character C to I.
|
||||
Return the old value. Currently, the only values defined for I are
|
||||
0 (the default) and 1 (which means to quote the character even if
|
||||
it would not otherwise be quoted). */
|
||||
int
|
||||
set_char_quoting (struct quoting_options *o, char c, int i)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned char uc = c;
|
||||
int *p = (o ? o : &default_quoting_options)->quote_these_too + uc / INT_BITS;
|
||||
int shift = uc % INT_BITS;
|
||||
int r = (*p >> shift) & 1;
|
||||
*p ^= ((i & 1) ^ r) << shift;
|
||||
return r;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* MSGID approximates a quotation mark. Return its translation if it
|
||||
has one; otherwise, return either it or "\"", depending on S. */
|
||||
static char const *
|
||||
gettext_quote (char const *msgid, enum quoting_style s)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char const *translation = _(msgid);
|
||||
if (translation == msgid && s == clocale_quoting_style)
|
||||
translation = "\"";
|
||||
return translation;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Place into buffer BUFFER (of size BUFFERSIZE) a quoted version of
|
||||
argument ARG (of size ARGSIZE), using QUOTING_STYLE and the
|
||||
non-quoting-style part of O to control quoting.
|
||||
Terminate the output with a null character, and return the written
|
||||
size of the output, not counting the terminating null.
|
||||
If BUFFERSIZE is too small to store the output string, return the
|
||||
value that would have been returned had BUFFERSIZE been large enough.
|
||||
If ARGSIZE is -1, use the string length of the argument for ARGSIZE.
|
||||
|
||||
This function acts like quotearg_buffer (BUFFER, BUFFERSIZE, ARG,
|
||||
ARGSIZE, O), except it uses QUOTING_STYLE instead of the quoting
|
||||
style specified by O, and O may not be null. */
|
||||
|
||||
static size_t
|
||||
quotearg_buffer_restyled (char *buffer, size_t buffersize,
|
||||
char const *arg, size_t argsize,
|
||||
enum quoting_style quoting_style,
|
||||
struct quoting_options const *o)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
size_t len = 0;
|
||||
char const *quote_string = 0;
|
||||
size_t quote_string_len = 0;
|
||||
int backslash_escapes = 0;
|
||||
int unibyte_locale = MB_CUR_MAX == 1;
|
||||
|
||||
#define STORE(c) \
|
||||
do \
|
||||
{ \
|
||||
if (len < buffersize) \
|
||||
buffer[len] = (c); \
|
||||
len++; \
|
||||
} \
|
||||
while (0)
|
||||
|
||||
switch (quoting_style)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case c_quoting_style:
|
||||
STORE ('"');
|
||||
backslash_escapes = 1;
|
||||
quote_string = "\"";
|
||||
quote_string_len = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case escape_quoting_style:
|
||||
backslash_escapes = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case locale_quoting_style:
|
||||
case clocale_quoting_style:
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Get translations for open and closing quotation marks.
|
||||
|
||||
The message catalog should translate "`" to a left
|
||||
quotation mark suitable for the locale, and similarly for
|
||||
"'". If the catalog has no translation,
|
||||
locale_quoting_style quotes `like this', and
|
||||
clocale_quoting_style quotes "like this".
|
||||
|
||||
For example, an American English Unicode locale should
|
||||
translate "`" to U+201C (LEFT DOUBLE QUOTATION MARK), and
|
||||
should translate "'" to U+201D (RIGHT DOUBLE QUOTATION
|
||||
MARK). A British English Unicode locale should instead
|
||||
translate these to U+2018 (LEFT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK) and
|
||||
U+2019 (RIGHT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK), respectively. */
|
||||
|
||||
char const *left = gettext_quote (N_("`"), quoting_style);
|
||||
char const *right = gettext_quote (N_("'"), quoting_style);
|
||||
for (quote_string = left; *quote_string; quote_string++)
|
||||
STORE (*quote_string);
|
||||
backslash_escapes = 1;
|
||||
quote_string = right;
|
||||
quote_string_len = strlen (quote_string);
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case shell_always_quoting_style:
|
||||
STORE ('\'');
|
||||
quote_string = "'";
|
||||
quote_string_len = 1;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; ! (argsize == (size_t) -1 ? arg[i] == '\0' : i == argsize); i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned char c;
|
||||
unsigned char esc;
|
||||
|
||||
if (backslash_escapes
|
||||
&& quote_string_len
|
||||
&& i + quote_string_len <= argsize
|
||||
&& memcmp (arg + i, quote_string, quote_string_len) == 0)
|
||||
STORE ('\\');
|
||||
|
||||
c = arg[i];
|
||||
switch (c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case '\0':
|
||||
if (backslash_escapes)
|
||||
{
|
||||
STORE ('\\');
|
||||
STORE ('0');
|
||||
STORE ('0');
|
||||
c = '0';
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case '?':
|
||||
switch (quoting_style)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case shell_quoting_style:
|
||||
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
|
||||
|
||||
case c_quoting_style:
|
||||
if (i + 2 < argsize && arg[i + 1] == '?')
|
||||
switch (arg[i + 2])
|
||||
{
|
||||
case '!': case '\'':
|
||||
case '(': case ')': case '-': case '/':
|
||||
case '<': case '=': case '>':
|
||||
/* Escape the second '?' in what would otherwise be
|
||||
a trigraph. */
|
||||
i += 2;
|
||||
c = arg[i + 2];
|
||||
STORE ('?');
|
||||
STORE ('\\');
|
||||
STORE ('?');
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case ALERT_CHAR: esc = 'a'; goto c_escape;
|
||||
case '\b': esc = 'b'; goto c_escape;
|
||||
case '\f': esc = 'f'; goto c_escape;
|
||||
case '\n': esc = 'n'; goto c_and_shell_escape;
|
||||
case '\r': esc = 'r'; goto c_and_shell_escape;
|
||||
case '\t': esc = 't'; goto c_and_shell_escape;
|
||||
case '\v': esc = 'v'; goto c_escape;
|
||||
case '\\': esc = c; goto c_and_shell_escape;
|
||||
|
||||
c_and_shell_escape:
|
||||
if (quoting_style == shell_quoting_style)
|
||||
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
|
||||
c_escape:
|
||||
if (backslash_escapes)
|
||||
{
|
||||
c = esc;
|
||||
goto store_escape;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case '#': case '~':
|
||||
if (i != 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
/* Fall through. */
|
||||
case ' ':
|
||||
case '!': /* special in bash */
|
||||
case '"': case '$': case '&':
|
||||
case '(': case ')': case '*': case ';':
|
||||
case '<': case '>': case '[':
|
||||
case '^': /* special in old /bin/sh, e.g. SunOS 4.1.4 */
|
||||
case '`': case '|':
|
||||
/* A shell special character. In theory, '$' and '`' could
|
||||
be the first bytes of multibyte characters, which means
|
||||
we should check them with mbrtowc, but in practice this
|
||||
doesn't happen so it's not worth worrying about. */
|
||||
if (quoting_style == shell_quoting_style)
|
||||
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case '\'':
|
||||
switch (quoting_style)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case shell_quoting_style:
|
||||
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
|
||||
|
||||
case shell_always_quoting_style:
|
||||
STORE ('\'');
|
||||
STORE ('\\');
|
||||
STORE ('\'');
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case '%': case '+': case ',': case '-': case '.': case '/':
|
||||
case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case '5':
|
||||
case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': case ':': case '=':
|
||||
case 'A': case 'B': case 'C': case 'D': case 'E': case 'F':
|
||||
case 'G': case 'H': case 'I': case 'J': case 'K': case 'L':
|
||||
case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P': case 'Q': case 'R':
|
||||
case 'S': case 'T': case 'U': case 'V': case 'W': case 'X':
|
||||
case 'Y': case 'Z': case ']': case '_': case 'a': case 'b':
|
||||
case 'c': case 'd': case 'e': case 'f': case 'g': case 'h':
|
||||
case 'i': case 'j': case 'k': case 'l': case 'm': case 'n':
|
||||
case 'o': case 'p': case 'q': case 'r': case 's': case 't':
|
||||
case 'u': case 'v': case 'w': case 'x': case 'y': case 'z':
|
||||
case '{': case '}':
|
||||
/* These characters don't cause problems, no matter what the
|
||||
quoting style is. They cannot start multibyte sequences. */
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
/* If we have a multibyte sequence, copy it until we reach
|
||||
its end, find an error, or come back to the initial shift
|
||||
state. For C-like styles, if the sequence has
|
||||
unprintable characters, escape the whole sequence, since
|
||||
we can't easily escape single characters within it. */
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Length of multibyte sequence found so far. */
|
||||
size_t m;
|
||||
|
||||
int printable;
|
||||
|
||||
if (unibyte_locale)
|
||||
{
|
||||
m = 1;
|
||||
printable = ISPRINT (c);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
mbstate_t mbstate;
|
||||
memset (&mbstate, 0, sizeof mbstate);
|
||||
|
||||
m = 0;
|
||||
printable = 1;
|
||||
if (argsize == (size_t) -1)
|
||||
argsize = strlen (arg);
|
||||
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
wchar_t w;
|
||||
size_t bytes = mbrtowc (&w, &arg[i + m],
|
||||
argsize - (i + m), &mbstate);
|
||||
if (bytes == 0)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
else if (bytes == (size_t) -1)
|
||||
{
|
||||
printable = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (bytes == (size_t) -2)
|
||||
{
|
||||
printable = 0;
|
||||
while (i + m < argsize && arg[i + m])
|
||||
m++;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (! iswprint (w))
|
||||
printable = 0;
|
||||
m += bytes;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (! mbsinit (&mbstate));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (1 < m || (backslash_escapes && ! printable))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Output a multibyte sequence, or an escaped
|
||||
unprintable unibyte character. */
|
||||
size_t ilim = i + m;
|
||||
|
||||
for (;;)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (backslash_escapes && ! printable)
|
||||
{
|
||||
STORE ('\\');
|
||||
STORE ('0' + (c >> 6));
|
||||
STORE ('0' + ((c >> 3) & 7));
|
||||
c = '0' + (c & 7);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (ilim <= i + 1)
|
||||
break;
|
||||
STORE (c);
|
||||
c = arg[++i];
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
goto store_c;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (! (backslash_escapes
|
||||
&& o->quote_these_too[c / INT_BITS] & (1 << (c % INT_BITS))))
|
||||
goto store_c;
|
||||
|
||||
store_escape:
|
||||
STORE ('\\');
|
||||
|
||||
store_c:
|
||||
STORE (c);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (quote_string)
|
||||
for (; *quote_string; quote_string++)
|
||||
STORE (*quote_string);
|
||||
|
||||
if (len < buffersize)
|
||||
buffer[len] = '\0';
|
||||
return len;
|
||||
|
||||
use_shell_always_quoting_style:
|
||||
return quotearg_buffer_restyled (buffer, buffersize, arg, argsize,
|
||||
shell_always_quoting_style, o);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Place into buffer BUFFER (of size BUFFERSIZE) a quoted version of
|
||||
argument ARG (of size ARGSIZE), using O to control quoting.
|
||||
If O is null, use the default.
|
||||
Terminate the output with a null character, and return the written
|
||||
size of the output, not counting the terminating null.
|
||||
If BUFFERSIZE is too small to store the output string, return the
|
||||
value that would have been returned had BUFFERSIZE been large enough.
|
||||
If ARGSIZE is -1, use the string length of the argument for ARGSIZE. */
|
||||
size_t
|
||||
quotearg_buffer (char *buffer, size_t buffersize,
|
||||
char const *arg, size_t argsize,
|
||||
struct quoting_options const *o)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct quoting_options const *p = o ? o : &default_quoting_options;
|
||||
return quotearg_buffer_restyled (buffer, buffersize, arg, argsize,
|
||||
p->style, p);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Use storage slot N to return a quoted version of argument ARG.
|
||||
ARG is of size ARGSIZE, but if that is -1, ARG is a null-terminated string.
|
||||
OPTIONS specifies the quoting options.
|
||||
The returned value points to static storage that can be
|
||||
reused by the next call to this function with the same value of N.
|
||||
N must be nonnegative. N is deliberately declared with type "int"
|
||||
to allow for future extensions (using negative values). */
|
||||
static char *
|
||||
quotearg_n_options (int n, char const *arg, size_t argsize,
|
||||
struct quoting_options const *options)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Preallocate a slot 0 buffer, so that the caller can always quote
|
||||
one small component of a "memory exhausted" message in slot 0. */
|
||||
static char slot0[256];
|
||||
static unsigned int nslots = 1;
|
||||
unsigned int n0 = n;
|
||||
struct slotvec
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t size;
|
||||
char *val;
|
||||
};
|
||||
static struct slotvec slotvec0 = {sizeof slot0, slot0};
|
||||
static struct slotvec *slotvec = &slotvec0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (n < 0)
|
||||
abort ();
|
||||
|
||||
if (nslots <= n0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned int n1 = n0 + 1;
|
||||
size_t s = n1 * sizeof *slotvec;
|
||||
|
||||
if (SIZE_MAX / UINT_MAX <= sizeof *slotvec
|
||||
&& n1 != s / sizeof *slotvec)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
|
||||
if (slotvec == &slotvec0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
slotvec = (struct slotvec *) xmalloc (sizeof *slotvec);
|
||||
*slotvec = slotvec0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
slotvec = (struct slotvec *) xrealloc (slotvec, s);
|
||||
memset (slotvec + nslots, 0, (n1 - nslots) * sizeof *slotvec);
|
||||
nslots = n1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t size = slotvec[n].size;
|
||||
char *val = slotvec[n].val;
|
||||
size_t qsize = quotearg_buffer (val, size, arg, argsize, options);
|
||||
|
||||
if (size <= qsize)
|
||||
{
|
||||
slotvec[n].size = size = qsize + 1;
|
||||
slotvec[n].val = val = xrealloc (val == slot0 ? 0 : val, size);
|
||||
quotearg_buffer (val, size, arg, argsize, options);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return val;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
quotearg_n (int n, char const *arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return quotearg_n_options (n, arg, (size_t) -1, &default_quoting_options);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
quotearg (char const *arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return quotearg_n (0, arg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return quoting options for STYLE, with no extra quoting. */
|
||||
static struct quoting_options
|
||||
quoting_options_from_style (enum quoting_style style)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct quoting_options o;
|
||||
o.style = style;
|
||||
memset (o.quote_these_too, 0, sizeof o.quote_these_too);
|
||||
return o;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
quotearg_n_style (int n, enum quoting_style s, char const *arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct quoting_options const o = quoting_options_from_style (s);
|
||||
return quotearg_n_options (n, arg, (size_t) -1, &o);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
quotearg_n_style_mem (int n, enum quoting_style s,
|
||||
char const *arg, size_t argsize)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct quoting_options const o = quoting_options_from_style (s);
|
||||
return quotearg_n_options (n, arg, argsize, &o);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
quotearg_style (enum quoting_style s, char const *arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return quotearg_n_style (0, s, arg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
quotearg_char (char const *arg, char ch)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct quoting_options options;
|
||||
options = default_quoting_options;
|
||||
set_char_quoting (&options, ch, 1);
|
||||
return quotearg_n_options (0, arg, (size_t) -1, &options);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
quotearg_colon (char const *arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return quotearg_char (arg, ':');
|
||||
}
|
||||
100
lib/quotearg.h
100
lib/quotearg.h
@@ -1,100 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* quotearg.h - quote arguments for output
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1998, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Basic quoting styles. */
|
||||
enum quoting_style
|
||||
{
|
||||
literal_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=literal */
|
||||
shell_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=shell */
|
||||
shell_always_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=shell-always */
|
||||
c_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=c */
|
||||
escape_quoting_style /* --quoting-style=escape */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* For now, --quoting-style=literal is the default, but
|
||||
this is planned to change to --quoting-style=shell in the future. */
|
||||
#ifndef DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE
|
||||
# define DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE literal_quoting_style
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Names of quoting styles and their corresponding values. */
|
||||
extern char const *const quoting_style_args[];
|
||||
extern enum quoting_style const quoting_style_vals[];
|
||||
|
||||
struct quoting_options;
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || defined __STDC__
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The functions listed below set and use a hidden variable
|
||||
that contains the default quoting style options. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Allocate a new set of quoting options, with contents initially identical
|
||||
to O if O is not null, or to the default if O is null.
|
||||
It is the caller's responsibility to free the result. */
|
||||
struct quoting_options *clone_quoting_options
|
||||
PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Get the value of O's quoting style. If O is null, use the default. */
|
||||
enum quoting_style get_quoting_style PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o));
|
||||
|
||||
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
|
||||
set the value of the quoting style to S. */
|
||||
void set_quoting_style PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o,
|
||||
enum quoting_style s));
|
||||
|
||||
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
|
||||
set the value of the quoting options for character C to I.
|
||||
Return the old value. Currently, the only values defined for I are
|
||||
0 (the default) and 1 (which means to quote the character even if
|
||||
it would not otherwise be quoted). */
|
||||
int set_char_quoting PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o, char c, int i));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Place into buffer BUFFER (of size BUFFERSIZE) a quoted version of
|
||||
argument ARG (of size ARGSIZE), using O to control quoting.
|
||||
If O is null, use the default.
|
||||
Terminate the output with a null character, and return the written
|
||||
size of the output, not counting the terminating null.
|
||||
If BUFFERSIZE is too small to store the output string, return the
|
||||
value that would have been returned had BUFFERSIZE been large enough.
|
||||
If ARGSIZE is -1, use the string length of the argument for ARGSIZE. */
|
||||
size_t quotearg_buffer PARAMS ((char *buffer, size_t buffersize,
|
||||
char const *arg, size_t argsize,
|
||||
struct quoting_options const *o));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Use storage slot N to return a quoted version of the string ARG.
|
||||
Use the default quoting options.
|
||||
The returned value points to static storage that can be
|
||||
reused by the next call to this function with the same value of N.
|
||||
N must be nonnegative. */
|
||||
char *quotearg_n PARAMS ((unsigned int n, char const *arg));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Equivalent to quotearg_n (0, ARG). */
|
||||
char *quotearg PARAMS ((char const *arg));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Like quotearg (ARG), except also quote any instances of CH. */
|
||||
char *quotearg_char PARAMS ((char const *arg, char ch));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Equivalent to quotearg_char (ARG, ':'). */
|
||||
char *quotearg_colon PARAMS ((char const *arg));
|
||||
@@ -1,10 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
ssize_t full_write PARAMS ((int desc, const char *ptr, size_t len));
|
||||
ssize_t safe_read PARAMS ((int desc, void *ptr, size_t len));
|
||||
129
lib/savedir.c
129
lib/savedir.c
@@ -1,129 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* savedir.c -- save the list of files in a directory in a string
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright 1990, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software
|
||||
Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H
|
||||
# include <dirent.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define dirent direct
|
||||
# if HAVE_SYS_NDIR_H
|
||||
# include <sys/ndir.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if HAVE_SYS_DIR_H
|
||||
# include <sys/dir.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if HAVE_NDIR_H
|
||||
# include <ndir.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef CLOSEDIR_VOID
|
||||
/* Fake a return value. */
|
||||
# define CLOSEDIR(d) (closedir (d), 0)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define CLOSEDIR(d) closedir (d)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef STDC_HEADERS
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef NULL
|
||||
# define NULL 0
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "savedir.h"
|
||||
#include "xalloc.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return a freshly allocated string containing the filenames
|
||||
in directory DIR, separated by '\0' characters;
|
||||
the end is marked by two '\0' characters in a row.
|
||||
Return NULL (setting errno) if DIR cannot be opened, read, or closed. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef NAME_SIZE_DEFAULT
|
||||
# define NAME_SIZE_DEFAULT 512
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
savedir (const char *dir)
|
||||
{
|
||||
DIR *dirp;
|
||||
struct dirent *dp;
|
||||
char *name_space;
|
||||
size_t allocated = NAME_SIZE_DEFAULT;
|
||||
size_t used = 0;
|
||||
int save_errno;
|
||||
|
||||
dirp = opendir (dir);
|
||||
if (dirp == NULL)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
name_space = xmalloc (allocated);
|
||||
|
||||
errno = 0;
|
||||
while ((dp = readdir (dirp)) != NULL)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Skip "", ".", and "..". "" is returned by at least one buggy
|
||||
implementation: Solaris 2.4 readdir on NFS filesystems. */
|
||||
char const *entry = dp->d_name;
|
||||
if (entry[entry[0] != '.' ? 0 : entry[1] != '.' ? 1 : 2] != '\0')
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t entry_size = strlen (entry) + 1;
|
||||
if (used + entry_size < used)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
if (allocated <= used + entry_size)
|
||||
{
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (2 * allocated < allocated)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
allocated *= 2;
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (allocated <= used + entry_size);
|
||||
|
||||
name_space = xrealloc (name_space, allocated);
|
||||
}
|
||||
memcpy (name_space + used, entry, entry_size);
|
||||
used += entry_size;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
name_space[used] = '\0';
|
||||
save_errno = errno;
|
||||
if (CLOSEDIR (dirp) != 0)
|
||||
save_errno = errno;
|
||||
if (save_errno != 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
free (name_space);
|
||||
errno = save_errno;
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return name_space;
|
||||
}
|
||||
@@ -1,14 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#if !defined SAVEDIR_H_
|
||||
# define SAVEDIR_H_
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
char *savedir PARAMS ((const char *dir));
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
@@ -1,10 +1,10 @@
|
||||
/* stdopen.c - ensure that the three standard file descriptors are in use
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2005, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
101
lib/strtoimax.c
101
lib/strtoimax.c
@@ -1,101 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Convert string representation of a number into an intmax_t value.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1999, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Paul Eggert. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
|
||||
# include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || defined __STDC__
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Verify a requirement at compile-time (unlike assert, which is runtime). */
|
||||
#define verify(name, assertion) struct name { char a[(assertion) ? 1 : -1]; }
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef UNSIGNED
|
||||
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL
|
||||
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL
|
||||
unsigned long strtoul PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOULL
|
||||
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOULL && HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
|
||||
unsigned long long strtoull PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
#else
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOL
|
||||
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOL
|
||||
long strtol PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOLL
|
||||
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOLL && HAVE_LONG_LONG
|
||||
long long strtoll PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef UNSIGNED
|
||||
# undef HAVE_LONG_LONG
|
||||
# define HAVE_LONG_LONG HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
|
||||
# define INT uintmax_t
|
||||
# define strtoimax strtoumax
|
||||
# define strtol strtoul
|
||||
# define strtoll strtoull
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define INT intmax_t
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
INT
|
||||
strtoimax (char const *ptr, char **endptr, int base)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if HAVE_LONG_LONG
|
||||
verify (size_is_that_of_long_or_long_long,
|
||||
(sizeof (INT) == sizeof (long)
|
||||
|| sizeof (INT) == sizeof (long long)));
|
||||
|
||||
if (sizeof (INT) != sizeof (long))
|
||||
return strtoll (ptr, endptr, base);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
verify (size_is_that_of_long,
|
||||
sizeof (INT) == sizeof (long));
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
return strtol (ptr, endptr, base);
|
||||
}
|
||||
@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#define UNSIGNED 1
|
||||
#include "strtoimax.c"
|
||||
263
lib/unicodeio.c
263
lib/unicodeio.c
@@ -1,263 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Unicode character output to streams with locale dependent encoding.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
|
||||
under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
|
||||
by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
Library General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||||
License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
|
||||
USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Note: This file requires the locale_charset() function. See in
|
||||
libiconv-1.7/libcharset/INTEGRATE for how to obtain it. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDDEF_H
|
||||
# include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# include <strings.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ICONV
|
||||
# include <iconv.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <error.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if ENABLE_NLS
|
||||
# include <libintl.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define gettext(Text) Text
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#define _(Text) gettext (Text)
|
||||
#define N_(Text) Text
|
||||
|
||||
/* Specification. */
|
||||
#include "unicodeio.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* When we pass a Unicode character to iconv(), we must pass it in a
|
||||
suitable encoding. The standardized Unicode encodings are
|
||||
UTF-8, UCS-2, UCS-4, UTF-16, UTF-16BE, UTF-16LE, UTF-7.
|
||||
UCS-2 supports only characters up to \U0000FFFF.
|
||||
UTF-16 and variants support only characters up to \U0010FFFF.
|
||||
UTF-7 is way too complex and not supported by glibc-2.1.
|
||||
UCS-4 specification leaves doubts about endianness and byte order
|
||||
mark. glibc currently interprets it as big endian without byte order
|
||||
mark, but this is not backed by an RFC.
|
||||
So we use UTF-8. It supports characters up to \U7FFFFFFF and is
|
||||
unambiguously defined. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Stores the UTF-8 representation of the Unicode character wc in r[0..5].
|
||||
Returns the number of bytes stored, or -1 if wc is out of range. */
|
||||
static int
|
||||
utf8_wctomb (unsigned char *r, unsigned int wc)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int count;
|
||||
|
||||
if (wc < 0x80)
|
||||
count = 1;
|
||||
else if (wc < 0x800)
|
||||
count = 2;
|
||||
else if (wc < 0x10000)
|
||||
count = 3;
|
||||
else if (wc < 0x200000)
|
||||
count = 4;
|
||||
else if (wc < 0x4000000)
|
||||
count = 5;
|
||||
else if (wc <= 0x7fffffff)
|
||||
count = 6;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
switch (count)
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Note: code falls through cases! */
|
||||
case 6: r[5] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x4000000;
|
||||
case 5: r[4] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x200000;
|
||||
case 4: r[3] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x10000;
|
||||
case 3: r[2] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x800;
|
||||
case 2: r[1] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0xc0;
|
||||
case 1: r[0] = wc;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return count;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Luckily, the encoding's name is platform independent. */
|
||||
#define UTF8_NAME "UTF-8"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Converts the Unicode character CODE to its multibyte representation
|
||||
in the current locale and calls the SUCCESS callback on the resulting
|
||||
byte sequence. If an error occurs, invokes the FAILURE callback instead,
|
||||
passing it CODE and an English error string.
|
||||
Returns whatever the callback returned.
|
||||
Assumes that the locale doesn't change between two calls. */
|
||||
long
|
||||
unicode_to_mb (unsigned int code,
|
||||
long (*success) PARAMS ((const char *buf, size_t buflen,
|
||||
void *callback_arg)),
|
||||
long (*failure) PARAMS ((unsigned int code, const char *msg,
|
||||
void *callback_arg)),
|
||||
void *callback_arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static int initialized;
|
||||
static int is_utf8;
|
||||
#if HAVE_ICONV
|
||||
static iconv_t utf8_to_local;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
char inbuf[6];
|
||||
int count;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!initialized)
|
||||
{
|
||||
extern const char *locale_charset PARAMS ((void));
|
||||
const char *charset = locale_charset ();
|
||||
|
||||
is_utf8 = !strcmp (charset, UTF8_NAME);
|
||||
#if HAVE_ICONV
|
||||
if (!is_utf8)
|
||||
{
|
||||
utf8_to_local = iconv_open (charset, UTF8_NAME);
|
||||
if (utf8_to_local == (iconv_t)(-1))
|
||||
/* For an unknown encoding, assume ASCII. */
|
||||
utf8_to_local = iconv_open ("ASCII", UTF8_NAME);
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
initialized = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Test whether the utf8_to_local converter is available at all. */
|
||||
if (!is_utf8)
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if HAVE_ICONV
|
||||
if (utf8_to_local == (iconv_t)(-1))
|
||||
return failure (code, N_("iconv function not usable"), callback_arg);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
return failure (code, N_("iconv function not available"), callback_arg);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Convert the character to UTF-8. */
|
||||
count = utf8_wctomb ((unsigned char *) inbuf, code);
|
||||
if (count < 0)
|
||||
return failure (code, N_("character out of range"), callback_arg);
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_ICONV
|
||||
if (!is_utf8)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char outbuf[25];
|
||||
const char *inptr;
|
||||
size_t inbytesleft;
|
||||
char *outptr;
|
||||
size_t outbytesleft;
|
||||
size_t res;
|
||||
|
||||
inptr = inbuf;
|
||||
inbytesleft = count;
|
||||
outptr = outbuf;
|
||||
outbytesleft = sizeof (outbuf);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Convert the character from UTF-8 to the locale's charset. */
|
||||
res = iconv (utf8_to_local,
|
||||
(ICONV_CONST char **)&inptr, &inbytesleft,
|
||||
&outptr, &outbytesleft);
|
||||
if (inbytesleft > 0 || res == (size_t)(-1)
|
||||
/* Irix iconv() inserts a NUL byte if it cannot convert. */
|
||||
# if !defined _LIBICONV_VERSION && (defined sgi || defined __sgi)
|
||||
|| (res > 0 && code != 0 && outptr - outbuf == 1 && *outbuf == '\0')
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
)
|
||||
return failure (code, NULL, callback_arg);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Avoid glibc-2.1 bug and Solaris 2.7 bug. */
|
||||
# if defined _LIBICONV_VERSION \
|
||||
|| !((__GLIBC__ - 0 == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ - 0 <= 1) || defined __sun)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Get back to the initial shift state. */
|
||||
res = iconv (utf8_to_local, NULL, NULL, &outptr, &outbytesleft);
|
||||
if (res == (size_t)(-1))
|
||||
return failure (code, NULL, callback_arg);
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
return success (outbuf, outptr - outbuf, callback_arg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* At this point, is_utf8 is true, so no conversion is needed. */
|
||||
return success (inbuf, count, callback_arg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Simple success callback that outputs the converted string.
|
||||
The STREAM is passed as callback_arg. */
|
||||
long
|
||||
fwrite_success_callback (const char *buf, size_t buflen, void *callback_arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *stream = (FILE *) callback_arg;
|
||||
|
||||
fwrite (buf, 1, buflen, stream);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Simple failure callback that displays an error and exits. */
|
||||
static long
|
||||
exit_failure_callback (unsigned int code, const char *msg, void *callback_arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (msg == NULL)
|
||||
error (1, 0, _("cannot convert U+%04X to local character set"), code);
|
||||
else
|
||||
error (1, 0, _("cannot convert U+%04X to local character set: %s"), code,
|
||||
gettext (msg));
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Simple failure callback that displays a fallback representation in plain
|
||||
ASCII, using the same notation as ISO C99 strings. */
|
||||
static long
|
||||
fallback_failure_callback (unsigned int code, const char *msg, void *callback_arg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
FILE *stream = (FILE *) callback_arg;
|
||||
|
||||
if (code < 0x10000)
|
||||
fprintf (stream, "\\u%04X", code);
|
||||
else
|
||||
fprintf (stream, "\\U%08X", code);
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Outputs the Unicode character CODE to the output stream STREAM.
|
||||
Upon failure, exit if exit_on_error is true, otherwise output a fallback
|
||||
notation. */
|
||||
void
|
||||
print_unicode_char (FILE *stream, unsigned int code, int exit_on_error)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unicode_to_mb (code, fwrite_success_callback,
|
||||
exit_on_error
|
||||
? exit_failure_callback
|
||||
: fallback_failure_callback,
|
||||
stream);
|
||||
}
|
||||
@@ -1,44 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Unicode character output to streams with locale dependent encoding.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
|
||||
under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
|
||||
by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
|
||||
Library General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
|
||||
License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
|
||||
USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef UNICODEIO_H
|
||||
# define UNICODEIO_H
|
||||
|
||||
# include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Outputs the Unicode character CODE to the output stream STREAM.
|
||||
Upon failure, exit if exit_on_error is true, otherwise output a fallback
|
||||
notation. */
|
||||
extern void print_unicode_char PARAMS ((FILE *stream, unsigned int code,
|
||||
int exit_on_error));
|
||||
|
||||
/* Simple success callback that outputs the converted string.
|
||||
The STREAM is passed as callback_arg. */
|
||||
extern long fwrite_success_callback PARAMS ((const char *buf, size_t buflen,
|
||||
void *callback_arg));
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
@@ -1,75 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* Emulate waitpid on systems that just have wait.
|
||||
Copyright 1994, 1995, 1998, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; see the file COPYING.
|
||||
If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define WAITPID_CHILDREN 8
|
||||
static pid_t waited_pid[WAITPID_CHILDREN];
|
||||
static int waited_status[WAITPID_CHILDREN];
|
||||
|
||||
pid_t
|
||||
waitpid (pid_t pid, int *stat_loc, int options)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
pid_t p;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!options && (pid == -1 || 0 < pid))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* If we have already waited for this child, return it immediately. */
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < WAITPID_CHILDREN; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
p = waited_pid[i];
|
||||
if (p && (p == pid || pid == -1))
|
||||
{
|
||||
waited_pid[i] = 0;
|
||||
goto success;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* The child has not returned yet; wait for it, accumulating status. */
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < WAITPID_CHILDREN; i++)
|
||||
if (! waited_pid[i])
|
||||
{
|
||||
p = wait (&waited_status[i]);
|
||||
if (p < 0)
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
if (p == pid || pid == -1)
|
||||
goto success;
|
||||
waited_pid[i] = p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* We cannot emulate this wait call, e.g. because of too many children. */
|
||||
errno = EINVAL;
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
|
||||
success:
|
||||
if (stat_loc)
|
||||
*stat_loc = waited_status[i];
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
87
lib/xalloc.h
87
lib/xalloc.h
@@ -1,87 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* xalloc.h -- malloc with out-of-memory checking
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1990-1998, 1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef XALLOC_H_
|
||||
# define XALLOC_H_
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef __attribute__
|
||||
# if __GNUC__ < 2 || (__GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ < 8) || __STRICT_ANSI__
|
||||
# define __attribute__(x)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN
|
||||
# define ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN __attribute__ ((__noreturn__))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Exit value when the requested amount of memory is not available.
|
||||
It is initialized to EXIT_FAILURE, but the caller may set it to
|
||||
some other value. */
|
||||
extern int xalloc_exit_failure;
|
||||
|
||||
/* If this pointer is non-zero, run the specified function upon each
|
||||
allocation failure. It is initialized to zero. */
|
||||
extern void (*xalloc_fail_func) PARAMS ((void));
|
||||
|
||||
/* If XALLOC_FAIL_FUNC is undefined or a function that returns, this
|
||||
message is output. It is translated via gettext.
|
||||
Its value is "memory exhausted". */
|
||||
extern char const xalloc_msg_memory_exhausted[];
|
||||
|
||||
/* This function is always triggered when memory is exhausted. It is
|
||||
in charge of honoring the three previous items. This is the
|
||||
function to call when one wants the program to die because of a
|
||||
memory allocation failure. */
|
||||
extern void xalloc_die PARAMS ((void)) ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN;
|
||||
|
||||
void *xmalloc PARAMS ((size_t n));
|
||||
void *xcalloc PARAMS ((size_t n, size_t s));
|
||||
void *xrealloc PARAMS ((void *p, size_t n));
|
||||
char *xstrdup PARAMS ((const char *str));
|
||||
|
||||
# define XMALLOC(Type, N_items) ((Type *) xmalloc (sizeof (Type) * (N_items)))
|
||||
# define XCALLOC(Type, N_items) ((Type *) xcalloc (sizeof (Type), (N_items)))
|
||||
# define XREALLOC(Ptr, Type, N_items) \
|
||||
((Type *) xrealloc ((void *) (Ptr), sizeof (Type) * (N_items)))
|
||||
|
||||
/* Declare and alloc memory for VAR of type TYPE. */
|
||||
# define NEW(Type, Var) Type *(Var) = XMALLOC (Type, 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Free VAR only if non NULL. */
|
||||
# define XFREE(Var) \
|
||||
do { \
|
||||
if (Var) \
|
||||
free (Var); \
|
||||
} while (0)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return a pointer to a malloc'ed copy of the array SRC of NUM elements. */
|
||||
# define CCLONE(Src, Num) \
|
||||
(memcpy (xmalloc (sizeof (*Src) * (Num)), (Src), sizeof (*Src) * (Num)))
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return a malloc'ed copy of SRC. */
|
||||
# define CLONE(Src) CCLONE (Src, 1)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !XALLOC_H_ */
|
||||
@@ -1,79 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* xgetcwd.c -- return current directory with unlimited length
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1992, 1996, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
# include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_GETCWD
|
||||
char *getcwd ();
|
||||
#else
|
||||
char *getwd ();
|
||||
# define getcwd(Buf, Max) getwd (Buf)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "xalloc.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return the current directory, newly allocated, arbitrarily long.
|
||||
Return NULL and set errno on error. */
|
||||
|
||||
char *
|
||||
xgetcwd ()
|
||||
{
|
||||
#if defined __GLIBC__ && __GLIBC__ >= 2
|
||||
return getcwd (NULL, 0);
|
||||
#else
|
||||
size_t buf_size = 128; /* must be a power of 2 */
|
||||
char *buf = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
while (1)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *cwd;
|
||||
buf = (char *) xrealloc (buf, buf_size);
|
||||
|
||||
cwd = getcwd (buf, buf_size);
|
||||
if (cwd != NULL)
|
||||
return cwd;
|
||||
if (errno != ERANGE)
|
||||
{
|
||||
free (buf);
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
buf_size *= 2;
|
||||
if (buf_size == 0)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
}
|
||||
116
lib/xmalloc.c
116
lib/xmalloc.c
@@ -1,116 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* xmalloc.c -- malloc with out of memory checking
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1990-1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if STDC_HEADERS
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
void *calloc ();
|
||||
void *malloc ();
|
||||
void *realloc ();
|
||||
void free ();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if ENABLE_NLS
|
||||
# include <libintl.h>
|
||||
# define _(Text) gettext (Text)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define textdomain(Domain)
|
||||
# define _(Text) Text
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#define N_(Text) Text
|
||||
|
||||
#include "error.h"
|
||||
#include "xalloc.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef EXIT_FAILURE
|
||||
# define EXIT_FAILURE 1
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef HAVE_DONE_WORKING_MALLOC_CHECK
|
||||
"you must run the autoconf test for a properly working malloc -- see malloc.m4"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef HAVE_DONE_WORKING_REALLOC_CHECK
|
||||
"you must run the autoconf test for a properly working realloc --see realloc.m4"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Exit value when the requested amount of memory is not available.
|
||||
The caller may set it to some other value. */
|
||||
int xalloc_exit_failure = EXIT_FAILURE;
|
||||
|
||||
/* If non NULL, call this function when memory is exhausted. */
|
||||
void (*xalloc_fail_func) PARAMS ((void)) = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* If XALLOC_FAIL_FUNC is NULL, or does return, display this message
|
||||
before exiting when memory is exhausted. Goes through gettext. */
|
||||
char const xalloc_msg_memory_exhausted[] = N_("memory exhausted");
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
xalloc_die (void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (xalloc_fail_func)
|
||||
(*xalloc_fail_func) ();
|
||||
error (xalloc_exit_failure, 0, "%s", _(xalloc_msg_memory_exhausted));
|
||||
/* The `noreturn' cannot be given to error, since it may return if
|
||||
its first argument is 0. To help compilers understand the
|
||||
xalloc_die does terminate, call exit. */
|
||||
exit (EXIT_FAILURE);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Allocate N bytes of memory dynamically, with error checking. */
|
||||
|
||||
void *
|
||||
xmalloc (size_t n)
|
||||
{
|
||||
void *p;
|
||||
|
||||
p = malloc (n);
|
||||
if (p == 0)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Change the size of an allocated block of memory P to N bytes,
|
||||
with error checking. */
|
||||
|
||||
void *
|
||||
xrealloc (void *p, size_t n)
|
||||
{
|
||||
p = realloc (p, n);
|
||||
if (p == 0)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Allocate memory for N elements of S bytes, with error checking. */
|
||||
|
||||
void *
|
||||
xcalloc (size_t n, size_t s)
|
||||
{
|
||||
void *p;
|
||||
|
||||
p = calloc (n, s);
|
||||
if (p == 0)
|
||||
xalloc_die ();
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
288
lib/xstrtol.c
288
lib/xstrtol.c
@@ -1,288 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* A more useful interface to strtol.
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1998-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Written by Jim Meyering. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
|
||||
# include <config.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __strtol
|
||||
# define __strtol strtol
|
||||
# define __strtol_t long int
|
||||
# define __xstrtol xstrtol
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Some pre-ANSI implementations (e.g. SunOS 4)
|
||||
need stderr defined if assertion checking is enabled. */
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if STDC_HEADERS
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# include <strings.h>
|
||||
# ifndef strchr
|
||||
# define strchr index
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <assert.h>
|
||||
#include <ctype.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
#ifndef errno
|
||||
extern int errno;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
|
||||
# include <limits.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef CHAR_BIT
|
||||
# define CHAR_BIT 8
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The extra casts work around common compiler bugs. */
|
||||
#define TYPE_SIGNED(t) (! ((t) 0 < (t) -1))
|
||||
/* The outer cast is needed to work around a bug in Cray C 5.0.3.0.
|
||||
It is necessary at least when t == time_t. */
|
||||
#define TYPE_MINIMUM(t) ((t) (TYPE_SIGNED (t) \
|
||||
? ~ (t) 0 << (sizeof (t) * CHAR_BIT - 1) : (t) 0))
|
||||
#define TYPE_MAXIMUM(t) (~ (t) 0 - TYPE_MINIMUM (t))
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined (STDC_HEADERS) || (!defined (isascii) && !defined (HAVE_ISASCII))
|
||||
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) 1
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) isascii(c)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define ISSPACE(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isspace (c))
|
||||
|
||||
#include "xstrtol.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOL && !defined strtol
|
||||
long int strtol ();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL && !defined strtoul
|
||||
unsigned long int strtoul ();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOIMAX && !defined strtoimax
|
||||
intmax_t strtoimax ();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOUMAX && !defined strtoumax
|
||||
uintmax_t strtoumax ();
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
bkm_scale (__strtol_t *x, int scale_factor)
|
||||
{
|
||||
__strtol_t product = *x * scale_factor;
|
||||
if (*x != product / scale_factor)
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
*x = product;
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
bkm_scale_by_power (__strtol_t *x, int base, int power)
|
||||
{
|
||||
while (power--)
|
||||
if (bkm_scale (x, base))
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* FIXME: comment. */
|
||||
|
||||
strtol_error
|
||||
__xstrtol (const char *s, char **ptr, int strtol_base,
|
||||
__strtol_t *val, const char *valid_suffixes)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *t_ptr;
|
||||
char **p;
|
||||
__strtol_t tmp;
|
||||
|
||||
assert (0 <= strtol_base && strtol_base <= 36);
|
||||
|
||||
p = (ptr ? ptr : &t_ptr);
|
||||
|
||||
if (! TYPE_SIGNED (__strtol_t))
|
||||
{
|
||||
const char *q = s;
|
||||
while (ISSPACE ((unsigned char) *q))
|
||||
++q;
|
||||
if (*q == '-')
|
||||
return LONGINT_INVALID;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
errno = 0;
|
||||
tmp = __strtol (s, p, strtol_base);
|
||||
if (errno != 0)
|
||||
return LONGINT_OVERFLOW;
|
||||
if (*p == s)
|
||||
return LONGINT_INVALID;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Let valid_suffixes == NULL mean `allow any suffix'. */
|
||||
/* FIXME: update all callers except the ones that allow suffixes
|
||||
after the number, changing last parameter NULL to `""'. */
|
||||
if (!valid_suffixes)
|
||||
{
|
||||
*val = tmp;
|
||||
return LONGINT_OK;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (**p != '\0')
|
||||
{
|
||||
int base = 1024;
|
||||
int suffixes = 1;
|
||||
int overflow;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!strchr (valid_suffixes, **p))
|
||||
{
|
||||
*val = tmp;
|
||||
return LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (strchr (valid_suffixes, '0'))
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* The ``valid suffix'' '0' is a special flag meaning that
|
||||
an optional second suffix is allowed, which can change
|
||||
the base, e.g. "100MD" for 100 megabytes decimal. */
|
||||
|
||||
switch (p[0][1])
|
||||
{
|
||||
case 'B':
|
||||
suffixes++;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'D':
|
||||
base = 1000;
|
||||
suffixes++;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
switch (**p)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case 'b':
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale (&tmp, 512);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'B':
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale (&tmp, 1024);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'c':
|
||||
overflow = 0;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'E': /* Exa */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 6);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'G': /* Giga */
|
||||
case 'g': /* 'g' is undocumented; for compatibility only */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 3);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'k': /* kilo */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 1);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'M': /* Mega */
|
||||
case 'm': /* 'm' is undocumented; for compatibility only */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 2);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'P': /* Peta */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 5);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'T': /* Tera */
|
||||
case 't': /* 't' is undocumented; for compatibility only */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 4);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'w':
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale (&tmp, 2);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'Y': /* Yotta */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 8);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'Z': /* Zetta */
|
||||
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 7);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
*val = tmp;
|
||||
return LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (overflow)
|
||||
return LONGINT_OVERFLOW;
|
||||
|
||||
(*p) += suffixes;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
*val = tmp;
|
||||
return LONGINT_OK;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef TESTING_XSTRTO
|
||||
|
||||
# include <stdio.h>
|
||||
# include "error.h"
|
||||
|
||||
char *program_name;
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main (int argc, char** argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
strtol_error s_err;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
program_name = argv[0];
|
||||
for (i=1; i<argc; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *p;
|
||||
__strtol_t val;
|
||||
|
||||
s_err = __xstrtol (argv[i], &p, 0, &val, "bckmw");
|
||||
if (s_err == LONGINT_OK)
|
||||
{
|
||||
printf ("%s->%lu (%s)\n", argv[i], val, p);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
STRTOL_FATAL_ERROR (argv[i], "arg", s_err);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
exit (0);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* TESTING_XSTRTO */
|
||||
@@ -1,82 +0,0 @@
|
||||
/* A more useful interface to strtol.
|
||||
Copyright 1995, 1996, 1998, 1999, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef XSTRTOL_H_
|
||||
# define XSTRTOL_H_ 1
|
||||
|
||||
# if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
|
||||
# include <inttypes.h> /* for uintmax_t */
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef PARAMS
|
||||
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef _STRTOL_ERROR
|
||||
enum strtol_error
|
||||
{
|
||||
LONGINT_OK, LONGINT_INVALID, LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR, LONGINT_OVERFLOW
|
||||
};
|
||||
typedef enum strtol_error strtol_error;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# define _DECLARE_XSTRTOL(name, type) \
|
||||
strtol_error \
|
||||
name PARAMS ((const char *s, char **ptr, int base, \
|
||||
type *val, const char *valid_suffixes));
|
||||
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtol, long int)
|
||||
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtoul, unsigned long int)
|
||||
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtoimax, intmax_t)
|
||||
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtoumax, uintmax_t)
|
||||
|
||||
# define _STRTOL_ERROR(Exit_code, Str, Argument_type_string, Err) \
|
||||
do \
|
||||
{ \
|
||||
switch ((Err)) \
|
||||
{ \
|
||||
case LONGINT_OK: \
|
||||
abort (); \
|
||||
\
|
||||
case LONGINT_INVALID: \
|
||||
error ((Exit_code), 0, "invalid %s `%s'", \
|
||||
(Argument_type_string), (Str)); \
|
||||
break; \
|
||||
\
|
||||
case LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR: \
|
||||
error ((Exit_code), 0, "invalid character following %s in `%s'", \
|
||||
(Argument_type_string), (Str)); \
|
||||
break; \
|
||||
\
|
||||
case LONGINT_OVERFLOW: \
|
||||
error ((Exit_code), 0, "%s `%s' too large", \
|
||||
(Argument_type_string), (Str)); \
|
||||
break; \
|
||||
} \
|
||||
} \
|
||||
while (0)
|
||||
|
||||
# define STRTOL_FATAL_ERROR(Str, Argument_type_string, Err) \
|
||||
_STRTOL_ERROR (2, Str, Argument_type_string, Err)
|
||||
|
||||
# define STRTOL_FAIL_WARN(Str, Argument_type_string, Err) \
|
||||
_STRTOL_ERROR (0, Str, Argument_type_string, Err)
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* not XSTRTOL_H_ */
|
||||
@@ -1,3 +0,0 @@
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
*.m4
|
||||
23
m4/c-bs-a.m4
23
m4/c-bs-a.m4
@@ -1,23 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 4
|
||||
|
||||
dnl From Paul Eggert.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([AC_C_BACKSLASH_A],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether backslash-a works in strings], ac_cv_c_backslash_a,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_COMPILE([],
|
||||
[
|
||||
#if '\a' == 'a'
|
||||
syntax error;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
char buf['\a' == 'a' ? -1 : 1];
|
||||
buf[0] = '\a';
|
||||
return buf[0] != "\a"[0];
|
||||
],
|
||||
ac_cv_c_backslash_a=yes,
|
||||
ac_cv_c_backslash_a=no)])
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_c_backslash_a = yes; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_C_BACKSLASH_A, 1,
|
||||
[Define if backslash-a works in C strings.])
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
95
m4/ccstdc.m4
95
m4/ccstdc.m4
@@ -1,95 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# The following is taken from automake 1.4,
|
||||
# except that it prefers the compiler option -Ae to "-Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE"
|
||||
# because only the former supports 64-bit integral types on HP-UX 10.20.
|
||||
|
||||
## ----------------------------------------- ##
|
||||
## ANSIfy the C compiler whenever possible. ##
|
||||
## From Franc,ois Pinard ##
|
||||
## ----------------------------------------- ##
|
||||
|
||||
# serial 2
|
||||
|
||||
# @defmac AC_PROG_CC_STDC
|
||||
# @maindex PROG_CC_STDC
|
||||
# @ovindex CC
|
||||
# If the C compiler in not in ANSI C mode by default, try to add an option
|
||||
# to output variable @code{CC} to make it so. This macro tries various
|
||||
# options that select ANSI C on some system or another. It considers the
|
||||
# compiler to be in ANSI C mode if it handles function prototypes correctly.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# If you use this macro, you should check after calling it whether the C
|
||||
# compiler has been set to accept ANSI C; if not, the shell variable
|
||||
# @code{am_cv_prog_cc_stdc} is set to @samp{no}. If you wrote your source
|
||||
# code in ANSI C, you can make an un-ANSIfied copy of it by using the
|
||||
# program @code{ansi2knr}, which comes with Ghostscript.
|
||||
# @end defmac
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(AM_PROG_CC_STDC,
|
||||
[AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])
|
||||
AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_C_INLINE])
|
||||
AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_C_CONST])
|
||||
dnl Force this before AC_PROG_CPP. Some cpp's, eg on HPUX, require
|
||||
dnl a magic option to avoid problems with ANSI preprocessor commands
|
||||
dnl like #elif.
|
||||
dnl FIXME: can't do this because then AC_AIX won't work due to a
|
||||
dnl circular dependency.
|
||||
dnl AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_PROG_CPP])
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING(for ${CC-cc} option to accept ANSI C)
|
||||
AC_CACHE_VAL(am_cv_prog_cc_stdc,
|
||||
[am_cv_prog_cc_stdc=no
|
||||
ac_save_CC="$CC"
|
||||
# Don't try gcc -ansi; that turns off useful extensions and
|
||||
# breaks some systems' header files.
|
||||
# AIX -qlanglvl=ansi
|
||||
# Ultrix and OSF/1 -std1
|
||||
# HP-UX -Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE
|
||||
# SVR4 -Xc -D__EXTENSIONS__
|
||||
for ac_arg in "" -qlanglvl=ansi -std1 -Ae "-Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE" "-Xc -D__EXTENSIONS__"
|
||||
do
|
||||
CC="$ac_save_CC $ac_arg"
|
||||
AC_TRY_COMPILE(
|
||||
[#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
/* Most of the following tests are stolen from RCS 5.7's src/conf.sh. */
|
||||
struct buf { int x; };
|
||||
FILE * (*rcsopen) (struct buf *, struct stat *, int);
|
||||
static char *e (p, i)
|
||||
char **p;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
{
|
||||
return p[i];
|
||||
}
|
||||
static char *f (char * (*g) (char **, int), char **p, ...)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *s;
|
||||
va_list v;
|
||||
va_start (v,p);
|
||||
s = g (p, va_arg (v,int));
|
||||
va_end (v);
|
||||
return s;
|
||||
}
|
||||
int test (int i, double x);
|
||||
struct s1 {int (*f) (int a);};
|
||||
struct s2 {int (*f) (double a);};
|
||||
int pairnames (int, char **, FILE *(*)(struct buf *, struct stat *, int), int, int);
|
||||
int argc;
|
||||
char **argv;
|
||||
], [
|
||||
return f (e, argv, 0) != argv[0] || f (e, argv, 1) != argv[1];
|
||||
],
|
||||
[am_cv_prog_cc_stdc="$ac_arg"; break])
|
||||
done
|
||||
CC="$ac_save_CC"
|
||||
])
|
||||
if test -z "$am_cv_prog_cc_stdc"; then
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT([none needed])
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($am_cv_prog_cc_stdc)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
case "x$am_cv_prog_cc_stdc" in
|
||||
x|xno) ;;
|
||||
*) CC="$CC $am_cv_prog_cc_stdc" ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
])
|
||||
37
m4/decl.m4
37
m4/decl.m4
@@ -1,37 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 5
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(jm_CHECK_DECLARATION,
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether $1 is declared])
|
||||
AC_CACHE_VAL(jm_cv_func_decl_$1,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_COMPILE($2,
|
||||
[
|
||||
#ifndef $1
|
||||
char *(*pfn) = (char *(*)) $1
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
],
|
||||
eval "jm_cv_func_decl_$1=yes",
|
||||
eval "jm_cv_func_decl_$1=no")])
|
||||
|
||||
if eval "test \"`echo '$jm_cv_func_decl_'$1`\" = yes"; then
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT(yes)
|
||||
ifelse([$3], , :, [$3])
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT(no)
|
||||
ifelse([$4], , , [$4
|
||||
])dnl
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])dnl
|
||||
|
||||
dnl jm_CHECK_DECLARATIONS(INCLUDES, FUNCTION... [, ACTION-IF-DECLARED
|
||||
dnl [, ACTION-IF-NOT-DECLARED]])
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(jm_CHECK_DECLARATIONS,
|
||||
[
|
||||
for jm_func in $2
|
||||
do
|
||||
jm_CHECK_DECLARATION($jm_func, $1,
|
||||
[
|
||||
jm_tr_func=HAVE_DECL_`echo $jm_func | tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ`
|
||||
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED($jm_tr_func) $3], $4)dnl
|
||||
done
|
||||
])
|
||||
12
m4/error.m4
12
m4/error.m4
@@ -1,12 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 3
|
||||
|
||||
dnl FIXME: put these prerequisite-only *.m4 files in a separate
|
||||
dnl directory -- otherwise, they'll conflict with existing files.
|
||||
|
||||
dnl These are the prerequisite macros for GNU's error.c file.
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_ERROR],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(strerror strerror_r vprintf doprnt)
|
||||
AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R
|
||||
AC_HEADER_STDC
|
||||
])
|
||||
@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
|
||||
dnl This is a copy of autoconf 2.13, except we also check that
|
||||
dnl FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR works.
|
||||
dnl
|
||||
undefine([AC_FUNC_FNMATCH])
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(AC_FUNC_FNMATCH,
|
||||
[AC_CACHE_CHECK(for working GNU-style fnmatch, ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works,
|
||||
# Some versions of Solaris, SCO, and the GNU C Library
|
||||
# have a broken or incompatible fnmatch.
|
||||
# So we run a test program. If we are cross-compiling, take no chance.
|
||||
# Thanks to John Oleynick, Franc,ois Pinard, and Paul Eggert for this test.
|
||||
[AC_TRY_RUN([#include <fnmatch.h>
|
||||
main() {
|
||||
exit (fnmatch ("a*", "abc", 0) != 0
|
||||
|| fnmatch("d*/*1", "d/s/1", FNM_FILE_NAME) != FNM_NOMATCH
|
||||
|| fnmatch("*", "x", FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR) != 0
|
||||
|| fnmatch("x*", "x/y/z", FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR) != 0
|
||||
|| fnmatch("*c*", "c/x", FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR) != 0);
|
||||
}],
|
||||
ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works=yes, ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works=no,
|
||||
ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works=no)])
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works = yes; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_FNMATCH)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
53
m4/getcwd.m4
53
m4/getcwd.m4
@@ -1,53 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# getcwd.m4 - check whether getcwd (NULL, 0) allocates memory for result
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
# any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
# GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
|
||||
# Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
# Written by Paul Eggert.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([AC_FUNC_GETCWD_NULL],
|
||||
[AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdlib.h unistd.h)
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether getcwd (NULL, 0) allocates memory for result],
|
||||
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null],
|
||||
[AC_TRY_RUN(
|
||||
[
|
||||
# ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
# include <unistd.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef getcwd
|
||||
char *getcwd ();
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
int
|
||||
main ()
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (chdir ("/") != 0)
|
||||
exit (1);
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *f = getcwd (NULL, 0);
|
||||
exit (! (f && f[0] == '/' && !f[1]));
|
||||
}
|
||||
}],
|
||||
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null=yes],
|
||||
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null=no],
|
||||
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null=no])])
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_func_getcwd_null = yes; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_GETCWD_NULL, 1,
|
||||
[Define if getcwd (NULL, 0) allocates memory for result.])
|
||||
fi])
|
||||
368
m4/gettext.m4
368
m4/gettext.m4
@@ -1,368 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# Macro to add for using GNU gettext.
|
||||
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# This file can be copied and used freely without restrictions. It can
|
||||
# be used in projects which are not available under the GNU General Public
|
||||
# License but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext
|
||||
# functionality.
|
||||
# Please note that the actual code of GNU gettext is covered by the GNU
|
||||
# General Public License and is *not* in the public domain.
|
||||
|
||||
# serial 10
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Usage: AM_WITH_NLS([TOOLSYMBOL], [NEEDSYMBOL], [LIBDIR]).
|
||||
dnl If TOOLSYMBOL is specified and is 'use-libtool', then a libtool library
|
||||
dnl $(top_builddir)/intl/libintl.la will be created (shared and/or static,
|
||||
dnl depending on --{enable,disable}-{shared,static} and on the presence of
|
||||
dnl AM-DISABLE-SHARED). Otherwise, a static library
|
||||
dnl $(top_builddir)/intl/libintl.a will be created.
|
||||
dnl If NEEDSYMBOL is specified and is 'need-ngettext', then GNU gettext
|
||||
dnl implementations (in libc or libintl) without the ngettext() function
|
||||
dnl will be ignored.
|
||||
dnl LIBDIR is used to find the intl libraries. If empty,
|
||||
dnl the value `$(top_builddir)/intl/' is used.
|
||||
dnl
|
||||
dnl The result of the configuration is one of three cases:
|
||||
dnl 1) GNU gettext, as included in the intl subdirectory, will be compiled
|
||||
dnl and used.
|
||||
dnl Catalog format: GNU --> install in $(datadir)
|
||||
dnl Catalog extension: .mo after installation, .gmo in source tree
|
||||
dnl 2) GNU gettext has been found in the system's C library.
|
||||
dnl Catalog format: GNU --> install in $(datadir)
|
||||
dnl Catalog extension: .mo after installation, .gmo in source tree
|
||||
dnl 3) No internationalization, always use English msgid.
|
||||
dnl Catalog format: none
|
||||
dnl Catalog extension: none
|
||||
dnl The use of .gmo is historical (it was needed to avoid overwriting the
|
||||
dnl GNU format catalogs when building on a platform with an X/Open gettext),
|
||||
dnl but we keep it in order not to force irrelevant filename changes on the
|
||||
dnl maintainers.
|
||||
dnl
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([AM_WITH_NLS],
|
||||
[AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether NLS is requested])
|
||||
dnl Default is enabled NLS
|
||||
AC_ARG_ENABLE(nls,
|
||||
[ --disable-nls do not use Native Language Support],
|
||||
USE_NLS=$enableval, USE_NLS=yes)
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($USE_NLS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(USE_NLS)
|
||||
|
||||
BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
|
||||
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
|
||||
INTLLIBS=
|
||||
|
||||
dnl If we use NLS figure out what method
|
||||
if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(ENABLE_NLS, 1,
|
||||
[Define to 1 if translation of program messages to the user's native language
|
||||
is requested.])
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether included gettext is requested])
|
||||
AC_ARG_WITH(included-gettext,
|
||||
[ --with-included-gettext use the GNU gettext library included here],
|
||||
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=$withval,
|
||||
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=no)
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext)
|
||||
|
||||
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext="$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext"
|
||||
if test "$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext" != "yes"; then
|
||||
dnl User does not insist on using GNU NLS library. Figure out what
|
||||
dnl to use. If GNU gettext is available we use this. Else we have
|
||||
dnl to fall back to GNU NLS library.
|
||||
CATOBJEXT=NONE
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Add a version number to the cache macros.
|
||||
define(gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc, [gt_cv_func_gnugettext]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, 2, 1)[_libc])
|
||||
define(gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl, [gt_cv_func_gnugettext]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, 2, 1)[_libintl])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADER(libintl.h,
|
||||
[AC_CACHE_CHECK([for GNU gettext in libc], gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>
|
||||
extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;],
|
||||
[bindtextdomain ("", "");
|
||||
return (int) gettext ("")]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, [ + (int) ngettext ("", "", 0)], [])[ + _nl_msg_cat_cntr],
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc=yes,
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc=no)])
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc" != "yes"; then
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for GNU gettext in libintl],
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl,
|
||||
[gt_save_LIBS="$LIBS"
|
||||
LIBS="$LIBS -lintl $LIBICONV"
|
||||
AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>
|
||||
extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;],
|
||||
[bindtextdomain ("", "");
|
||||
return (int) gettext ("")]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, [ + (int) ngettext ("", "", 0)], [])[ + _nl_msg_cat_cntr],
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl=yes,
|
||||
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl=no)
|
||||
LIBS="$gt_save_LIBS"])
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl If an already present or preinstalled GNU gettext() is found,
|
||||
dnl use it. But if this macro is used in GNU gettext, and GNU
|
||||
dnl gettext is already preinstalled in libintl, we update this
|
||||
dnl libintl. (Cf. the install rule in intl/Makefile.in.)
|
||||
if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc" = "yes" \
|
||||
|| { test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" = "yes" \
|
||||
&& test "$PACKAGE" != gettext; }; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_GETTEXT, 1,
|
||||
[Define if the GNU gettext() function is already present or preinstalled.])
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" = "yes"; then
|
||||
dnl If iconv() is in a separate libiconv library, then anyone
|
||||
dnl linking with libintl{.a,.so} also needs to link with
|
||||
dnl libiconv.
|
||||
INTLLIBS="-lintl $LIBICONV"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
gt_save_LIBS="$LIBS"
|
||||
LIBS="$LIBS $INTLLIBS"
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(dcgettext)
|
||||
LIBS="$gt_save_LIBS"
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Search for GNU msgfmt in the PATH.
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
|
||||
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
|
||||
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Search for GNU xgettext in the PATH.
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
|
||||
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --omit-header /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
|
||||
|
||||
CATOBJEXT=.gmo
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = "NONE"; then
|
||||
dnl GNU gettext is not found in the C library.
|
||||
dnl Fall back on GNU gettext library.
|
||||
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext=yes
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext" = "yes"; then
|
||||
dnl Mark actions used to generate GNU NLS library.
|
||||
INTLOBJS="\$(GETTOBJS)"
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
|
||||
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
|
||||
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
|
||||
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
|
||||
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --omit-header /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(MSGFMT)
|
||||
BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
|
||||
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
|
||||
CATOBJEXT=.gmo
|
||||
INTLLIBS="ifelse([$3],[],\$(top_builddir)/intl,[$3])/libintl.ifelse([$1], use-libtool, [l], [])a $LIBICONV"
|
||||
LIBS=`echo " $LIBS " | sed -e 's/ -lintl / /' -e 's/^ //' -e 's/ $//'`
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl This could go away some day; the PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST already does it.
|
||||
dnl Test whether we really found GNU msgfmt.
|
||||
if test "$GMSGFMT" != ":"; then
|
||||
dnl If it is no GNU msgfmt we define it as : so that the
|
||||
dnl Makefiles still can work.
|
||||
if $GMSGFMT --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then
|
||||
: ;
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT(
|
||||
[found msgfmt program is not GNU msgfmt; ignore it])
|
||||
GMSGFMT=":"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl This could go away some day; the PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST already does it.
|
||||
dnl Test whether we really found GNU xgettext.
|
||||
if test "$XGETTEXT" != ":"; then
|
||||
dnl If it is no GNU xgettext we define it as : so that the
|
||||
dnl Makefiles still can work.
|
||||
if $XGETTEXT --omit-header /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then
|
||||
: ;
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT(
|
||||
[found xgettext program is not GNU xgettext; ignore it])
|
||||
XGETTEXT=":"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl We need to process the po/ directory.
|
||||
POSUB=po
|
||||
fi
|
||||
AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS(
|
||||
[for ac_file in $CONFIG_FILES; do
|
||||
# Support "outfile[:infile[:infile...]]"
|
||||
case "$ac_file" in
|
||||
*:*) ac_file=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%:.*%%'` ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
# PO directories have a Makefile.in generated from Makefile.in.in.
|
||||
case "$ac_file" in */Makefile.in)
|
||||
# Adjust a relative srcdir.
|
||||
ac_dir=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%/[^/][^/]*$%%'`
|
||||
ac_dir_suffix="/`echo "$ac_dir"|sed 's%^\./%%'`"
|
||||
ac_dots=`echo "$ac_dir_suffix"|sed 's%/[^/]*%../%g'`
|
||||
# In autoconf-2.13 it is called $ac_given_srcdir.
|
||||
# In autoconf-2.50 it is called $srcdir.
|
||||
test -n "$ac_given_srcdir" || ac_given_srcdir="$srcdir"
|
||||
case "$ac_given_srcdir" in
|
||||
.) top_srcdir=`echo $ac_dots|sed 's%/$%%'` ;;
|
||||
/*) top_srcdir="$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
|
||||
*) top_srcdir="$ac_dots$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
if test -f "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/POTFILES.in"; then
|
||||
rm -f "$ac_dir/POTFILES"
|
||||
test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: creating $ac_dir/POTFILES" || echo "creating $ac_dir/POTFILES"
|
||||
sed -e "/^#/d" -e "/^[ ]*\$/d" -e "s,.*, $top_srcdir/& \\\\," -e "\$s/\(.*\) \\\\/\1/" < "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/POTFILES.in" > "$ac_dir/POTFILES"
|
||||
test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: creating $ac_dir/Makefile" || echo "creating $ac_dir/Makefile"
|
||||
sed -e "/POTFILES =/r $ac_dir/POTFILES" "$ac_dir/Makefile.in" > "$ac_dir/Makefile"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
done])
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
dnl If this is used in GNU gettext we have to set BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL
|
||||
dnl to 'yes' because some of the testsuite requires it.
|
||||
if test "$PACKAGE" = gettext; then
|
||||
BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl intl/plural.c is generated from intl/plural.y. It requires bison,
|
||||
dnl because plural.y uses bison specific features. It requires at least
|
||||
dnl bison-1.26 because earlier versions generate a plural.c that doesn't
|
||||
dnl compile.
|
||||
dnl bison is only needed for the maintainer (who touches plural.y). But in
|
||||
dnl order to avoid separate Makefiles or --enable-maintainer-mode, we put
|
||||
dnl the rule in general Makefile. Now, some people carelessly touch the
|
||||
dnl files or have a broken "make" program, hence the plural.c rule will
|
||||
dnl sometimes fire. To avoid an error, defines BISON to ":" if it is not
|
||||
dnl present or too old.
|
||||
AC_CHECK_PROGS([INTLBISON], [bison])
|
||||
if test -z "$INTLBISON"; then
|
||||
ac_verc_fail=yes
|
||||
else
|
||||
dnl Found it, now check the version.
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING([version of bison])
|
||||
changequote(<<,>>)dnl
|
||||
ac_prog_version=`$INTLBISON --version 2>&1 | sed -n 's/^.*GNU Bison .* \([0-9]*\.[0-9.]*\).*$/\1/p'`
|
||||
case $ac_prog_version in
|
||||
'') ac_prog_version="v. ?.??, bad"; ac_verc_fail=yes;;
|
||||
1.2[6-9]* | 1.[3-9][0-9]* | [2-9].*)
|
||||
changequote([,])dnl
|
||||
ac_prog_version="$ac_prog_version, ok"; ac_verc_fail=no;;
|
||||
*) ac_prog_version="$ac_prog_version, bad"; ac_verc_fail=yes;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT([$ac_prog_version])
|
||||
fi
|
||||
if test $ac_verc_fail = yes; then
|
||||
INTLBISON=:
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl These rules are solely for the distribution goal. While doing this
|
||||
dnl we only have to keep exactly one list of the available catalogs
|
||||
dnl in configure.in.
|
||||
for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
|
||||
GMOFILES="$GMOFILES $lang.gmo"
|
||||
POFILES="$POFILES $lang.po"
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Make all variables we use known to autoconf.
|
||||
AC_SUBST(BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(CATALOGS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(CATOBJEXT)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(GMOFILES)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INTLLIBS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INTLOBJS)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(POFILES)
|
||||
AC_SUBST(POSUB)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl For backward compatibility. Some configure.ins may be using this.
|
||||
nls_cv_header_intl=
|
||||
nls_cv_header_libgt=
|
||||
|
||||
dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
|
||||
DATADIRNAME=share
|
||||
AC_SUBST(DATADIRNAME)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
|
||||
INSTOBJEXT=.mo
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INSTOBJEXT)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
|
||||
GENCAT=gencat
|
||||
AC_SUBST(GENCAT)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Usage: Just like AM_WITH_NLS, which see.
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([AM_GNU_GETTEXT],
|
||||
[AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_MAKE_SET])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_RANLIB])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_ISC_POSIX])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_HEADER_STDC])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_CONST])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_INLINE])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_OFF_T])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_SIZE_T])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_ALLOCA])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_MMAP])dnl
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_GLIBC21])dnl
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS([argz.h limits.h locale.h nl_types.h malloc.h stddef.h \
|
||||
stdlib.h string.h unistd.h sys/param.h])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS([feof_unlocked fgets_unlocked getcwd getegid geteuid \
|
||||
getgid getuid mempcpy munmap putenv setenv setlocale stpcpy strchr strcasecmp \
|
||||
strdup strtoul tsearch __argz_count __argz_stringify __argz_next])
|
||||
|
||||
AM_ICONV
|
||||
AM_LANGINFO_CODESET
|
||||
AM_LC_MESSAGES
|
||||
AM_WITH_NLS([$1],[$2],[$3])
|
||||
|
||||
if test "x$CATOBJEXT" != "x"; then
|
||||
if test "x$ALL_LINGUAS" = "x"; then
|
||||
LINGUAS=
|
||||
else
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING(for catalogs to be installed)
|
||||
NEW_LINGUAS=
|
||||
for presentlang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
|
||||
useit=no
|
||||
for desiredlang in ${LINGUAS-$ALL_LINGUAS}; do
|
||||
# Use the presentlang catalog if desiredlang is
|
||||
# a. equal to presentlang, or
|
||||
# b. a variant of presentlang (because in this case,
|
||||
# presentlang can be used as a fallback for messages
|
||||
# which are not translated in the desiredlang catalog).
|
||||
case "$desiredlang" in
|
||||
"$presentlang"*) useit=yes;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
done
|
||||
if test $useit = yes; then
|
||||
NEW_LINGUAS="$NEW_LINGUAS $presentlang"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
done
|
||||
LINGUAS=$NEW_LINGUAS
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT($LINGUAS)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Construct list of names of catalog files to be constructed.
|
||||
if test -n "$LINGUAS"; then
|
||||
for lang in $LINGUAS; do CATALOGS="$CATALOGS $lang$CATOBJEXT"; done
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl If the AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR macro for autoconf is used we possibly
|
||||
dnl find the mkinstalldirs script in another subdir but $(top_srcdir).
|
||||
dnl Try to locate is.
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS=
|
||||
if test -n "$ac_aux_dir"; then
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS="$ac_aux_dir/mkinstalldirs"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
if test -z "$MKINSTALLDIRS"; then
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS="\$(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs"
|
||||
fi
|
||||
AC_SUBST(MKINSTALLDIRS)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Enable libtool support if the surrounding package wishes it.
|
||||
INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX=ifelse([$1], use-libtool, [l], [])
|
||||
AC_SUBST(INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX)
|
||||
])
|
||||
@@ -1,32 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 6
|
||||
|
||||
dnl From Paul Eggert.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_PREREQ(2.52)
|
||||
|
||||
# Define intmax_t to long or long long if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_TYPE(intmax_t, ,
|
||||
[test $ac_cv_type_long_long = yes \
|
||||
&& ac_type='long long' \
|
||||
|| ac_type='long'
|
||||
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(intmax_t, $ac_type,
|
||||
[Define to widest signed type if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.])])
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
# Define uintmax_t to unsigned long or unsigned long long
|
||||
# if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_TYPE(uintmax_t, ,
|
||||
[test $ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long = yes \
|
||||
&& ac_type='unsigned long long' \
|
||||
|| ac_type='unsigned long'
|
||||
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(uintmax_t, $ac_type,
|
||||
[Define to widest unsigned type if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.])])
|
||||
])
|
||||
@@ -1,19 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 1
|
||||
|
||||
dnl From Paul Eggert
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN(jm_FUNC_MBRTOWC,
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether mbrtowc and mbstate_t are properly declared])
|
||||
AC_CACHE_VAL(jm_cv_func_mbrtowc,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_LINK(
|
||||
[#include <wchar.h>],
|
||||
[mbstate_t state; return ! (sizeof state && mbrtowc);],
|
||||
[jm_cv_func_mbrtowc=yes],
|
||||
[jm_cv_func_mbrtowc=no])])
|
||||
if test $jm_cv_func_mbrtowc = yes; then
|
||||
AC_MSG_RESULT(yes)
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_MBRTOWC, 1,
|
||||
[Define to 1 if mbrtowc and mbstate_t are properly declared.])
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
@@ -1,29 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# serial 9
|
||||
|
||||
# From Paul Eggert.
|
||||
|
||||
# BeOS 5 has <wchar.h> but does not define mbstate_t,
|
||||
# so you can't declare an object of that type.
|
||||
# Check for this incompatibility with Standard C.
|
||||
|
||||
# Include stdlib.h first, because otherwise this test would fail on Linux
|
||||
# (at least glibc-2.1.3) because the "_XOPEN_SOURCE 500" definition elicits
|
||||
# a syntax error in wchar.h due to the use of undefined __int32_t.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([AC_MBSTATE_T],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdlib.h)
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for mbstate_t], ac_cv_type_mbstate_t,
|
||||
[AC_TRY_COMPILE([
|
||||
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
# include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#include <wchar.h>],
|
||||
[mbstate_t x; return sizeof x;],
|
||||
ac_cv_type_mbstate_t=yes,
|
||||
ac_cv_type_mbstate_t=no)])
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_type_mbstate_t = no; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(mbstate_t, int,
|
||||
[Define to a type if <wchar.h> does not define.])
|
||||
fi])
|
||||
141
m4/prereq.m4
141
m4/prereq.m4
@@ -1,141 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 21
|
||||
|
||||
dnl These are the prerequisite macros for files in the lib/
|
||||
dnl directories of the fileutils, sh-utils, and textutils packages.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ],
|
||||
[
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_ADDEXT
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_CANON_HOST
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_DIRNAME
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_ERROR
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_EXCLUDE
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_GETPAGESIZE
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_HASH
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_HUMAN
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_MBSWIDTH
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_MEMCHR
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_QUOTEARG
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_READUTMP
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_REGEX
|
||||
jm_PREREQ_TEMPNAME # called by mkstemp
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_ADDEXT],
|
||||
[
|
||||
dnl For addext.c.
|
||||
AC_SYS_LONG_FILE_NAMES
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(pathconf)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h string.h unistd.h)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_CANON_HOST],
|
||||
[
|
||||
dnl Add any libraries as early as possible.
|
||||
dnl In particular, inet_ntoa needs -lnsl at least on Solaris5.5.1,
|
||||
dnl so we have to add -lnsl to LIBS before checking for that function.
|
||||
AC_SEARCH_LIBS(gethostbyname, [inet nsl])
|
||||
|
||||
dnl These come from -lnsl on Solaris5.5.1.
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(gethostbyname gethostbyaddr inet_ntoa)
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(gethostbyname gethostbyaddr inet_ntoa)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(unistd.h string.h netdb.h sys/socket.h \
|
||||
netinet/in.h arpa/inet.h)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_DIRNAME],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_HEADER_STDC
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(string.h)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_EXCLUDE],
|
||||
[
|
||||
jm_FUNC_FNMATCH
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdbool.h)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_GETPAGESIZE],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(getpagesize)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(OS.h unistd.h)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_HASH],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdlib.h stdbool.h)
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_CHECK_DECLS])
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
# If you use human.c, you need the following files:
|
||||
# inttypes.m4 ulonglong.m4
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_HUMAN],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h string.h)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_DECLS([getenv])
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T])
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_MEMCHR],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h bp-sym.h)
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_QUOTEARG],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(isascii iswprint)
|
||||
jm_FUNC_MBRTOWC
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stddef.h stdlib.h string.h wchar.h wctype.h)
|
||||
AC_HEADER_STDC
|
||||
AC_C_BACKSLASH_A
|
||||
AC_MBSTATE_T
|
||||
AM_C_PROTOTYPES
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_READUTMP],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_HEADER_STDC
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(string.h utmp.h utmpx.h sys/param.h)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(utmpname)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(utmpxname)
|
||||
AM_C_PROTOTYPES
|
||||
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_header_utmp_h = yes || test $ac_cv_header_utmpx_h = yes; then
|
||||
utmp_includes="\
|
||||
$ac_includes_default
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_UTMPX_H
|
||||
# include <utmpx.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_UTMP_H
|
||||
# include <utmp.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
"
|
||||
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmpx.ut_user],,,[$utmp_includes])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmp.ut_user],,,[$utmp_includes])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmpx.ut_name],,,[$utmp_includes])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmp.ut_name],,,[$utmp_includes])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmpx.ut_type],,,[$utmp_includes])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmp.ut_type],,,[$utmp_includes])
|
||||
AC_LIBOBJ(readutmp)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_REGEX],
|
||||
[
|
||||
dnl FIXME: Maybe provide a btowc replacement someday: solaris-2.5.1 lacks it.
|
||||
dnl FIXME: Check for wctype and iswctype, and and add -lw if necessary
|
||||
dnl to get them.
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(bzero bcopy isascii btowc)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(alloca.h libintl.h wctype.h wchar.h)
|
||||
AC_HEADER_STDC
|
||||
AC_FUNC_ALLOCA
|
||||
])
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_TEMPNAME],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_HEADER_STDC
|
||||
AC_HEADER_STAT
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(fcntl.h sys/time.h stdint.h unistd.h)
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(__secure_getenv gettimeofday)
|
||||
])
|
||||
@@ -1,66 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 1002
|
||||
# Experimental replacement for the function in the latest CVS autoconf.
|
||||
# If the compile-test says strerror_r doesn't work, then resort to a
|
||||
# `run'-test that works on BeOS and segfaults on DEC Unix.
|
||||
# Use with the error.c file in ../lib.
|
||||
|
||||
undefine([AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R])
|
||||
|
||||
# AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R
|
||||
# ------------------
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R],
|
||||
[AC_CHECK_DECLS([strerror_r])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_FUNCS([strerror_r])
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_func_strerror_r = yes; then
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(string.h)
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for working strerror_r],
|
||||
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works,
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_TRY_COMPILE(
|
||||
[
|
||||
# include <stdio.h>
|
||||
# if HAVE_STRING_H
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
],
|
||||
[
|
||||
char buf[100];
|
||||
char x = *strerror_r (0, buf, sizeof buf);
|
||||
],
|
||||
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=yes,
|
||||
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=no
|
||||
)
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works = no; then
|
||||
# strerror_r seems not to work, but now we have to choose between
|
||||
# systems that have relatively inaccessible declarations for the
|
||||
# function. BeOS and DEC UNIX 4.0 fall in this category, but the
|
||||
# former has a strerror_r that returns char*, while the latter
|
||||
# has a strerror_r that returns `int'.
|
||||
# This test should segfault on the DEC system.
|
||||
AC_TRY_RUN(
|
||||
[
|
||||
# include <stdio.h>
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
# include <ctype.h>
|
||||
|
||||
extern char *strerror_r ();
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main ()
|
||||
{
|
||||
char buf[100];
|
||||
char x = *strerror_r (0, buf, sizeof buf);
|
||||
exit (!isalpha (x));
|
||||
}
|
||||
],
|
||||
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=yes,
|
||||
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=no,
|
||||
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=no)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])
|
||||
if test $ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works = yes; then
|
||||
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_WORKING_STRERROR_R, 1,
|
||||
[Define to 1 if `strerror_r' returns a string.])
|
||||
fi
|
||||
fi
|
||||
])# AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R
|
||||
@@ -1,19 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 6
|
||||
|
||||
dnl From Paul Eggert.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_PREREQ(2.50)
|
||||
|
||||
# Define uintmax_t to `unsigned long' or `unsigned long long'
|
||||
# if <inttypes.h> does not exist.
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_CHECK_TYPE(uintmax_t, ,
|
||||
[AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
|
||||
test $ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long = yes \
|
||||
&& ac_type='unsigned long long' \
|
||||
|| ac_type='unsigned long'
|
||||
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(uintmax_t, $ac_type,
|
||||
[Define to the widest unsigned type if standard headers do not declare.])])
|
||||
])
|
||||
@@ -1,41 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 2
|
||||
dnl Cloned from xstrtoumax.m4. Keep these files in sync.
|
||||
|
||||
# autoconf tests required for use of xstrtoimax.c
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_PREREQ_XSTRTOIMAX],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T])
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T])
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG])
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_DECLS([strtol, strtoul, strtoll, strtoimax, strtoumax])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h inttypes.h)
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether <inttypes.h> defines strtoimax as a macro],
|
||||
jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro,
|
||||
AC_EGREP_CPP([inttypes_h_defines_strtoimax], [#include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
#ifdef strtoimax
|
||||
inttypes_h_defines_strtoimax
|
||||
#endif],
|
||||
jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro=yes,
|
||||
jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro=no))
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro" != yes; then
|
||||
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoimax)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Only the replacement strtoimax invokes strtol and strtoll,
|
||||
dnl so we need the replacements only if strtoimax does not exist.
|
||||
case "$jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro,$ac_cv_func_strtoimax" in
|
||||
no,no)
|
||||
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtol)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl We don't need (and can't compile) the replacement strtoll
|
||||
dnl unless the type `long long' exists.
|
||||
if test "$ac_cv_type_long_long" = yes; then
|
||||
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoll)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
])
|
||||
@@ -1,40 +0,0 @@
|
||||
#serial 4
|
||||
|
||||
# autoconf tests required for use of xstrtoumax.c
|
||||
|
||||
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_PREREQ_XSTRTOUMAX],
|
||||
[
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T])
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T])
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG])
|
||||
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_DECLS([strtol, strtoul, strtoull, strtoimax, strtoumax])
|
||||
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h inttypes.h)
|
||||
|
||||
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether <inttypes.h> defines strtoumax as a macro],
|
||||
jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro,
|
||||
AC_EGREP_CPP([inttypes_h_defines_strtoumax], [#include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
#ifdef strtoumax
|
||||
inttypes_h_defines_strtoumax
|
||||
#endif],
|
||||
jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro=yes,
|
||||
jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro=no))
|
||||
|
||||
if test "$jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro" != yes; then
|
||||
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoumax)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
dnl Only the replacement strtoumax invokes strtoul and strtoull,
|
||||
dnl so we need the replacements only if strtoumax does not exist.
|
||||
case "$jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro,$ac_cv_func_strtoumax" in
|
||||
no,no)
|
||||
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoul)
|
||||
|
||||
dnl We don't need (and can't compile) the replacement strtoull
|
||||
dnl unless the type `unsigned long long' exists.
|
||||
if test "$ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long" = yes; then
|
||||
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoull)
|
||||
fi
|
||||
;;
|
||||
esac
|
||||
])
|
||||
18
po/.cvsignore → po/.gitignore
vendored
18
po/.cvsignore → po/.gitignore
vendored
@@ -1,20 +1,22 @@
|
||||
index.html
|
||||
*.gmo
|
||||
*.mo
|
||||
*.po
|
||||
.reference
|
||||
LINGUAS
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
Makefile.in.in
|
||||
Makevars
|
||||
Makevars.template
|
||||
POTFILES
|
||||
Rules-quot
|
||||
boldquot.sed
|
||||
en@boldquot.header
|
||||
en@quot.header
|
||||
insert-header.sed
|
||||
insert-header.sin
|
||||
quot.sed
|
||||
remove-potcdate.sin
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
POTFILES
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
tar.pot
|
||||
remove-potcdate.sed
|
||||
*.gmo
|
||||
*.mo
|
||||
remove-potcdate.sin
|
||||
stamp-po
|
||||
tar.pot
|
||||
@@ -1,196 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# Makefile for program source directory in GNU NLS utilities package.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001 by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>
|
||||
#
|
||||
# This file can be copied and used freely without restrictions. It can
|
||||
# be used in projects which are not available under the GNU Public License
|
||||
# but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext functionality.
|
||||
# Please note that the actual code is *not* freely available.
|
||||
|
||||
PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@
|
||||
VERSION = @VERSION@
|
||||
|
||||
# These two variables depend on the location of this directory.
|
||||
subdir = po
|
||||
top_builddir = ..
|
||||
|
||||
SHELL = /bin/sh
|
||||
@SET_MAKE@
|
||||
|
||||
srcdir = @srcdir@
|
||||
top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@
|
||||
VPATH = @srcdir@
|
||||
|
||||
prefix = @prefix@
|
||||
exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
|
||||
datadir = @datadir@
|
||||
localedir = $(datadir)/locale
|
||||
gettextsrcdir = $(datadir)/gettext/po
|
||||
|
||||
INSTALL = @INSTALL@
|
||||
INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
|
||||
MKINSTALLDIRS = @MKINSTALLDIRS@
|
||||
mkinstalldirs = $(SHELL) `case "$(MKINSTALLDIRS)" in /*) echo "$(MKINSTALLDIRS)" ;; *) echo "$(top_builddir)/$(MKINSTALLDIRS)" ;; esac`
|
||||
|
||||
CC = @CC@
|
||||
GMSGFMT = @GMSGFMT@
|
||||
MSGFMT = @MSGFMT@
|
||||
XGETTEXT = @XGETTEXT@
|
||||
MSGMERGE = msgmerge
|
||||
|
||||
DEFS = @DEFS@
|
||||
CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
|
||||
CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDES = -I.. -I$(top_srcdir)/intl
|
||||
|
||||
COMPILE = $(CC) -c $(DEFS) $(INCLUDES) $(CPPFLAGS) $(CFLAGS) $(XCFLAGS)
|
||||
|
||||
POFILES = @POFILES@
|
||||
GMOFILES = @GMOFILES@
|
||||
DISTFILES = ChangeLog Makefile.in.in POTFILES.in $(PACKAGE).pot \
|
||||
$(POFILES) $(GMOFILES)
|
||||
|
||||
POTFILES = \
|
||||
|
||||
CATALOGS = @CATALOGS@
|
||||
|
||||
.SUFFIXES:
|
||||
.SUFFIXES: .c .o .po .pox .gmo .mo
|
||||
|
||||
.c.o:
|
||||
$(COMPILE) $<
|
||||
|
||||
.po.pox:
|
||||
$(MAKE) $(PACKAGE).pot
|
||||
$(MSGMERGE) $< $(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot -o $*.pox
|
||||
|
||||
.po.mo:
|
||||
$(MSGFMT) -o $@ $<
|
||||
|
||||
.po.gmo:
|
||||
file=$(srcdir)/`echo $* | sed 's,.*/,,'`.gmo \
|
||||
&& rm -f $$file && $(GMSGFMT) --statistics -o $$file $<
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
all: all-@USE_NLS@
|
||||
|
||||
all-yes: $(CATALOGS)
|
||||
all-no:
|
||||
|
||||
# Note: Target 'all' must not depend on target '$(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot',
|
||||
# otherwise packages like GCC can not be built if only parts of the source
|
||||
# have been downloaded.
|
||||
|
||||
$(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot: $(POTFILES) $(srcdir)/POTFILES.in
|
||||
$(XGETTEXT) --default-domain=$(PACKAGE) --directory=$(top_srcdir) \
|
||||
--add-comments --keyword=_ --keyword=N_ \
|
||||
--files-from=$(srcdir)/POTFILES.in \
|
||||
&& test ! -f $(PACKAGE).po \
|
||||
|| ( rm -f $(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot \
|
||||
&& mv $(PACKAGE).po $(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
install: install-exec install-data
|
||||
install-exec:
|
||||
install-data: install-data-@USE_NLS@
|
||||
if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then \
|
||||
$(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir); \
|
||||
$(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/Makefile.in.in \
|
||||
$(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/Makefile.in.in; \
|
||||
else \
|
||||
: ; \
|
||||
fi
|
||||
install-data-no: all
|
||||
install-data-yes: all
|
||||
$(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(datadir)
|
||||
@catalogs='$(CATALOGS)'; \
|
||||
for cat in $$catalogs; do \
|
||||
cat=`basename $$cat`; \
|
||||
lang=`echo $$cat | sed 's/\.gmo$$//'`; \
|
||||
dir=$(localedir)/$$lang/LC_MESSAGES; \
|
||||
$(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$$dir; \
|
||||
if test -r $$cat; then \
|
||||
$(INSTALL_DATA) $$cat $(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo; \
|
||||
echo "installing $$cat as $(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo"; \
|
||||
else \
|
||||
$(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$cat $(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo; \
|
||||
echo "installing $(srcdir)/$$cat as" \
|
||||
"$(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo"; \
|
||||
fi; \
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
# Define this as empty until I found a useful application.
|
||||
installcheck:
|
||||
|
||||
uninstall:
|
||||
catalogs='$(CATALOGS)'; \
|
||||
for cat in $$catalogs; do \
|
||||
cat=`basename $$cat`; \
|
||||
lang=`echo $$cat | sed 's/\.gmo$$//'`; \
|
||||
rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/$$lang/LC_MESSAGES/$(PACKAGE).mo; \
|
||||
done
|
||||
if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then \
|
||||
rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/Makefile.in.in; \
|
||||
else \
|
||||
: ; \
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
check: all
|
||||
|
||||
dvi info tags TAGS ID:
|
||||
|
||||
mostlyclean:
|
||||
rm -f core core.* *.pox $(PACKAGE).po *.new.po
|
||||
rm -fr *.o
|
||||
|
||||
clean: mostlyclean
|
||||
|
||||
distclean: clean
|
||||
rm -f Makefile Makefile.in POTFILES *.mo
|
||||
|
||||
maintainer-clean: distclean
|
||||
@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use;"
|
||||
@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild."
|
||||
rm -f $(GMOFILES)
|
||||
|
||||
distdir = $(top_builddir)/$(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION)/$(subdir)
|
||||
dist distdir:
|
||||
$(MAKE) update-po
|
||||
@$(MAKE) dist2
|
||||
# This is a separate target because 'update-po' must be executed before.
|
||||
dist2: $(DISTFILES)
|
||||
dists="$(DISTFILES)"; \
|
||||
for file in $$dists; do \
|
||||
if test -f $$file; then dir=.; else dir=$(srcdir); fi; \
|
||||
cp -p $$dir/$$file $(distdir); \
|
||||
done
|
||||
|
||||
update-po: Makefile
|
||||
$(MAKE) $(PACKAGE).pot
|
||||
if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then PATH=`pwd`/../src:$$PATH; fi; \
|
||||
cd $(srcdir); \
|
||||
catalogs='$(GMOFILES)'; \
|
||||
for cat in $$catalogs; do \
|
||||
cat=`basename $$cat`; \
|
||||
lang=`echo $$cat | sed 's/\.gmo$$//'`; \
|
||||
echo "$$lang:"; \
|
||||
if $(MSGMERGE) $$lang.po $(PACKAGE).pot -o $$lang.new.po; then \
|
||||
mv -f $$lang.new.po $$lang.po; \
|
||||
else \
|
||||
echo "msgmerge for $$cat failed!"; \
|
||||
rm -f $$lang.new.po; \
|
||||
fi; \
|
||||
done
|
||||
$(MAKE) update-gmo
|
||||
|
||||
update-gmo: Makefile $(GMOFILES)
|
||||
@:
|
||||
|
||||
Makefile: Makefile.in.in $(top_builddir)/config.status POTFILES.in
|
||||
cd $(top_builddir) \
|
||||
&& CONFIG_FILES=$(subdir)/$@.in CONFIG_HEADERS= \
|
||||
$(SHELL) ./config.status
|
||||
|
||||
# Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make not to export all variables.
|
||||
# Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
|
||||
.NOEXPORT:
|
||||
41
po/Makevars
41
po/Makevars
@@ -1,41 +0,0 @@
|
||||
# Makefile variables for PO directory in any package using GNU gettext.
|
||||
|
||||
# Usually the message domain is the same as the package name.
|
||||
DOMAIN = $(PACKAGE)
|
||||
|
||||
# These two variables depend on the location of this directory.
|
||||
subdir = po
|
||||
top_builddir = ..
|
||||
|
||||
# These options get passed to xgettext.
|
||||
XGETTEXT_OPTIONS = --keyword=_ --keyword=N_
|
||||
|
||||
# This is the copyright holder that gets inserted into the header of the
|
||||
# $(DOMAIN).pot file. Set this to the copyright holder of the surrounding
|
||||
# package. (Note that the msgstr strings, extracted from the package's
|
||||
# sources, belong to the copyright holder of the package.) Translators are
|
||||
# expected to transfer the copyright for their translations to this person
|
||||
# or entity, or to disclaim their copyright. The empty string stands for
|
||||
# the public domain; in this case the translators are expected to disclaim
|
||||
# their copyright.
|
||||
COPYRIGHT_HOLDER = Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This is the email address or URL to which the translators shall report
|
||||
# bugs in the untranslated strings:
|
||||
# - Strings which are not entire sentences, see the maintainer guidelines
|
||||
# in the GNU gettext documentation, section 'Preparing Strings'.
|
||||
# - Strings which use unclear terms or require additional context to be
|
||||
# understood.
|
||||
# - Strings which make invalid assumptions about notation of date, time or
|
||||
# money.
|
||||
# - Pluralisation problems.
|
||||
# - Incorrect English spelling.
|
||||
# - Incorrect formatting.
|
||||
# It can be your email address, or a mailing list address where translators
|
||||
# can write to without being subscribed, or the URL of a web page through
|
||||
# which the translators can contact you.
|
||||
MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS = bug-tar@gnu.org
|
||||
|
||||
# This is the list of locale categories, beyond LC_MESSAGES, for which the
|
||||
# message catalogs shall be used. It is usually empty.
|
||||
EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES =
|
||||
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
|
||||
# List of files which contain translatable strings.
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1996, 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1996, 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007 Free Software
|
||||
# Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
# any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
@@ -19,21 +19,27 @@
|
||||
# 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
# Library files
|
||||
lib/argmatch.c
|
||||
lib/argp-help.c
|
||||
lib/argp-parse.c
|
||||
lib/error.c
|
||||
lib/getopt.c
|
||||
lib/human.c
|
||||
lib/obstack.c
|
||||
gnu/argmatch.c
|
||||
gnu/argp-help.c
|
||||
gnu/argp-parse.c
|
||||
gnu/closeout.c
|
||||
gnu/error.c
|
||||
gnu/getopt.c
|
||||
gnu/obstack.c
|
||||
gnu/human.c
|
||||
gnu/obstack.c
|
||||
gnu/openat-die.c
|
||||
gnu/quotearg.c
|
||||
gnu/rpmatch.c
|
||||
gnu/xalloc-die.c
|
||||
gnu/xmalloc.c
|
||||
gnu/version-etc.c
|
||||
gnu/xalloc-die.c
|
||||
|
||||
lib/paxerror.c
|
||||
lib/paxexit.c
|
||||
lib/paxnames.c
|
||||
lib/quotearg.c
|
||||
lib/rpmatch.c
|
||||
lib/rtapelib.c
|
||||
lib/xalloc-die.c
|
||||
lib/xmalloc.c
|
||||
|
||||
rmt/rmt.c
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -46,12 +52,12 @@ src/delete.c
|
||||
src/extract.c
|
||||
src/incremen.c
|
||||
src/list.c
|
||||
src/mangle.c
|
||||
src/misc.c
|
||||
src/names.c
|
||||
src/tar.c
|
||||
src/update.c
|
||||
src/xheader.c
|
||||
src/checkpoint.c
|
||||
|
||||
# Testsuite
|
||||
tests/genfile.c
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,6 +0,0 @@
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
backup.sh
|
||||
backup
|
||||
restore
|
||||
dump-remind
|
||||
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2004, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2004, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
## any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -82,11 +82,11 @@ SLEEP_MESSAGE="`awk '
|
||||
}' /dev/null`"
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2004, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
## any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
|
||||
328
scripts/tar-snapshot-edit
Executable file
328
scripts/tar-snapshot-edit
Executable file
@@ -0,0 +1,328 @@
|
||||
#! /usr/bin/perl -w
|
||||
# Display and edit the 'dev' field in tar's snapshots
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
# any later version.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
# GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
|
||||
# 02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Author: Dustin J. Mitchell <dustin@zmanda.com>
|
||||
#
|
||||
# This script is capable of replacing values in the 'dev' field of an
|
||||
# incremental backup 'snapshot' file. This is useful when the device
|
||||
# used to store files in a tar archive changes, without the files
|
||||
# themselves changing. This may happen when, for example, a device
|
||||
# driver changes major or minor numbers.
|
||||
|
||||
use Getopt::Std;
|
||||
|
||||
## reading
|
||||
|
||||
sub read_incr_db ($) {
|
||||
my $filename = shift;
|
||||
open(my $file, "<$filename") || die "Could not open '$filename' for reading";
|
||||
|
||||
my $header_str = <$file>;
|
||||
my $file_version;
|
||||
if ($header_str =~ /^GNU tar-[^-]*-([0-9]+)\n$/) {
|
||||
$file_version = $1+0;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
$file_version = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
print "file version $file_version\n";
|
||||
|
||||
if ($file_version == 0) {
|
||||
return read_incr_db_0($file, $header_str);
|
||||
} elsif ($file_version == 1) {
|
||||
return read_incr_db_1($file);
|
||||
} elsif ($file_version == 2) {
|
||||
return read_incr_db_2($file);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
die "Unrecognized snapshot version in header '$header_str'";
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
sub read_incr_db_0 ($$) {
|
||||
my $file = shift;
|
||||
my $header_str = shift;
|
||||
|
||||
my $hdr_timestamp_sec = $header_str;
|
||||
chop $hdr_timestamp_sec;
|
||||
my $hdr_timestamp_nsec = ''; # not present in file format 0
|
||||
|
||||
my @dirs;
|
||||
|
||||
while (<$file>) {
|
||||
/^([0-9]*) ([0-9]*) (.*)\n$/ || die("Bad snapshot line $_");
|
||||
|
||||
push @dirs, { dev=>$1,
|
||||
ino=>$2,
|
||||
name=>$3 };
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
close($file);
|
||||
|
||||
# file version, timestamp, timestamp, dir list
|
||||
return [ 0, $hdr_timestamp_sec, $hdr_timestamp_nsec, \@dirs ];
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
sub read_incr_db_1 ($) {
|
||||
my $file = shift;
|
||||
|
||||
my $timestamp = <$file>; # "sec nsec"
|
||||
my ($hdr_timestamp_sec, $hdr_timestamp_nsec) = ($timestamp =~ /([0-9]*) ([0-9]*)/);
|
||||
|
||||
my @dirs;
|
||||
|
||||
while (<$file>) {
|
||||
/^([0-9]*) ([0-9]*) ([0-9]*) ([0-9]*) (.*)\n$/ || die("Bad snapshot line $_");
|
||||
|
||||
push @dirs, { timestamp_sec=>$1,
|
||||
timestamp_nsec=>$2,
|
||||
dev=>$3,
|
||||
ino=>$4,
|
||||
name=>$5 };
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
close($file);
|
||||
|
||||
# file version, timestamp, timestamp, dir list
|
||||
return [ 1, $hdr_timestamp_sec, $hdr_timestamp_nsec, \@dirs ];
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
sub read_incr_db_2 ($) {
|
||||
my $file = shift;
|
||||
|
||||
$/="\0"; # $INPUT_RECORD_SEPARATOR
|
||||
my $hdr_timestamp_sec = <$file>;
|
||||
chop $hdr_timestamp_sec;
|
||||
my $hdr_timestamp_nsec = <$file>;
|
||||
chop $hdr_timestamp_nsec;
|
||||
my @dirs;
|
||||
|
||||
while (1) {
|
||||
last if eof($file);
|
||||
|
||||
my $nfs = <$file>;
|
||||
my $timestamp_sec = <$file>;
|
||||
my $timestamp_nsec = <$file>;
|
||||
my $dev = <$file>;
|
||||
my $ino = <$file>;
|
||||
my $name = <$file>;
|
||||
|
||||
# get rid of trailing NULs
|
||||
chop $nfs;
|
||||
chop $timestamp_sec;
|
||||
chop $timestamp_nsec;
|
||||
chop $dev;
|
||||
chop $ino;
|
||||
chop $name;
|
||||
|
||||
my @dirents;
|
||||
while (my $dirent = <$file>) {
|
||||
chop $dirent;
|
||||
push @dirents, $dirent;
|
||||
last if ($dirent eq "");
|
||||
}
|
||||
die "missing terminator" unless (<$file> eq "\0");
|
||||
|
||||
push @dirs, { nfs=>$nfs,
|
||||
timestamp_sec=>$timestamp_sec,
|
||||
timestamp_nsec=>$timestamp_nsec,
|
||||
dev=>$dev,
|
||||
ino=>$ino,
|
||||
name=>$name,
|
||||
dirents=>\@dirents };
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
close($file);
|
||||
$/ = "\n"; # reset to normal
|
||||
|
||||
# file version, timestamp, timestamp, dir list
|
||||
return [ 2, $hdr_timestamp_sec, $hdr_timestamp_nsec, \@dirs ];
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
## display
|
||||
|
||||
sub show_device_counts ($$) {
|
||||
my $info = shift;
|
||||
my $filename = shift;
|
||||
my %devices;
|
||||
foreach my $dir (@{${@$info}[3]}) {
|
||||
my $dev = ${%$dir}{'dev'};
|
||||
$devices{$dev}++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
foreach $dev (sort keys %devices) {
|
||||
printf "$filename: Device 0x%04x occurs $devices{$dev} times.\n", $dev;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
## editing
|
||||
|
||||
sub replace_device_number ($@) {
|
||||
my $info = shift(@_);
|
||||
my @repl = @_;
|
||||
|
||||
foreach my $dir (@{${@$info}[3]}) {
|
||||
foreach $x (@repl) {
|
||||
if (${%$dir}{'dev'} eq $$x[0]) {
|
||||
${%$dir}{'dev'} = $$x[1];
|
||||
last;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
## writing
|
||||
|
||||
sub write_incr_db ($$) {
|
||||
my $info = shift;
|
||||
my $filename = shift;
|
||||
my $file_version = $$info[0];
|
||||
|
||||
open($file, ">$filename") || die "Could not open '$filename' for writing";
|
||||
|
||||
if ($file_version == 0) {
|
||||
write_incr_db_0($info, $file);
|
||||
} elsif ($file_version == 1) {
|
||||
write_incr_db_1($info, $file);
|
||||
} elsif ($file_version == 2) {
|
||||
write_incr_db_2($info, $file);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
die "Unknown file version $file_version.";
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
close($file);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
sub write_incr_db_0 ($$) {
|
||||
my $info = shift;
|
||||
my $file = shift;
|
||||
|
||||
my $timestamp_sec = $info->[1];
|
||||
print $file "$timestamp_sec\n";
|
||||
|
||||
foreach my $dir (@{${@$info}[3]}) {
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'dev'} ";
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'ino'} ";
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'name'}\n";
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
sub write_incr_db_1 ($$) {
|
||||
my $info = shift;
|
||||
my $file = shift;
|
||||
|
||||
print $file "GNU tar-1.15-1\n";
|
||||
|
||||
my $timestamp_sec = $info->[1];
|
||||
my $timestamp_nsec = $info->[2];
|
||||
print $file "$timestamp_sec $timestamp_nsec\n";
|
||||
|
||||
foreach my $dir (@{${@$info}[3]}) {
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'timestamp_sec'} ";
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'timestamp_nsec'} ";
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'dev'} ";
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'ino'} ";
|
||||
print $file "${%$dir}{'name'}\n";
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
sub write_incr_db_2 ($$) {
|
||||
my $info = shift;
|
||||
my $file = shift;
|
||||
|
||||
print $file "GNU tar-1.16-2\n";
|
||||
|
||||
my $timestamp_sec = $info->[1];
|
||||
my $timestamp_nsec = $info->[2];
|
||||
print $file $timestamp_sec . "\0";
|
||||
print $file $timestamp_nsec . "\0";
|
||||
|
||||
foreach my $dir (@{${@$info}[3]}) {
|
||||
print $file ${%$dir}{'nfs'} . "\0";
|
||||
print $file ${%$dir}{'timestamp_sec'} . "\0";
|
||||
print $file ${%$dir}{'timestamp_nsec'} . "\0";
|
||||
print $file ${%$dir}{'dev'} . "\0";
|
||||
print $file ${%$dir}{'ino'} . "\0";
|
||||
print $file ${%$dir}{'name'} . "\0";
|
||||
foreach my $dirent (@{${%$dir}{'dirents'}}) {
|
||||
print $file $dirent . "\0";
|
||||
}
|
||||
print $file "\0";
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
## main
|
||||
|
||||
sub main {
|
||||
our ($opt_b, $opt_r, $opt_h);
|
||||
getopts('br:h');
|
||||
HELP_MESSAGE() if ($opt_h || $#ARGV == -1 || ($opt_b && !$opt_r));
|
||||
|
||||
my @repl;
|
||||
if ($opt_r) {
|
||||
foreach my $spec (split(/,/, $opt_r)) {
|
||||
($spec =~ /^([^-]+)-([^-]+)/) || die "Invalid replacement specification '$opt_r'";
|
||||
push @repl, [interpret_dev($1), interpret_dev($2)];
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
foreach my $snapfile (@ARGV) {
|
||||
my $info = read_incr_db($snapfile);
|
||||
if ($opt_r ) {
|
||||
if ($opt_b) {
|
||||
rename($snapfile, $snapfile . "~") || die "Could not rename '$snapfile' to backup";
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
replace_device_number($info, @repl);
|
||||
write_incr_db($info, $snapfile);
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
show_device_counts($info, $snapfile);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
sub HELP_MESSAGE {
|
||||
print "Usage: tar-snapshot-edit.pl [-r 'DEV1-DEV2[,DEV3-DEV4...]' [-b]] SNAPFILE [SNAPFILE [..]]\n";
|
||||
print "\n";
|
||||
print " Without -r, summarize the 'device' values in each SNAPFILE.\n";
|
||||
print "\n";
|
||||
print " With -r, replace occurrences of DEV1 with DEV2 in each SNAPFILE.\n";
|
||||
print " DEV1 and DEV2 may be specified in hex (e.g., 0xfe01), decimal (e.g.,\n";
|
||||
print " 65025), or MAJ:MIN (e.g., 254:1). To replace multiple occurrences,\n";
|
||||
print " separate them with commas. If -b is also specified, backup\n";
|
||||
print " files (ending with '~') will be created.\n";
|
||||
exit 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
sub interpret_dev ($) {
|
||||
my $dev = shift;
|
||||
|
||||
if ($dev =~ /^([0-9]+):([0-9]+)$/) {
|
||||
return $1 * 256 + $2;
|
||||
} elsif ($dev =~ /^0x[0-9a-fA-F]+$/) {
|
||||
return oct $dev;
|
||||
} elsif ($dev =~ /^[0-9]+$/) {
|
||||
return $dev+0;
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
die "Invalid device specification '$dev'";
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
main
|
||||
473
scripts/xsparse.c
Normal file
473
scripts/xsparse.c
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,473 @@
|
||||
/* xsparse - expands compressed sparse file images extracted from GNU tar
|
||||
archives.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
Written by Sergey Poznyakoff
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
|
||||
under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
|
||||
Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
|
||||
version.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
|
||||
WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General
|
||||
Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
|
||||
with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
|
||||
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#include <fcntl.h>
|
||||
#include <sys/stat.h>
|
||||
#include <limits.h>
|
||||
#include <errno.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/* Bound on length of the string representing an off_t.
|
||||
See INT_STRLEN_BOUND in intprops.h for explanation */
|
||||
#define OFF_T_STRLEN_BOUND ((sizeof (off_t) * CHAR_BIT) * 146 / 485 + 1)
|
||||
#define OFF_T_STRSIZE_BOUND (OFF_T_STRLEN_BOUND+1)
|
||||
|
||||
#define BLOCKSIZE 512
|
||||
|
||||
struct sp_array
|
||||
{
|
||||
off_t offset;
|
||||
size_t numbytes;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
char *progname;
|
||||
int verbose;
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
die (int code, char *fmt, ...)
|
||||
{
|
||||
va_list ap;
|
||||
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "%s: ", progname);
|
||||
va_start (ap, fmt);
|
||||
vfprintf (stderr, fmt, ap);
|
||||
va_end (ap);
|
||||
fprintf (stderr, "\n");
|
||||
exit (code);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void *
|
||||
emalloc (size_t size)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *p = malloc (size);
|
||||
if (!p)
|
||||
die (1, "not enough memory");
|
||||
return p;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
off_t
|
||||
string_to_off (char *p, char **endp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
off_t v = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (; *p; p++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int digit = *p - '0';
|
||||
off_t x = v * 10;
|
||||
if (9 < (unsigned) digit)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (endp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
*endp = p;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
die (1, "number parse error near %s", p);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (x / 10 != v)
|
||||
die (1, "number out of allowed range, near %s", p);
|
||||
v = x + digit;
|
||||
if (v < 0)
|
||||
die (1, "negative number");
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (endp)
|
||||
*endp = p;
|
||||
return v;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
size_t
|
||||
string_to_size (char *p, char **endp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
off_t v = string_to_off (p, endp);
|
||||
size_t ret = v;
|
||||
if (ret != v)
|
||||
die (1, "number too big");
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
size_t sparse_map_size;
|
||||
struct sp_array *sparse_map;
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
get_line (char *s, int size, FILE *stream)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *p = fgets (s, size, stream);
|
||||
size_t len;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!p)
|
||||
die (1, "unexpected end of file");
|
||||
len = strlen (p);
|
||||
if (s[len - 1] != '\n')
|
||||
die (1, "buffer overflow");
|
||||
s[len - 1] = 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
get_var (FILE *fp, char **name, char **value)
|
||||
{
|
||||
static char *buffer;
|
||||
static size_t bufsize = OFF_T_STRSIZE_BOUND;
|
||||
char *p, *q;
|
||||
|
||||
buffer = emalloc (bufsize);
|
||||
do
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len, s;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!fgets (buffer, bufsize, fp))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
len = strlen (buffer);
|
||||
if (len == 0)
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
s = string_to_size (buffer, &p);
|
||||
if (*p != ' ')
|
||||
die (1, "malformed header: expected space but found %s", p);
|
||||
if (buffer[len-1] != '\n')
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (bufsize < s + 1)
|
||||
{
|
||||
bufsize = s + 1;
|
||||
buffer = realloc (buffer, bufsize);
|
||||
if (!buffer)
|
||||
die (1, "not enough memory");
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (!fgets (buffer + len, s - len + 1, fp))
|
||||
die (1, "unexpected end of file or read error");
|
||||
}
|
||||
p++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
while (memcmp (p, "GNU.sparse.", 11));
|
||||
|
||||
p += 11;
|
||||
q = strchr (p, '=');
|
||||
if (!q)
|
||||
die (1, "malformed header: expected `=' not found");
|
||||
*q++ = 0;
|
||||
q[strlen (q) - 1] = 0;
|
||||
*name = p;
|
||||
*value = q;
|
||||
return 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
char *outname;
|
||||
off_t outsize;
|
||||
unsigned version_major;
|
||||
unsigned version_minor;
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
read_xheader (char *name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *kw, *val;
|
||||
FILE *fp = fopen (name, "r");
|
||||
char *expect = NULL;
|
||||
size_t i = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
if (verbose)
|
||||
printf ("Reading extended header file\n");
|
||||
|
||||
while (get_var (fp, &kw, &val))
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (verbose)
|
||||
printf ("Found variable GNU.sparse.%s = %s\n", kw, val);
|
||||
|
||||
if (expect && strcmp (kw, expect))
|
||||
die (1, "bad keyword sequence: expected `%s' but found `%s'",
|
||||
expect, kw);
|
||||
expect = NULL;
|
||||
if (strcmp (kw, "name") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
outname = emalloc (strlen (val) + 1);
|
||||
strcpy (outname, val);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (strcmp (kw, "major") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
version_major = string_to_size (val, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (strcmp (kw, "minor") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
version_minor = string_to_size (val, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (strcmp (kw, "realsize") == 0
|
||||
|| strcmp (kw, "size") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
outsize = string_to_off (val, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (strcmp (kw, "numblocks") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
sparse_map_size = string_to_size (val, NULL);
|
||||
sparse_map = emalloc (sparse_map_size * sizeof *sparse_map);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (strcmp (kw, "offset") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
sparse_map[i].offset = string_to_off (val, NULL);
|
||||
expect = "numbytes";
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (strcmp (kw, "numbytes") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
sparse_map[i++].numbytes = string_to_size (val, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else if (strcmp (kw, "map") == 0)
|
||||
{
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < sparse_map_size; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
sparse_map[i].offset = string_to_off (val, &val);
|
||||
if (*val != ',')
|
||||
die (1, "bad GNU.sparse.map: expected `,' but found `%c'",
|
||||
*val);
|
||||
sparse_map[i].numbytes = string_to_size (val+1, &val);
|
||||
if (*val != ',')
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!(*val == 0 && i == sparse_map_size-1))
|
||||
die (1, "bad GNU.sparse.map: expected `,' but found `%c'",
|
||||
*val);
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
val++;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (*val)
|
||||
die (1, "bad GNU.sparse.map: garbage at the end");
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (expect)
|
||||
die (1, "bad keyword sequence: expected `%s' not found", expect);
|
||||
if (version_major == 0 && sparse_map_size == 0)
|
||||
die (1, "size of the sparse map unknown");
|
||||
if (i != sparse_map_size)
|
||||
die (1, "not all sparse entries supplied");
|
||||
fclose (fp);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
read_map (FILE *ifp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
char nbuf[OFF_T_STRSIZE_BOUND];
|
||||
|
||||
if (verbose)
|
||||
printf ("Reading v.1.0 sparse map\n");
|
||||
|
||||
get_line (nbuf, sizeof nbuf, ifp);
|
||||
sparse_map_size = string_to_size (nbuf, NULL);
|
||||
sparse_map = emalloc (sparse_map_size * sizeof *sparse_map);
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < sparse_map_size; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
get_line (nbuf, sizeof nbuf, ifp);
|
||||
sparse_map[i].offset = string_to_off (nbuf, NULL);
|
||||
get_line (nbuf, sizeof nbuf, ifp);
|
||||
sparse_map[i].numbytes = string_to_size (nbuf, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
fseek (ifp, ((ftell (ifp) + BLOCKSIZE - 1) / BLOCKSIZE) * BLOCKSIZE,
|
||||
SEEK_SET);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
expand_sparse (FILE *sfp, int ofd)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t i;
|
||||
size_t maxbytes = 0;
|
||||
char *buffer;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < sparse_map_size; i++)
|
||||
if (maxbytes < sparse_map[i].numbytes)
|
||||
maxbytes = sparse_map[i].numbytes;
|
||||
|
||||
for (buffer = malloc (maxbytes); !buffer; maxbytes /= 2)
|
||||
if (maxbytes == 0)
|
||||
die (1, "not enough memory");
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < sparse_map_size; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t size = sparse_map[i].numbytes;
|
||||
|
||||
if (size == 0)
|
||||
ftruncate (ofd, sparse_map[i].offset);
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
lseek (ofd, sparse_map[i].offset, SEEK_SET);
|
||||
while (size)
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t rdsize = (size < maxbytes) ? size : maxbytes;
|
||||
if (rdsize != fread (buffer, 1, rdsize, sfp))
|
||||
die (1, "read error (%d)", errno);
|
||||
if (rdsize != write (ofd, buffer, rdsize))
|
||||
die (1, "write error (%d)", errno);
|
||||
size -= rdsize;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
free (buffer);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
usage (int code)
|
||||
{
|
||||
printf ("Usage: %s [OPTIONS] infile [outfile]\n", progname);
|
||||
printf ("%s: expand sparse files extracted from GNU archives\n",
|
||||
progname);
|
||||
printf ("\nOPTIONS are:\n\n");
|
||||
printf (" -h Display this help list\n");
|
||||
printf (" -n Dry run: do nothing, print what would have been done\n");
|
||||
printf (" -v Increase verbosity level\n");
|
||||
printf (" -x FILE Parse extended header FILE\n\n");
|
||||
|
||||
exit (code);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void
|
||||
guess_outname (char *name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
char *p;
|
||||
char *s;
|
||||
|
||||
if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '/')
|
||||
name += 2;
|
||||
|
||||
p = name + strlen (name) - 1;
|
||||
s = NULL;
|
||||
|
||||
for (; p > name && *p != '/'; p--)
|
||||
;
|
||||
if (*p == '/')
|
||||
s = p + 1;
|
||||
if (p != name)
|
||||
{
|
||||
for (p--; p > name && *p != '/'; p--)
|
||||
;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (*p != '/')
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (s)
|
||||
outname = s;
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
outname = emalloc (4 + strlen (name));
|
||||
strcpy (outname, "../");
|
||||
strcpy (outname + 3, name);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
else
|
||||
{
|
||||
size_t len = p - name + 1;
|
||||
outname = emalloc (len + strlen (s) + 1);
|
||||
memcpy (outname, name, len);
|
||||
strcpy (outname + len, s);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int
|
||||
main (int argc, char **argv)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int c;
|
||||
int dry_run = 0;
|
||||
char *xheader_file = NULL;
|
||||
char *inname;
|
||||
FILE *ifp;
|
||||
struct stat st;
|
||||
int ofd;
|
||||
|
||||
progname = argv[0];
|
||||
while ((c = getopt (argc, argv, "hnvx:")) != EOF)
|
||||
{
|
||||
switch (c)
|
||||
{
|
||||
case 'h':
|
||||
usage (0);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'x':
|
||||
xheader_file = optarg;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
case 'n':
|
||||
dry_run = 1;
|
||||
case 'v':
|
||||
verbose++;
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
exit (1);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
argc -= optind;
|
||||
argv += optind;
|
||||
|
||||
if (argc == 0 || argc > 2)
|
||||
usage (1);
|
||||
|
||||
if (xheader_file)
|
||||
read_xheader (xheader_file);
|
||||
|
||||
inname = argv[0];
|
||||
if (argv[1])
|
||||
outname = argv[1];
|
||||
|
||||
if (stat (inname, &st))
|
||||
die (1, "cannot stat %s (%d)", inname, errno);
|
||||
|
||||
ifp = fopen (inname, "r");
|
||||
if (ifp == NULL)
|
||||
die (1, "cannot open file %s (%d)", inname, errno);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!xheader_file || version_major == 1)
|
||||
read_map (ifp);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!outname)
|
||||
guess_outname (inname);
|
||||
|
||||
ofd = open (outname, O_RDWR|O_CREAT|O_TRUNC, st.st_mode);
|
||||
if (ofd == -1)
|
||||
die (1, "cannot open file %s (%d)", outname, errno);
|
||||
|
||||
if (verbose)
|
||||
printf ("Expanding file `%s' to `%s'\n", inname, outname);
|
||||
|
||||
if (dry_run)
|
||||
{
|
||||
printf ("Finished dry run\n");
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
expand_sparse (ifp, ofd);
|
||||
|
||||
fclose (ifp);
|
||||
close (ofd);
|
||||
|
||||
if (verbose)
|
||||
printf ("Done\n");
|
||||
|
||||
if (outsize)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (stat (outname, &st))
|
||||
die (1, "cannot stat output file %s (%d)", outname, errno);
|
||||
if (st.st_size != outsize)
|
||||
die (1, "expanded file has wrong size");
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +0,0 @@
|
||||
Makefile.in
|
||||
Makefile
|
||||
localedir.h
|
||||
rmt
|
||||
tar
|
||||
.deps
|
||||
.gdbinit
|
||||
1
src/.gitignore
vendored
Normal file
1
src/.gitignore
vendored
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
|
||||
tar
|
||||
@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
|
||||
# Makefile for GNU tar sources.
|
||||
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003 Free
|
||||
# Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2006,
|
||||
# 2007, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||||
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
|
||||
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
|
||||
## any later version.
|
||||
|
||||
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
@@ -23,6 +23,7 @@ bin_PROGRAMS = tar
|
||||
noinst_HEADERS = arith.h common.h tar.h
|
||||
tar_SOURCES = \
|
||||
buffer.c\
|
||||
checkpoint.c\
|
||||
compare.c\
|
||||
create.c\
|
||||
delete.c\
|
||||
@@ -30,20 +31,18 @@ tar_SOURCES = \
|
||||
xheader.c\
|
||||
incremen.c\
|
||||
list.c\
|
||||
mangle.c\
|
||||
misc.c\
|
||||
names.c\
|
||||
sparse.c\
|
||||
suffix.c\
|
||||
system.c\
|
||||
tar.c\
|
||||
transform.c\
|
||||
update.c\
|
||||
utf8.c
|
||||
|
||||
INCLUDES = -I$(top_srcdir)/lib -I../ -I../lib
|
||||
INCLUDES = -I$(top_srcdir)/gnu -I../ -I../gnu -I$(top_srcdir)/lib
|
||||
|
||||
tar.o: ../lib/localedir.h
|
||||
|
||||
LDADD = ../lib/libtar.a $(LIBINTL) $(LIBICONV)
|
||||
LDADD = ../lib/libtar.a ../gnu/libgnu.a $(LIBINTL) $(LIBICONV)
|
||||
|
||||
tar_LDADD = $(LDADD) $(LIB_CLOCK_GETTIME)
|
||||
|
||||
1084
src/Makefile.in
1084
src/Makefile.in
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More
Reference in New Issue
Block a user